Yamaha BD-A1010 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Reproductores de Blu-Ray
Tipo
El manual del propietario
BD-A1010
© 2011 Yamaha Corporation
Printed in Malaysia WZ02530
BLU-RAY DISC PLAYER
BD-A1010
OWNER’S MANUAL
MANUAL DE INSTRUCCIONES
사용 설명서
KALVP
(전원 키)
본 기기의 전원을 켜거나 대기 모드에 맞추십시오.
00_BD-A1010_K_cv.fm Page 1 Tuesday, April 19, 2011 2:52 PM
Caution-i En
1 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.
2 Install this unit in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean place –
away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration, dust,
moisture, and/or cold. For proper ventilation, allow the
following minimum clearances.
Top: 10 cm (4 in)
Rear: 10 cm (4 in)
Sides: 10 cm (4 in)
3 Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances,
motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds.
4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in an environment with
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or
splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:
Other components, as they may cause damage and/or
discoloration on the surface of this unit.
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and
liquid may cause electrical shock to the user and/or
damage to this unit.
6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,
and/or personal injury.
7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections
are complete.
8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,
possibly causing damage.
9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
10 When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet,
grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this
unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and
may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Yamaha will not be held responsible for any damage resulting
from use of this unit with a voltage other than specified.
13 To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cable
disconnected from a wall outlet or this unit during a lightning
storm.
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified
Yamaha service personnel when any service is needed. The
cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time
(i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall
outlet.
16 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on
common operating errors before concluding that this unit is
faulty.
17 Before moving this unit, press p to set this unit to the
standby mode, and disconnect the AC power plug from the
wall outlet.
18 Condensation will form when the surrounding temperature
changes suddenly. Disconnect the power cable from the
outlet, then leave this unit alone.
19 When using this unit for a long time, this unit may become
warm. Turn the power off, then leave this unit alone for
cooling.
20 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power
plug can be reached easily.
21 The batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as
sunshine, fire or the like.
LASER SAFETY
This unit employs a laser. Due to possible eye injury, only a
qualified service person should remove the cover or attempt
to service this device.
DANGER
This unit emits visible laser radiation when open. Avoid
direct eye exposure to beam. When this unit is plugged into
the wall outlet, do not place your eyes close to the opening of
the disc tray and other openings to look into inside.
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.
This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source
as long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this
unit itself is turned off by p. This state is called the
standby mode. In this state, this unit is designed to
consume a very small quantity of power.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR
MOISTURE.
The laser component in this product is capable of
emitting radiation exceeding the limit for Class 1.
CAUTION
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of
procedures other than those specified herein may result
in hazardous radiation exposure.
LASER Specification:
Class 1 LASER Product
Wave length: 790 nm (CDs)/655 nm (DVDs)/405 nm (BDs)
Laser output: max. 1 mW
1 En
1
2
3
4
5
English
WHAT YOU CAN DO WITH THIS PLAYER........ 2
SUPPLIED PARTS .............................................. 2
ABOUT DISCS AND FILES................................. 3
Types of discs/files that can be used with this Player .... 3
Loading a disc................................................................. 4
Disc precautions ............................................................. 4
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS .......................... 5
Front panel...................................................................... 5
Remote control ............................................................... 6
INTRODUCTION TO CONNECTIONS .............. 10
Rear panel ..................................................................... 10
HDMI CONNECTION......................................... 12
Connecting to the HDMI terminal................................ 12
Connection for the playback of Blu-ray 3D discs ........ 12
VIDEO CONNECTIONS .................................... 13
Connecting to the component/video jack ..................... 13
AUDIO CONNECTIONS .................................... 14
Connecting to the digital audio jack/terminal............... 14
Connecting to the audio jacks....................................... 15
NETWORK AND USB CONNECTION .............. 16
Connecting to the NETWORK terminal and USB port
.... 16
OTHER CONNECTIONS ................................... 17
Connecting to the REMOTE CONTROL jacks ........... 17
Connecting the power cable ......................................... 17
INITIAL WIZARD/EASY SETUP........................ 18
Setting with the Initial Wizard/Easy Setup................... 18
HOME/MEDIA MENU ........................................ 19
Playing back photo/music/video................................... 19
Using network content.................................................. 21
USING NETWORK SERVICES ......................... 22
PLAYING VIDEOS FROM YouTube™ ............. 22
ADVANCED PLAYBACK OPERATION............ 23
On Screen menu............................................................ 23
Status menu................................................................... 24
Using Bookmark........................................................... 25
Program play................................................................. 25
Using search ................................................................. 25
Enjoying BONUSVIEW™ and BD-Live™................. 26
Using Picture in Picture function
(secondary audio/video playback) ........................... 26
Using the feature of BD-Live™ ................................... 26
SETUP MENU.................................................... 27
Example of SETUP menu operation ............................ 29
General Setting ............................................................. 30
Display Setting ............................................................. 32
Audio Setting................................................................ 34
System Information ...................................................... 34
About the audio output formats .................................... 35
About the video output formats .................................... 36
SOFTWARE UPGRADE.................................... 37
Upgrading the software ................................................ 37
TROUBLESHOOTING....................................... 38
Power ............................................................................ 38
Basic operation.............................................................. 38
Disc playback................................................................ 38
Picture ........................................................................... 39
Sound ............................................................................ 39
Network......................................................................... 40
Messages on the screen ................................................. 40
GLOSSARY ....................................................... 41
SPECIFICATIONS ............................................. 42
General.......................................................................... 42
Audio performance ....................................................... 42
Input/output................................................................... 42
Copyright ...................................................................... 43
(at the end of this manual)
About this manual
This manual describes how to operate this Player
using a remote control except when it is not
available. Some of these operations are also
available using the front panel buttons.
Notes contain important information about safety
and operating instructions. Hint(s) indicates a tip for
your operation.
This manual is printed prior to production. Design
and specifications are subject to change in part as a
result of improvements, etc. In case of differences
between the manual and the product, the product has
priority.
The icons used in this manual
Icons are used to indicate available buttons/functions for a
particular format.
: BD-Video
: DVD-Video, DVD-VR, DVD+VR, DVD-Audio
: Audio CD, Super Audio CD
: AVCHD, WMV, DivX
: MP3, WMA, WAV
: JPEG
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION
2. CONNECTION
3. PLAYBACK
4. SETTINGS
5. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Information about software ....................................i
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
2 En
INTRODUCTION
* For details on playable disc and format, see page 3.
** Network setting is needed to use this function.
Make sure the following accessories are provided with the product.
WHAT YOU CAN DO WITH THIS PLAYER
Easy setting for language, resolution, screen aspect ratio \ p. 18
You can perform language and TV settings.
Play back commercially-released Blu-ray™/DVD/CD/SA-CD/DVD-
Audio discs
*
\ p. 23
In addition to Blu-ray Discs™ (BD discs), this Player also supports playback of a variety of
other discs.
Play back BONUSVIEW™, BD-Live™, etc.
*
\ p. 26
You can enjoy additional movies on the latest BD discs.
Play back Video, Music, Photo files on a disc
*
\ p. 19
This Player can play back discs you recorded.
Play back Video, Music, Photo files on a disc/USB memory device
*
\ p. 19
Files recorded on discs/USB memory devices can be played back with this Player.
Play back Video, Music, Photo files on a Home Network Server
*
**
\ p. 21
PC contents can be played back with TV or AV receiver by connecting this Player to a network
server.
Operation with the remote control of TV, AV receiver, etc. \ p. 30
Connecting devices with an HDMI cable, you can control devices with a single remote control
using the HDMI Control function.
Streaming Playback contents on the Network Services
**
\ p. 22
You can instantly enjoy videos over the internet with this Player.
SUPPLIED PARTS
Batteries (×2)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
Power cableRemote control Audio pin cable Video pin cable
3 En
English
INTRODUCTION
1
Types of discs/files that can be
used with this Player
12 cm (5”) and 8 cm (3”) discs can be played back in
this Player. Do not use an 8 cm (3”) to 12 cm (5”)
adapter.
Use discs that conform to compatible standards as
indicated by the presence of official logos on the
disc label. Playback of discs not complying with
these standards is not guaranteed. In addition, the
image quality or sound quality is not guaranteed
even if the discs can be played back.
BD/DVD Video players and discs have region
codes, which dictate the regions in which a disc can
be played.
BD/DVD Video operations and functions may be
different from the explanations in this manual and
some operations may be prohibited due to disc
manufacturer’s settings.
If a menu screen or operating instructions are
displayed during playback of a disc, follow the
operating procedure displayed.
Playback for some of the discs in the left side
column tables may not be possible depending on the
disc.
Finalize all recording media that is played back in
this Player.
“Finalize” refers to a recorder processing a recorded
disc so that it will play in other players/recorders as
well as this Player. Only finalized discs will play
back in this Player. (This Player does not have a
function to finalize discs.)
Playback of all files on the disc, USB memory
device and network is not guaranteed.
ABOUT DISCS AND FILES
Disc Type
Recording
Format
Data Format
BD-ROM/BD-R/
BD-RE
BD-Video --
DVD-ROM DVD-Video/DVD-
Audio
--
DVD-R/DVD-R DL/
DVD-RW
DVD-Video/DVD-
VR/AVCHD/Data
Disc
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
DVD+R/DVD+R
DL/DVD+RW
DVD-Video/
DVD+VR/AVCHD/
Data Disc
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
CD-ROM CDDA/HDCD --
CD-R/CD-RW CDDA/Data Disc DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
SA-CD SA-CD --
USB -- DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
Network -- WMV/MP3/WMA/
WAV/JPEG
Region management information
Destination BD-Video DVD-Video
U.S.A. and Canada Region code “A” or
“ALL”
Region number “1
or “ALL”
Asia Region code “A” or
“ALL”
Region number “3
or “ALL”
Taiwan Region code “A” or
“ALL”
Region number “3
or “ALL”
1
ALL
3
ALL
3
ALL
Korea Region code “A” or
“ALL”
Region number “3”
or “ALL”
Central and South
America
Region code “A” or
“ALL”
Region number “4”
or “ALL”
Europe Region code “B” or
“ALL”
Region number “2”
or “ALL”
Australia Region code “B” or
“ALL”
Region number “4”
or “ALL”
Russia Region code “C” or
“ALL”
Region number “5”
or “ALL”
Notes
Region management information
Destination BD-Video DVD-Video
3
ALL
4
ALL
2
ALL
4
ALL
5
ALL
4 En
ABOUT DISCS AND FILES
A copyright protected file cannot be played back via
USB memory device and network.
MP3/WMA/WAV audio file requirement
Sampling frequency: within 32 - 48 kHz (MP3/
WMA), LPCM 44.1 kHz/16 bit/Stereo (WAV)
Bitrate: within 8 - 320 kbps (MP3), 32 - 192 kbps
(WMA)
WMV file requirement
WMV9, maximum resolution is 1,920 × 1,080.
About Super Audio CD (SA-CD)
Audio format based upon the current CD standards
but includes a greater amount of information that
provides higher quality sound. There are three types
of discs: single layer, dual layer and hybrid discs.
The hybrid disc can be played on existing CD
players as well as Super Audio CD players since it
contains both standard audio CD and Super Audio
CD information.
This player supports DSD data transmission via
HDMI using a compatible AV receiver.
This unit does not show the text data included in the
discs on the front panel display.
Loading a disc
Insert the disc with the label face up.
In case of the disc recorded on both sides, face down
the side to play back.
Playback may begin automatically, depending on the
disc and setting of this Player.
The menu may be displayed first, depending on the
disc.
The disc load time may vary depending on the disc.
Disc precautions
Be careful of scratches and dust
BD, DVD and CD discs are sensitive to dust,
fingerprints and especially scratches. A scratched
disc may not be able to be played back. Handle discs
with care and store them in a safe place.
Proper disc storage
Handling precautions
Cleaning the pick up lens
Never use commercially available cleaning discs.
The use of these discs can damage the lens.
Request the nearest service center approved by
Yamaha to clean the lens.
Hint
Note
1
2
3
Super Audio CD disc type
Single layer disc
HD layer
Dual layer disc
Hybrid layer disc
HD layer
CD layer
HD layer
Hybrid Super Audio CD disc
CD layer that plays on any
CD player
- High Quality DSD Stereo
- High Quality DSD Multi-channel
High Density layer containing:
Notes
Place the disc in the center of the disc case
and store the case and disc upright.
Avoid storing discs in locations subject to
direct sunlight, close to heating appliances
or in locations of high humidity.
Do not drop discs or subject them to
strong vibrations or impacts.
Avoid storing discs in locations where
there are large amounts of dust or
moisture.
If the surface is soiled, wipe gently with a
soft, damp (water only) cloth. When
wiping discs, always move the cloth from
the center hole toward the outer edge.
Do not use record cleaning sprays,
benzene, thinner, static electricity
prevention liquids or any other solvent.
Do not touch the surface.
Do not stick paper or adhesive labels to the disc.
If the playing surface of a disc is soiled or scratched,
the Player may decide that the disc is incompatible
and eject the disc tray, or it may fail to play the disc
correctly. Wipe any dirt off the playing surface with
a soft cloth.
5 En
English
INTRODUCTION
1
Front panel
1 p (On/Standby)
2 USB port (p. 16)
3 SA-CD indicator: Lights up when an SA-CD is
loaded and the SA-CD layer (p. 4) is selected.
4 Front panel display
5 Disc tray (p. 4)
6 (Eject): Opens/closes the disc tray.
7 (Search backward/Skip backward):
Press to skip backward, and press and hold to search
backward.
8 (Search forward/Skip forward):
Press to skip forward, and press and hold to search
forward.
9 (Play)
0 (Pause)
A (Stop)
B PURE DIRECT: Press to change the Pure Direct
mode (p. 7) to mode 1/mode 2/off. This button lights
up when Pure Direct mode is set to mode 1/mode 2.
Loading the batteries in the remote
control
Do not subject the remote control unit to shock,
water or excessive humidity.
The remote control unit may not function if the
Player’s remote sensor is in direct sunlight or any
other strong light.
Incorrect use of batteries may cause them to leak or
burst. Read the battery warnings and use the
batteries properly.
Do not mix old and new batteries, or mix different
brands.
Remove the batteries if you will not use the remote
control unit for an extended period of time.
Dispose of batteries according to your regional
regulations.
Approximate operating range of
remote control
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
2 5 61 43 7 8 9 0 A B
Notes
1
3
2
30˚30˚
Remote control sensor
6 m (20 ft)
6 En
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
Remote control
will appear on the top left corner of the screen
when the pressed button is not available.
1 Infrared signal transmitter: Outputs infrared
signal. Aim this window to the remote control sensor
(p. 5).
2 MARKER : Sets Bookmark (p. 25) at
a specified point of a movie. After Bookmark is set, to
select the set point you want to jump to, press
DIGEST. You can set up to 12 Bookmarks.
3 : Opens/closes the disc tray.
4 PROGRAM : Sets the order of playback
(p. 25). You can set up to 15 tracks (for an audio disc)
or titles/chapters (DVD-Video).
5 Color buttons : Use these buttons according to
on-screen instructions.
6 Number buttons: Enters numbers, or during
playback, jumps to the track/chapter corresponding to
the number you input. These buttons may not be
available depending on the disc type and playback
condition.
7 CLEAR: Clears entered number/set item.
8 SETUP: Displays SETUP menu screen (p. 27).
9 PIP : Turns on/off the Picture in Picture (p. 26).
PIP Mark ( ) is displayed on the screen when this
function is available. You can also select this item from
On Screen menu (p. 23).
PIP Mark is displayed only when the PIP Mark is set
to on (p. 31).
0 2ND AUDIO : Selects the secondary audio of
the Picture in Picture (p. 26) or audio commentaries.
The Secondary Audio Mark ( ) is displayed on the
screen when this function is available (p. 34). You can
also select this item from On Screen menu (p. 23).
Secondary Audio Mark is displayed only when
Secondary Audio Mark is set to on (p. 31).
Note
Note
Note
DVD
VIDEO
DVD CD
BD
BD
BD
7 En
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
English
INTRODUCTION
1
A TOP MENU : Displays the top menu
screen (p. 42) if the disc contains a menu. Select the
desired item using 5/a /2/3 and ENTER.
Specific operations may be different depending on
the disc. Follow the instructions of each menu
screen.
B Cursor buttons (5/a /2/3): Moves the focus in
the menu screen.
ENTER: Selects the focused menu/item.
C RETURN: Returns to the previous menu or screen,
etc.
D SUBTITLE : Changes subtitle
languages (p. 42) if available . You can also select this
item from On Screen menu (p. 23).
E STATUS: Displays the playback information (p. 24).
F Control buttons
/
:
Searches backward/forward. The search speed will
change each time you press the button (search
backward/forward: 5 steps each). Press to resume
normal playback.
: Changes the speed of a slide show (slower/
faster: 3 steps).
/ :
Press and hold for instant search/replay. Instant search
skips the content 30 seconds. Instant replay replays
the content from 10 seconds before.
/: Skips backward/forward.
: Stops playback. To stop playback completely,
press this button twice.
: Pauses playback.
: Plays back contents.
()/ ()
: Performs slow backward/forward. Slow
playback speed will change each time you press the
button (slow backward/forward: 4 steps each).
These buttons also perform frame advance/reverse
playback during pause.
Press to resume normal playback.
Many DVD-Audio discs include slide show and page
turn capabilities. Press / to move to a previous/
next page. This function is only for DVD-Audio.
Some BD/DVD discs are not compatible with frame
advance/reverse playback.
Depending on the disc, this Player resumes playback
from the point that where the Player was previously
stopped. To play back from the beginning, press
twice and then .
G SA-CD/CD: Switches the playback layer of a hybrid
SA-CD between SA-CD and CD (p. 4).
The SA-CD/CD indicator (p. 5) on the front panel
lights up when an SA-CD is loaded and the SA-CD
layer is selected (p. 34).
Audio signals are only output from the AUDIO OUT
jacks (p. 11) while the SA-CD layer is selected.
Audio signals recorded in DSD multi-channel format
cannot be played on this Player.
H PURE DIRECT: Changes Pure Direct mode. Pure
Direct mode shown below will change each time you
press the button. Pure Direct mode improves audio
quality. PURE DIRECT on the front panel lights up
when Pure Direct mode is set to mode 1/mode 2.
Mode 1: Front panel display is turned off, and video
signals are not output. This mode is suitable listening
audio.
Mode 2: Front panel display is turned off, and video
signals from other than HDMI terminal are not output.
This mode is suitable for watching movies with high
quality sound.
off: Normal play back.
I DIMMER: Changes brightness of the front panel
display in 5 steps.
J DIGEST : Shows 12 photo thumbnails.
When thumbnails are displayed, you can proceed to
the next/previous page with / .
: Displays Bookmark select bar
(p. 25).
K p: Turns this Player on or sets it to the standby mode.
L ZOOM : Zooms in/out.
The size of the screen will change each time you press
the button (zoom in/out: 3 steps each).
Note
Notes
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
Hint
Notes
PHOTO
DVD VIDEO
DVD VIDEO PHOTO
Continued to the next page.
\
8 En
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
M SEARCH :
Jumps to a specified point during playback. For details
on this function, refer to “Using search” (p. 25). You
can also select this item from status menu (p. 24).
N HOME: Displays the HOME menu screen (p. 19).
O REPEAT
: Changes repeat mode. Repeat mode shown
below will change each time you press the button.
: Repeats the title being played back.
: Repeats the chapter being played back.
: Repeats the folder being played back.
: Repeats all tracks/files on the disc.
: Repeats the track/file being played back.
P A/B : Plays back
a specific part you want to repeat.
1 Press A/B at the scene where you want to set the
start point. “A-” is displayed on the screen.
2 Press A/B again at the scene where you want to set
the end point. “A-B” is displayed on the screen.
Repeat playback starts.
3 To cancel the repeat playback, press A/B. “A-B”
disappears and the repeat playback is finished.
This function cannot be performed depending on the
specifications of the disc.
Q POP-UP/MENU : Displays pop-up
menu. The menu contents displayed vary depending
on the disc. For details on how to see and operate the
pop-up menu, refer to the manual for the disc.
The top menu screen may be displayed by pressing
POP-UP/MENU depending on the DVD.
R ON SCREEN: Displays On Screen menu (p. 23).
S ANGLE : Changes the camera angle if
video is recorded with multiple angles. The Angle
Mark ( ) is displayed on the screen when this
function is available. You can also select this item
from On Screen menu (p. 23).
Angle Mark is displayed only when the Angle Mark
is set to on (p. 31).
T AUDIO : Changes the audio language or
format. You can also select this item from On Screen
menu (p. 23).
Note
Note
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
BD DVD
BD DVD
9 En
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
English
INTRODUCTION
1
ID function
You can change the remote control ID to prevent
unwanted operation of the other Yamaha player such as
DVD player. If you have changed the remote control ID,
make sure that you select the same ID for the main unit.
The default setting is ID1.
1 Remote control setting
To change the ID from ID1 to ID2, press and hold
the red color button and 2 of number button
simultaneously for 7 seconds. To change the ID
from ID2 to ID1, press and hold the red color button
and 1 of number button simultaneously for 7
seconds.
2 Main unit setting
Press and hold and on the
front panel simultaneously for 2 seconds to display
current ID when:
No disc is inserted in this Player.
The disc tray is closed.
Playback is stopped.
“NO DISC” is displayed on the front panel
display.
Keep pressing and holding the keys for another 2
seconds to change the ID between ID1 and ID2.
If the remote control is without batteries for a few
minutes or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the remote control ID is
automatically set to ID1. If you want to use the
remote control in ID2 setting, install new batteries
and set the remote control ID again.
Note
10 En
CONNECTION
Find the corresponding connection method on your video/audio equipment. We recommend that you use the HDMI
terminal which provides high quality digital audio and video on a single connection. If you use the other terminals/jacks,
connect the video first. Then connect the audio.
Rear panel
INTRODUCTION TO CONNECTIONS
Yes
No
Use AV receiver?
HDMI terminal on
AV receiver? *
HDMI terminal on TV?
HDMI terminal on TV?
HDMI terminal on TV?
Connect video and audio to TV with HDMI cable.
Connect video to TV.
Connect video to TV with HDMI cable.
Connect video to AV receiver.
Connect video and audio to AV
receiver with HDMI cable.
Refer to owner’s manual
of AV receiver.
START
* When you connect to an AV receiver that cannot output the sound
input via its HDMI terminal, refer to the owner’s manual of your AV
receiver.
67 0 A93214 85
11 En
English
CONNECTION
2
1 NETWORK (p. 16)
2 HDMI (p. 12)
3 USB port (p. 16)
4 REMOTE CONTROL (IN/OUT/RS-232C) (p. 17)
5 7.1 ch surround (AUDIO OUT) (p. 15)
6 MIXED 2CH (AUDIO OUT) (p. 15)
7 VIDEO (p. 13)
8 COMPONENT (p. 13)
9 COAXIAL (p. 14)
0 OPTICAL (p. 14)
A AC IN (p. 17)
Video connection
Connect audio to AV
receiver.
Video connection to TV
Connect audio to TV.
HDMI (p. 12)
A
Video and audio connection to
AV receiver
Audio connection to AV receiver
Video and audio connection to TV
Audio connection to TV
HDMI (p. 12)
A’
COMPONENT (p. 13)
B
VIDEO (p. 13)
C
to TV
to AV receiver
or
COMPONENT (p. 13)
B’
VIDEO (p. 13)
C’
or
COAXIAL (p. 14)
D
OPTICAL (p. 14)
E
or
MIXED 2CH (p. 15)
F
or
COAXIAL (p. 14)
D’
OPTICAL (p. 14)
E’
or
MIXED 2CH (p. 15)
F’
or
HDMI (p. 12)
A’
7.1 ch surround (p. 15)
G
or
12 En
Connecting to the HDMI terminal
You can enjoy high quality digital picture and sound through the HDMI terminal.
Firmly connect an HDMI cable (commercially available) to the HDMI terminals.
See page 35 for information on the audio/video output formats.
Use HIGH SPEED HDMI cables that have the HDMI logo (as shown on the back cover).
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
HDMI CONNECTION
HDMI IN
This Player
To HDMI terminal
HDMI cable
(commercially available)
When you use the HDMI Control function,
refer to the “HDMI Control” (p. 30).
For information on the output mode of HDMI
terminal, refer to the “HDMI” (p. 34).
When no picture is displayed, refer to
“TROUBLESHOOTING” (p. 39).
Connection for the playback
of Blu-ray 3D discs
To enjoy Blu-ray 3D discs on this Player, you need
the following equipments and connections:
You need a TV and an AV Receiver (if you
need) that have 3D functionality.
All the components must be connected with
HDMI cables.
Blu-ray disc should contain 3D images.
Hints
AV receiver
TV
A A’
To HDMI input terminal
13 En
English
CONNECTION
2
Connecting to the component/video jack
You can enjoy accurate color reproduction and high quality images through the component jacks.
Firmly connect a component video cable (commercially available) or a video pin cable to the COMPONENT jacks/
VIDEO jack.
See page 36 for information on the video output formats.
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
If you play back the image via VCR, the image may deteriorate due to the copy guard function.
To enjoy BD-3D discs on this Player, you need to connect an AV receiver, a TV, and this Player using HDMI
cables. Refer to the previous page.
VIDEO CONNECTIONS
COMPONENT IN
Y
PB
PR
This Player
Component video cable
(commercially available)
AV receiver
TV
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
To COMPONENT
jacks
To component
input jacks
B B’
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
VIDEO
AV INPUT
This Player
Video pin cable
(supplied)
AV receiver TV
(Yellow)
(Yellow)
(Yellow)
To VIDEO
jack
To video
input jack
(Yellow)
C C’
Notes
14 En
Connecting to the digital audio jack/terminal
You can connect audio equipment or the TV to the COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal.
Firmly connect a Coaxial digital audio cable (commercially available) or optical cable (commercially available) to
the coaxial digital audio jack or optical digital audio terminal.
See page 35 for information on the audio output formats.
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
For information on the output mode of COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal, refer to the “Coaxial/Optical” (p. 34).
AUDIO CONNECTIONS
Hint
AV INPUT
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
OPTICAL
This Player
To OPTICAL
terminal
TVAV receiver
Optical cable
(commercially available)
Coaxial digital audio cable
(commercially available)
This Player
AV receiver
D D’
To COAXIAL
jack
To coaxial
input jack
To optical
input terminal
TV
D’ E E’
AUDIO CONNECTIONS
15 En
English
CONNECTION
2
Connecting to the audio jacks
You can connect audio equipment or the TV to the MIXED 2CH/7.1 ch surround jacks.
Firmly connect audio pin cables (supplied and commercially available) to the MIXED 2CH jacks or 7.1 ch
surround jacks.
See page 35 for information on the audio output formats.
If you want to reproduce multi-channel SA-CD and DVD-Audio, connect 7.1 ch surround jacks to the
corresponding input jacks of your AV receiver using commercially available audio pin cables.
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
You can connect a subwoofer to the SUBWOOFER jack directly. When you connect TV to this Player directly,
connect an active subwoofer such as Yamaha Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System to this jack.
To output the audio signal from the MIXED 2CH/7.1 ch surround jacks, refer to “Speaker Setting” (p. 34).
AUDIO
AUDIO IN
LR
To AUDIO OUT
MIXED 2CH jacks
Audio pin cable
(supplied)
(White)
(Red)
(White) (Red)
TVAV receiver
Th
i
s Player
To audio input
jacks
F F’
(White)
(Red)
(White)
(Red)
MULTICH IN
SURROUND
LR
SURROUND BACK
LR
FRONT
LR
CENTER SUBWOOFER
AV receiver
Th
i
s Player
G
(White)
(Red)
(White)
(Red)
(White)
(Red)
Audio pin
cables
(supplied and
commercially
available)
(White)
(Red)
(White)
(Red)
(White)
(Red)
To 7.1 ch
surround
jacks
To
MULTI
CH IN
jacks
(White) (Red) (White) (Red) (White) (Red)
Hints
16 En
Connecting to the NETWORK terminal and USB port
PC contents can be played back by connecting this Player to the network.
You can enjoy a variety of contents with interactive functions by connecting to the internet when playing BD-Live
compatible discs. Refer to page 26 regarding further information on BD-Live functions.
You can connect a USB memory device (2 GB or greater and formatted with FAT 32/16) for BD Local Storage to
the USB port on the rear panel (or front panel) of the player to save the BD-Live data or to upgrade the software of
this Player.
Firmly connect a network cable (commercially available) and a USB memory device (commercially available) to
the NETWORK terminal and USB port.
Use only an STP (shielded twisted pair) network cable.
When using the internet, a broadband internet connection as shown below is required.
Connect the other connector of the network cable to the hub/broadband router.
Before using the USB memory device
After connecting
When you set the Network setting manually, refer to “Network” (p. 32).
To play back the PC contents on your network, refer to “Using network content” (p. 21).
NETWORK AND USB CONNECTION
LAN
This Player
When using a broadband internet
connection, a contract with an internet
service provider is required. For more
details, contact your nearest internet service
provider.
Refer to the operation manual of the
equipment you have as the connected
equipment and connection method may
differ depending on your internet
environment.
Use a network cable/router supporting
10BASE-T/100BASE-TX.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the USB memory device
or unplug the power cable while the
operations for BD-Live (p. 26) or
software upgrade are being performed.
Do not use a USB extension cable when
connecting a USB memory device to the
USB port of the Player. Using a USB
extension cable may prevent the Player
from performing correctly.
Yamaha cannot guarantee that all brands’
USB memory devices will operate with
this Player.
Notes
Note
To NETWORK
terminal
Internet
Modem
Network cable
(commercially available)
Hub or
broadband router
PC
To USB port
USB memory device
(commercially available)
To LAN
terminal
To save BD-Live data on
the USB memory device
on the front panel, set
Local Storage to Front
USB (p. 30).
Hint
17 En
English
CONNECTION
2
Connecting to the REMOTE
CONTROL jacks
You can transmit and receive the remote control
signals by connecting to the REMOTE CONTROL
(OUT/IN) jacks.
Firmly connect monaural 3.5 mm mini plug cables
(commercially available) to the REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT/IN) jacks.
If your AV receiver is a Yamaha product and has the
capability to transmit SCENE control signals, you
can control the Player with the SCENE function.
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this
Player until all connections are completed.
For details about the SCENE function, refer to the
owner’s manual supplied with your Yamaha AV
receiver.
You can connect a Yamaha component (such as CD
player) supports the SCENE function to the
REMOTE CONTROL (OUT) jack of this Player.
The RS-232C terminal is a control expansion
terminal for commercial use. Consult your dealer for
details.
Connecting the power cable
After all connections are completed, plug the
supplied power cable into the AC IN on the rear of
the Player. Then plug into AC outlet.
TO PREVENT RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO
NOT TOUCH THE UN-INSULATED PARTS OF
ANY CABLES WHILE THE POWER CABLE IS
CONNECTED.
OTHER CONNECTIONS
Hints
REMOTE CONTROL IN
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
This Player
To REMOTE
CONTROL (IN)
jack
Monaural 3.5 mm
mini plug cable
(commercially
available)
To remote
control out
jack
Yamaha component
To remote
control in
jack
Monaural 3.5 mm
mini plug cable
(commercially
available)
Infrared signal receiver
or Yamaha component
(such as AV receiver)
To REMOTE
CONTROL
(OUT) jack
Note
To AC outlet
To AC IN
18 En
PLAYBACK
Setting with the Initial Wizard/
Easy Setup
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup allows you to set language,
resolution, and screen aspect ratio easily. Initial Wizard
screen is displayed when you turn this Player on for the
first time after purchase or upgrade. Same setting can be
performed from SETUP menu = System = Easy Setup.
1 When Easy Setup screen is displayed, Press ENTER to
start Easy Setup.
2 Press 5/a to select the language you want to display
on the screen, then press ENTER.
3 Press 5 /a to select the resolution, then press ENTER.
For details on setting items, see “Resolution” (p. 33).
4 Press 5/a to select the screen aspect ratio, then press
ENTER. For details on setting items, see “TV Screen”
(p. 32).
Easy Setup is completed.
5 Press ENTER to exit Easy Setup.
When no picture is displayed after Initial Wizard/
Easy Setup is completed, refer to
“TROUBLESHOOTING” (p. 39).
A warning message concerning 3D video playback
appears when this Player is turned on. Press ENTER
to dismiss the message or CLEAR to disable it (p.
30).
INITIAL WIZARD/EASY SETUP
Notes
ENTER
FinishPrevious
Setting
Page: 5/5
Easy Setup
The set-up wizard is finished!
Now press the Finish button to go to SETUP. Please
enjoy!
19 En
English
PLAYBACK
3
HOME and MEDIA menus allow you to browse and play
multi-media files on data discs, USB memory devices and
your network.
For details on playable disc and format, see page 3.
Playing back photo/music/video
Basic operation
5/a : Moves the focus.
2: Returns to the parent folder.
3: Checks/unchecks single folder/file.
HOME: Moves to/exits HOME menu screen.
ENTER: Confirms the folder/file.
Icons on the top of MEDIA menu
: Plays back the disc on the tray, or displays contents
in the data disc.
: Displays contents in the USB memory device
connected to the USB port.
: Searches for a DLNA (p. 21) server on the network.
: Displays contents on the connected DLNA server.
Common operations for playing back
files in a selected folder
Example: Selecting a movie file on a USB memory
device
Stop the playback of the video before you move to
MEDIA menu screen.
1 Press HOME to move to HOME menu screen.
Press 2/3 to select MEDIA, then press ENTER.
2 MEDIA screen appears.
3 Select the item which contains the file you want to play
back, then press ENTER.
HOME/MEDIA MENU
Note
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
2ND
AUDIO
A/B
HOME
Note
HOME/MEDIA MENU
20 En
4 Select the Photo, Music, Video or AVCHD folder you
want to play back, then press ENTER.
To return to the parent folder, press 2 or select .
Note that the only the file type selected on this step
will be displayed in the following step. For example,
if you selected Photo folder in this step, only photo
files are displayed after this step. When you play
back other than photo, return to this hierarchy and
select file type again.
5 Select the folder(s) containing the file you want to play
back.
6 Select the file you want to play back, then press
ENTER.
When a video file is selected, playback starts.
When a music file is selected, status screen is displayed
and playback starts.
When a photo file is selected, slide show starts.
To enjoy slide show with music, press HOME to
return to the HOME menu screen while music is
played back, and select photo file.
The displayed file may not be played back
depending on the content.
Operations for viewing photos
While viewing photos, the buttons on the remote control
work as shown below.
: Stops slide show and returns to the file browser.
: Pauses a slide show.
: Plays a slide show.
: Moves to a next photo.
: Moves to a previous photo.
: Makes a slide show faster in 3 steps.
: Makes a slide show slower in 3 steps.
5: Inverts a photo.
a : Reflects a photo.
2: Rotates a photo counterclockwise.
3: Rotates a photo clockwise.
ZOOM: Zooms in/out a photo (zoom in/out: 3 steps each).
5/a /2/3 : Pan in zoom mode when a photo is larger
than the screen.
DIGEST: Switches to thumbnail mode (p. 7). When
thumbnails are displayed, you can proceed to the next/
previous page with / .
Note
Hint
Note
HOME/MEDIA MENU
21 En
PLAYBACK
3
English
Using network content
This Player is a DLNA certified digital media player. You
can manage photo, music and video contents stored on
DLNA servers on your home network.
About DLNA
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance) provides easy
sharing of digital media through network in the home, and
you can enjoy digital contents stored on your DLNA-
server-software-installed PC or other DLNA compatible
device with your TV via this Player. To connect this
Player to your DLNA servers, some settings for the
DLNA server or device are required. For details, refer to
your DLNA server software or DLNA device.
Playing back shared contents
1 To play back files on your PC, install a DLNA server
software, such as Windows Media Player 12, and share
files you want to play back.
2 Turn on the PC with DLNA server software installed or
the DLNA device connected to your home network.
3 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen. Then
select MEDIA to move to MEDIA menu. The DLNA
servers connected to the network are listed on the
screen.
If your DLNA server is not listed, select DLNA
Search to find it.
Depending on the DLNA server, this Player may
need to be permitted from the server.
To play the file on the DLNA server, this Player and
the server must be connected to the same access
point.
The file requirements may not always be compatible.
There may be some restrictions depending on file
features and DLNA sever capability.
4 Select the file you want to play back.
The playback and operating quality may be affected
by your home network condition.
The files from removable media such as USB
memory devices or DVD-drive on your media
server, may not be shared properly.
Notes
Notes
22 En
You can instantly watch the videos that the following network services provide.
YouTube
Access to content provided by third parties requires a high speed internet connection and may also require account
registration and a paid subscription.
Third party content services may be changed, suspended, interrupted, or discontinued at any time without notice,
and Yamaha disclaims any liability in connection with such occurrences.
Some content may only be available for specific countries and may be presented in specific languages.
Yamaha does not represent or warrant that content services will continue to be provided or available for a particular
period of time, and any such warranty, express or implied, is disclaimed.
You can watch movies from YouTube over the internet
using this Player.
The services may be changed without notice.
1 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen.
The HOME menu screen may differ depending on
the model.
2 Press 5/a /2/3 to select YouTube, then press
ENTER.
To return to the HOME menu screen, press
RETURN.
USING NETWORK SERVICES
Notes
PLAYING VIDEOS FROM YouTube™
Hint
Hint
23 En
English
PLAYBACK
3
This chapter explains playback of commercially available
BD and DVD discs, SA-CDs, CDs, and recorded DVD-
RW/R discs.
For the basic playback operation, see page 6.
On Screen menu
To display On Screen menu, press ON SCREEN. After
that, press 5/a /2/3 to select an item, then press
ENTER to operate the desired function.
On Screen menu contains following items.
Title : Shows the title number being
played back. You can skip to the desired title by selecting
it from this item.
Chapter : Shows the chapter
number being played back. You can skip to the desired
chapter by selecting it from this item.
Track/File : Shows
track/file number being played back. You can skip to the
desired track/file by selecting it from this item.
Time : Shows the
playback time. Select display type from the following:
Elapsed playback time of the title, chapter, disc,
track or file
Remaining playback time of the title, chapter, disc,
track or file
Mode/Play Mode
: Shows current
playback mode. You can select playback mode from the
following:
Normal: Normal playback.
Shuffle: Random playback without repetition.
Random: Random playback with repetition.
Normal
Shuffle CH (chapter)
Shuffle TT (title)
Shuffle All
Random CH (chapter)
Random TT (title)
Random All
Normal
Shuffle F (folder)
Shuffle All
Random F (folder)
Random All
Audio : Shows audio language/
signal of BD/DVD disc currently selected. You can select
the desired type of audio.
Angle : Shows the currently-selected angle
number. If the video is recorded with multiple angles, you
can change the angle.
Subtitle : Shows the currently-
selected subtitle language when the subtitle is provided.
Subtitle Style : Shows the currently-selected
subtitle style. This function is available only for Video-file
external subtitle. You can select the desired text style of
subtitle.
Bitrate : Shows
bitrate of the audio/video signal.
Second Video : Turns the PIP on/off (p. 6).
Second Audio : Turns the secondary audio on/off
(p. 6).
Ins Search
: Skips 30 seconds.
Ins Replay
: Replays the content
from 10 seconds before.
Slide Show :
Shows slide show speed. You can select the slide show
speed from Slow/Medium/Fast.
Transition : Shows how photo appears on the
screen. You can select the transition type.
Code Page : Selects character code of subtitle
you added to DivX video (p. 41).
ADVANCED PLAYBACK OPERATION
Note
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD VIDEO
CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
CD
DVD
VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
PHOTO
VIDEO
ADVANCED PLAYBACK OPERATION
24 En
Status menu
This shows various settings, such as subtitles, angle
settings and the title/chapter/track number currently
played back. To display status menu, press STATUS.
Status menu contains following menus.
Example: Icons when playing BD
1 (Playback status)
2 (Disc type/video file icon)
3 (Title number being played): You can jump to
specified title with SEARCH button (p. 8).
4 (Chapter number being played): You can
jump to specified chapter with SEARCH button (p. 8).
5 (Elapsed playback time): You can jump to
specified point with SEARCH button (p. 8).
6 (Subtitle currently selected): You can change
the subtitle language with SUBTITLE button.
7 (Audio currently selected): You can change the
audio language or format with AUDIO button.
8
(Repeat mode):
Shows current repeat mode (p. 8).
Example: Icons when playing music file
1 (Playback status)
2
(Repeat mode):
Shows current repeat mode (p. 8).
3 (Disc type/music file icon)
4 (Artwork) : Displays artwork if the file
contains it.
5 (Track/file number being played): You can
jump to specified track with SEARCH button (p. 8).
6 (Information) : Displays music information
if the file contains them.
7 (Elapsed playback time): You can jump to
specified point with SEARCH button (p. 8).
8 (Progress bar) : Shows progress status of
current song.
9 (Audio level meter): displays current volume level.
1 (Playback status)
2 (Photo file icon)
3 (File number being displayed)
4
(Repeat mode):
Shows current repeat mode (p. 8).
5 (Slide show speed)
BD DVD VIDEO
13
678
245
DVD CD MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
PHOTO
ADVANCED PLAYBACK OPERATION
25 En
PLAYBACK
3
English
Using Bookmark
This allows you to set Bookmark at the specified point of
the video. After Bookmark is set, you can move to the
point you set using this function. You can set up to 12
Bookmarks.
1 Press MARKER during playing back the movie to set
Bookmark. Bookmark number, and the status are
displayed.
2 After Bookmark is set, press DIGEST to display
Bookmark select bar.
3 Press 2/3 to select the Bookmark you want to play
back, then press ENTER.
Press CLEAR to delete the selected Bookmark.
When playback is finished (e.g., ejecting the disc,
pressing twice), Bookmarks are automatically
deleted.
Program play
This allows you to program playback order of audio disc
tracks or DVD chapters.
Press PROGRAM during playback to display the
PROGRAM window to program playback order.
You can program up to 15 tracks/chapters.
Example: Programming the playback order of CD tracks
1 Press PROGRAM during playback.
2 Press ENTER to program playback order.
For audio disc, press 5/a to select a desired track then
press ENTER.
For DVD-Video disc, select a desired title (shown as
TT) and chapter (shown as CH) instead of a track.
To clear a set track, select the track you want to clear,
then press CLEAR.
Press RETURN to cancel the Program play.
3 After programming is finished, press to set and
start program playback.
4 To cancel program play, stop playback completely by
pressing twice.
Using search
This allows you to jump to the specified point during
playback.
1 Press SEARCH during playback. Status bar appears.
2 Press 5/a /2/3 to select one of the item below, then
press ENTER.
:
Title number (shown as )
Chapter number (shown as )
Elapsed title time (shown as )
Elapsed chapter time (shown as )
:
Track number (shown as )
Elapsed track time (shown as )
Elapsed disc time (shown as )
:
File number (shown as )
Elapsed file time (shown as )
3 Press 5/a or number buttons to set/adjust the value of
the focused item, and press ENTER to jump to the
specified point.
4 To close the status bar, press STATUS.
Note
DVD VIDEO
DVD CD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
CD
VIDEO MUSIC
ADVANCED PLAYBACK OPERATION
26 En
Enjoying BONUSVIEW™ and BD-
Live™
This player supports BONUSVIEW (p. 41) (BD-ROM
Profile 1 Version 1.1) and BD-Live (p. 41) (BD-ROM
Profile 2) playback functions.
Functions and playback method vary depending on
the disc. See the guidance on the disc or the supplied
user’s manual.
Using Picture in Picture function
(secondary audio/video playback)
BD-Video that includes secondary audio and video
compatible with Picture in Picture can be played back
with secondary audio and video simultaneously as a small
video in the corner.
While PIP Mark ( ) or Secondary
Audio Mark ( ) is displayed, press
PIP to turn the Picture in Picture
function on/off.
To listen to secondary audio, make sure that the
Audio Output setting (Coaxial/Optical or HDMI) is
set to PCM or Reencode (p. 34).
Depending on the disc, to listen to secondary audio,
you may need to set secondary audio to on on the top
menu of the disc (p. 7).
The secondary audio and video for Picture in Picture
may automatically play back and be removed
depending on the content. Also, playable areas may
be restricted.
Using the feature of BD-Live™
1. Set the Network setting (p. 32).
2. Connect the USB memory device
to this Player (p. 16).
BD-Live data is saved in a USB memory device
connected to this Player. To enjoy these functions,
connect a USB memory device (2 GB or greater and
formatted with FAT 32/16) supporting USB 2.0
High Speed (480 Mbit/s) to the USB port that you
select on Local Storage (p. 30). The default setting is
the USB port on the rear panel.
BUDA folder is created automatically in the USB
memory device when necessary.
If there is insufficient storage space, the data will not
be copied/downloaded. Delete unneeded data or use
a new USB memory device.
Some time may be required for the data to load
(read/write).
Yamaha cannot guarantee that all brands’ USB
memory devices will operate with this Player.
Do not use a USB extension cable when connecting
a USB memory device to the USB port of the player.
Using a USB extension cable may prevent the player
from performing correctly.
3. Play back the disc.
4. Run BD-Live according to the
instructions on the disc.
Regarding playback method of BD-Live contents,
etc., perform the operations in accordance with the
instructions in the BD disc manual.
To enjoy BD-Live functions, perform the network
connection (p. 16) and Network settings (p. 32).
Refer to “BD-Live Connection” (p. 32) regarding the
setup to restrict access to BD-Live contents.
The time required to download the provided
programs into the USB memory device connected to
this Player varies depending on the internet
connection speeds and the data volume of the
programs.
BD-Live programs provided through the internet
may not be able to display the connection depending
on the status (upgrading) of the provider. In such
cases, take out the disc and try again.
If the BD-Live screen does not appear for a while
after you select the BD-Live function in the BD disc
menu, the USB memory device may not have
enough free space. In such cases, eject the disc from
the player, and then erase the data in the USB
memory device using the “Format” menu in the
“Local Storage” (p. 30).
Note
Notes
Primary video Secondary video
Notes
Notes
27 En
English
SETTINGS
4
SETTINGS
The SETUP menu enables various audio/visual settings and adjustments for functions using the remote control unit.
SETUP MENU
Menu/Submenu Item Function Page
General Setting
System Screen Saver Sets screen saver on/off. 30
Disc Auto Playback Sets this Player to start disc playback automatically. 30
HDMI Control Sets this Player to receive control signal from the remote
control of your TV/AV receiver.
30
Network Control Sets the control via Ethernet to on/off. 30
Load Default Resets all settings to the default setting except Security
setting.
30
Upgrade Performs upgrade of this Player. 30
Easy Setup Sets language, resolution, screen aspect ratio. 30
Local Storage Displays status of Local Storage (p. 30), formats Local
Storage and selects the front/rear USB port for Local Storage.
30
3D Playback
Message
Displays a warning message concerning 3D video playback
when this Player is turned on.
30
Language OSD Selects the language for On Screen Display. 31
Menu Prioritizes the language for disc menu. 31
Audio Prioritizes the language for audio. 31
Subtitle Prioritizes the language for subtitle. 31
Playback Closed Caption Sets the closed caption to on/off. 31
Angle Mark Sets to display the Angle Mark when BD/DVD with multiple
angles is played back.
31
PIP Mark Sets to display the PIP Mark when BD/DVD with Picture in
Picture is played back.
31
Secondary Audio
Mark
Sets to display the Secondary Audio Mark when BD/DVD
with secondary audio is played back.
31
DivX(R) VOD
DRM
Displays registration code for DivX(R) video.
31
DVD-Audio Mode Sets DVD-Audio mode to DVD-Audio/DVD-Video. 31
Security Change Password Changes password for Parental Control and Country Code. 31
Parental Control Sets the Parental Control depending on the disc content. 31
Country Code Sets your Country Code. 31
Network Internet Connection Sets the internet connection to Enable/Disable. 32
Information Displays network information screen. 32
Connection Test Performs the network connection test. 32
IP Setting Sets the IP setting to Auto/Manual. 32
BD-Live
Connection
Sets the BD-Live connection to Permitted/Partial Permitted/
Prohibited.
32
DLNA Sets the DLNA to Enable/Disable. 32
Proxy Setting Sets the proxy setting. 32
SETUP MENU
28 En
Display Setting
TV 3D Output Selects 3D or 2D videos. 32
TV Screen Sets the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV, and adjust
the video output.
32
Resolution Selects the resolution of output video. 33
TV System Selects the TV System from NTSC/PAL/Multi. 33
Color Space Selects Color Space from RGB/YCbCr 4:4:4/YCbCr 4:2:2/
Full RGB.
33
HDMI Deep Color Selects HDMI Deep Color from 30 bits/36 bits/Off. 33
HDMI 1080p 24Hz Sets HDMI 1080p 24Hz to auto/off. 33
Lip Sync Adjusts the lag between video and audio, such as when the
mouth movement is out of sync with the voice.
33
Video Process Video Mode Adjusts the visual image. 33
Color Adjust Adjusts Brightness/Saturation/Hue for each color. 33
Auto Contrast Adjusts contrast to optimize the played back image. 33
Noise Reduction Sets the level of Noise Reduction. 33
De-interlacing
Mode
Sets how to detect the video signal.
34
Audio Setting
Audio Output Coaxial/Optical Selects the output mode of COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL
terminal from Bitstream/PCM/Reencode/Off.
34
HDMI Selects the output mode of HDMI terminal from Bitstream/
PCM/Reencode/Off.
34
Downsampling Selects the digital audio signal down sampling frequency
from 48k/96k/192k.
34
DRC Sets the DRC (Dynamic Range Compression). 34
SACD Output SACD Priority Selects a contents when Hybrid SA-CD is played back. 34
HDMI Output Selects the output mode of HDMI terminal from DSD/PCM
when SA-CD is played back.
34
Speaker Setting Configuration Sets the audio output of 7.1 ch surround jack. 34
2ch Downmix Selects down mix method to analog 2-ch. 34
Post Process Up Mix Multi-channelizes the 2-channel audio signal. 34
System
Information
Displays software version and MAC address (p. 42).
34
Menu/Submenu Item Function Page
SETUP MENU
29 En
SETTINGS
4
English
Example of SETUP menu
operation
You need to call up the SETUP menu screen to perform
settings for this Player. The following is the explanation
for basic operations of the SETUP menu.
Example: Setting Parental Control
Some items cannot be set during playback. In this
case, press twice to stop playback completely
before setting.
1. Display the SETUP menu screen.
Press SETUP to display the SETUP menu screen.
Press 2/3 to select General Setting, then press
ENTER or a .
2. Select a Submenu.
Press 5/a to select Security, then press ENTER or
cursor 3.
3. Select a menu item.
Press 5/a to select Parental Control, then press
ENTER or cursor 3.
4. Enter password.
Enter your password with number buttons.
The default password is 0000.
You cannot move to the next setting screen until
you have input the correct password.
To change the password, refer to “Change
Password” (p. 31).
5. Select a next item.
Press 5/a to select the Parental Control Level for
BD/DVD, then press ENTER.
6. Exit the menu screen.
Press 2 to return to the previous menu.
Note
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
CLEAR SEARCH
SETUP
PIP
REPEAT
HOME
SETUP MENU
30 En
General Setting
The default settings are marked with “
*
”.
System
Screen Saver
You can set the screen saver to on/off.
When set to on, this Player will switch to screen saver
mode if there is no operation for 3 minutes. After that, this
Player will turn to standby mode when there is no
operation for 6 minutes.
On
*
, Off
Disc Auto Playback
You can set Disc Auto Playback to on/off. When set to on,
a disc will play back automatically after loading.
On
*
, Off
HDMI Control
You can set the Player to receive control signal from a
TV/AV receiver compatible with the HDMI Control
function via an HDMI cable (p. 12).
On, Off
*
Network Control
You can set control via Ethernet to on/off. This player
employs Yamaha Network Control protocol (YNC).
On, Off
*
When set to on, power consumption during standby
mode increases due to network control function.
When set to on, the system startup time is decreased.
Load Default
You can reset all settings of this Player to default setting
except Security setting (p. 31). For details on default
settings, see pages 27-34.
Upgrade
You can upgrade the software manually from Disc, USB
Storage or Network. For details on software upgrade, refer
to “SOFTWARE UPGRADE” (p. 37).
Easy Setup
You can perform Easy Setup (p. 18).
Local Storage
You can display Local Storage information, format Local
Storage, and select Front USB/Rear USB to save the BD-
Live data.
To format (empty) the “BUDA” folder in the USB
memory device, select Information and press ENTER
when “Format” is focused on the screen.
Front USB, Rear USB
*
Local Storage is used as an auxiliary memory when
Blu-ray Disc is played back.
3D Playback Message
You can turn on or off a warning message concerning 3D
video playback that appears on the TV when this Player is
turned on.
On
*
, Off
Using HDMI Control function
Using the HDMI Control function, you can interactively
operate this Player with your TV (HDMI Control
function supported).
When you connect this Player to the TV compatible with
the HDMI Control function using an HDMI cable and
set HDMI Control in the SETUP menu to on (p. 30), you
can perform the function listed below.
• Automatic input select function
When you start playback of this Player, the input
selector of the TV (and an AV receiver if this Player is
connected to the TV via the AV receiver) is switched
to this Player automatically. TV Power is turned on
automatically depending on the TV.
• Automatic power off function
When you turn off the TV while this Player is in stop
mode and the SETUP menu screen is not displayed,
the power of this Player is also turned off
automatically.
HDMI Control function may not work properly
depending on the TV.
Functions other than ones shown above may work
depending on the TV or AV receiver.
In order to make the HDMI Control function
available, set up settings for the HDMI Control
function on ALL components (this Player, TV,
and AV receiver). Certain operation may also be
required.
Each function may be set independently to
activate/deactivate depending on the TV.
Refer to the operation manuals supplied with the
TV and/or AV receiver for details regarding setup.
When set to on, power consumption during
standby mode increases due to HDMI control
function.
Notes
Notes
Hint
SETUP MENU
31 En
SETTINGS
4
English
Language
OSD
You can select the language for On Screen Display which
is the messages or menu displayed on the screen such as
SETUP menu.
English
*
, , , , ,
, ,
Menu
You can prioritize the language for disc menu.
English
*
, , , , , ,
, Portuguese, Danish, , Finnish,
Norwegian, , Korean, Japanese, More
Audio
You can prioritize the audio language for BD/DVD
playback. For details on setting items, see “Menu” (p. 31).
Subtitle
You can prioritize the language for Subtitle.
English, , , , , ,
, Portuguese, Danish, , Finnish,
Norwegian, , Korean, Japanese, More, Off
*
Playback
Closed Caption
You can set to display the closed caption (p. 41) when BD/
DVD with closed caption is played back.
On, Off
*
Angle Mark
You can set to display the Angle Mark ( ) when BD/
DVD with multiple angles is played back.
On
*
, Off
PIP Mark
You can set to display the PIP Mark ( ) when BD with
picture in picture (p. 26) is played back.
On
*
, Off
Secondary Audio Mark
You can set to display the Secondary Audio Mark ( )
when BD with secondary audio is played back.
On
*
, Off
DivX(R) VOD DRM
You can display registration code for DivX(R) video.
DVD-Audio Mode
Some DVD-Audio discs contain the DVD-Video content
in addition to the DVD-Audio content. You can select
DVD-Audio mode or DVD-Video mode.
This setting is only available when no disc is loaded.
Security
Change Password
You can set the password for changing the Parental
Control Level and Country Code. Refer to “Parental
Control” (p. 31) and “Country Code” (p. 31).
The default password is 0000.
If you forget the password, refer to
“TROUBLESHOOTING” (p. 38) and set all the
Security settings to their default settings.
Parental Control
In some BD/DVD discs, a control level for disc viewing is
set depending on the age of the viewer. You can set the
Parental Control shown on the screen depending on the
disc content.
The password (see “Change Password” on p. 31) needs to
be entered before the Parental Control Levels is set.
After you set the Parental Control, when you play back a
disc with level higher than current Parental Control Level,
or you want to change the Parental Control Level, a dialog
box will pop up to ask you to enter the password.
Off*, 1 to 8
Country Code
You can set the Country Code you live in. The password
(see “Change Password” on p. 31) needs to be entered
before the Country Code is set. This setting may be used
for rating of Parental Control and disc playback.
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Svenska Nederlandse
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
DVD-AUDIO
*
Both DVD-Audio/Video contents are played back.
Only the DVD-Audio content may be played back
depending on the disc.
DVD-VIDEO Only the DVD-Video content is played back.
Note
Notes
SETUP MENU
32 En
Network
Internet Connection
Set this item to Enable when you use BD-Live (p. 26), DLNA
(p. 21) and software upgrade from the network (p. 37).
Enable
*
, Disable
Information
You can display network information screen. On this
screen, you can view the information of Interface
(Ethernet), Address Type, IP Address, Subnet Mask,
Default Gateway, and DNS.
Connection Test
You can perform an internet connection test. If the test is
failed, please check “IP Setting” (p. 32) and perform the
test again.
IP Setting
You can configure the network settings.
Numeric keys Enters characters.
2/3 Moves the highlight.
CLEAR Deletes a character.
ENTER Saves the settings and exits from
the menu.
BD-Live Connection
You can set access restriction to BD-Live contents.
DLNA
You can set the DLNA (p. 21) to Enable/Disable. When
you do not use the DLNA function, set to Disable.
Enable
*
, Disable
Proxy Setting
You can set Proxy Setting. Set to Disable for normal use.
Set to Enable to set the proxy setting.
Display Setting
The default settings are marked with “
*
”.
TV
3D Output
You can select 3D or 2D video output from this Player.
Even if you set “3D Output” to “Auto” and play
back a Blu-ray 3D disc, this Player selects 2D
images depending on the connection and the setting
of TV, etc (p. 12).
TV Screen
You can set the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV,
and adjust the video output.
If you switch your TV (i.e. because you have bought a
new one) and the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV
changes, you will have to change the TV Screen setting.
Auto* Select to automatically configure the network
settings of this Player with the DHCP server.
Manual Select to configure the network settings (IP Address,
Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, and DNS) manually.
Hints
Permitted
Allows all BD-Live discs to connect the network.
Partial
Permitted
*
Allows only discs with owner certification.
Prohibited Prohibits all BD-Live discs to connect the network.
Enable Enables proxy host and proxy port setting.
Disable
*
Sets proxy server to disable. Select this item when
proxy server is not used.
Proxy Host Sets proxy host.
Proxy Port Sets proxy port.
Auto* This Player automatically selects 3D or 2D videos.
Off This Player always selects 2D videos.
Note
16:9 Full Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 16:9 screen. When a 4:3 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
16:9 Normal
*
Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 16:9 screen. When a 4:3 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
4:3 Pan Scan Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 4:3 screen. When a 16:9 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
4:3 Letterbox Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 4:3 screen. When a 16:9 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
Original
image size
On 16:9 (wide screen) TV
16:9 Full 16:9 Normal
4:3
Original
image size
On 4:3 TV
4:3 Pan Scan 4:3 Letterbox
16:9
SETUP MENU
33 En
SETTINGS
4
English
Resolution
You can select the video output resolution from Auto,
480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, and 1080p. When set
to Auto, resolution is set to the maximum resolution
according to the connected TV. For more details on output
formats, refer to “About the video output formats” (p. 36).
Auto
*
, 480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p
To output HD audio (such as Dolby TrueHD or
DTS-HD Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set
Resolution to Auto or more than 720p.
TV System
You can select TV System from PAL, NTSC and Multi.
Set the same TV System as your TV set. For more details
on output formats, refer to “About the video output
formats” (p. 36).
Color Space
You can select the Color Space (p. 41) output from
HDMI. This function is available when this Player is
connected with an HDMI cable.
This function is only available on TVs that support
this function.
HDMI Deep Color
When your TV and/or AV receiver is compatible with
Deep Color (p. 41), set this item according to your TV/AV
receiver. This function is available when this Player is
connected with an HDMI cable.
30 bits, 36 bits, Off
*
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
This outputs the BD-Video encoded in 24Hz frame rate in
HDMI 1080p 24Hz. Smoother video playback may be
available with this function. This function is available
when your TV/AV receiver support this function, and this
Player is connected with an HDMI cable. For more details
on output formats, refer to “About the video output
formats” (p. 36).
Auto
*
, Off
This setting is disabled when output resolution is
other than 1080p.
Lip Sync
You can set/adjust the Lip Sync (p. 42) function.
Video Process
Video Mode
You can select Video Mode below.
Color Adjust
You can adjust Brightness/Saturation/Hue for each color
(Red/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan/Magenta). To use this
function, set Video Mode to Custom. For details on the
setting items, see “Video Mode” (p. 33).
The default settings are 0.
Auto Contrast
Adjusts contrast to optimize the played back image.
To use this function, set Video Mode to Custom.
Off
*
, On
Noise Reduction
You can set the Noise Reduction to a level of 0 to 3. 0 is
off, and 3 is the maximum level.
0
*
, 1, 2, 3
Note
NTSC, PAL
*
, Multi
(Australia, Asia, U.K., Europe and Russia
models)
NTSC
*
, PAL, Multi
(U.S.A., Canada, Central and South America,
Taiwan and Korea models)
RGB Outputs video signal at normal signal range.
YCbCr 4:4:4
*
Sets Color Space to YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 4:2:2 Sets Color Space to YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB When RGB is set and white and black on the screen
are too faint, select this item. This setting is effective
when a connected component supports RGB 0-255
range.
Note
Note
Auto* This Player adjusts the Lip Sync function
automatically.
Manual You can adjust the Lip Sync function manually. You
can set the delay of the audio for 2D and 3D contents
independently.
2D
3D
Off This Player does not adjust the Lip Sync function.
Standard* The image is most natural and well-balanced. This
mode suits for normal use.
Vivid The image is more vivid and sharp.
Cinema The image suits for watching movie in dark room.
Custom You can adjust the visual image manually. Press 5 /
a to select the parameter, then press 2 /3 to adjust
the figure.
Brightness
Adjusts the overall brightness of the image.
Sharpness
Adjusts the sharpness of objects in the video.
Hue
Adjusts the tint of the projected image.
Saturation
Adjusts the richness of the color in the projected
image.
Contrast
Adjusts the bright areas (white levels) in the image.
CTI
Smoothes out the edges of color images. Color
images are rendered more distinct.
The default settings are 0.
SETUP MENU
34 En
De-interlacing Mode
You can select how to detect the video signal. Set to Auto
for normal use. When horizontal stripping noise appears
on the screen, set this to Film/Video to remove the noise.
Auto
*
, Film, Video
Audio Setting
The default settings are marked with “
*
”.
Audio Output
Coaxial/Optical
You can select the output mode of COAXIAL jack and
OPTICAL terminal. For more details on output formats,
refer to “About the audio output formats” (p. 35).
HDMI
You can select the output mode of HDMI ternminal. For
details on setting items, see “Coaxial/Optical” (p. 34). For
more details on output formats, refer to “About the audio
output formats” (p. 35).
Bitstream
*
, PCM, Reencode, Off
To output HD audio (such as Dolby TrueHD or
DTS-HD Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set
Resolution to Auto or more than 720p (p. 33).
Downsampling
You can select digital audio signal down-sample
frequency. This function is effective for the audio signal
output from the COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal.
DRC
You can set the DRC (Dynamic Range Compression)
(p. 41) to on/off/Auto. When set to Auto, DRC is
automatically turned on for a source with DRC
information in Dolby TrueHD format. DRC makes the
strong sound such as plosive sound lower, and
conversations more audible. It is useful when you watch
movies in the night.
Off
*
, On, Auto
SACD Output
SACD Priority
You can select a content played back from multi-channel
or stereo (2-channel) contents when a Hybrid SA-CD
(p. 4) including both is loaded.
Multi-ch
*
, 2-ch
HDMI Output
You can select audio signal output from HDMI terminal
when SA-CD is played back.
Speaker Setting
Configuration
You can set the output of 7.1 ch surround depending on
the connected speaker or amplifier.
1 Press 5/a to select a speaker you want to configure,
then press ENTER.
2 Adjust the figures below. Note that some of items are
not displayed depend on the selected speaker.
3 Press RETURN to go back to speaker selection.
2ch Downmix
You can select down mix method to analog 2-ch from
Stereo or Lt/Rt.
Post Process
Up Mix
You can multi-channelize the 2-channel audio signal. To
multi-channelize, select NEO6, then select Cinema or
Music mode.
Off
*
, NEO6
System Information
Software version and MAC address (p. 42) are displayed.
Bitstream
Outputs digital signal without any processing.
Secondary Audio is not output.
PCM Outputs 2-channel PCM.
Reencode
*
Outputs Bitstream with Secondary Audio.
Off Mutes sound.
Note
48k
*
The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
48 kHz.
96k The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
96 kHz.
192k The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
192 kHz.
DSD
*
Outputs DSD raw signal. When this Player is
connected to DSD compatible AV receiver, this item
is recommended.
PCM Outputs PCM signal decoded by this Player.
Size When the woofer section of a speaker is 16 cm (6-1/
2 in) or larger, select Large. When smaller than 16
cm (6-1/2 in), select Small.
Large
*
, Small
Trim -12 to 0 dB (in 0.5 dB step)
The default setting is 0 dB.
Delay 0.5 to 10 m (in 0.5 m step)
The default setting is 3 m.
Disable When selected speaker is not in use, select Yes.
Yes, No
*
Stereo
*
Changes channel output to stereo, which only
delivers sound from the two front speakers.
Lt/Rt Select this item if this unit is connected to a Dolby
Pro Logic decoder. Sound from rear speakers is
mixed to the 2 ch stereo sound.
SETUP MENU
35 En
SETTINGS
4
English
About the audio output formats
* “SA” is a Secondary Audio.
** “BCS” is a button click sound, the sound effect for pop-up menus, etc.
SA-CD output formats
When Coaxial/Optical or HDMI is set to Bitstream, secondary audio is not output. (p. 34)
To output HD audio (such as Dolby TrueHD or DTS-HD Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set Resolution to
Auto or more than 720p (p. 33).
For SA-CD playback, Configuration in Speaker Setting (p. 34) is effective only when HDMI Output is set to
PCM.
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/
7.1 ch
surround
Source format Bitstream PCM Reencode Bitstream PCM Reencode
PCM 2ch PCM 2ch PCM 2ch 2ch
PCM 5.1ch PCM 5.1ch PCM 2ch 2ch/5.1ch
PCM 7.1ch PCM 7.1ch PCM 2ch 2ch/7.1ch
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
PCM up to
5.1ch
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital 2ch/5.1ch
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital
Plus
PCM up to
7.1ch
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital
2ch/7.1ch
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby
TrueHD
PCM up to
7.1ch
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
Dolby Digital
DTS DTS
PCM up to
5.1ch
DTS DTS PCM 2ch DTS 2ch/5.1ch
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
DTS HD High
Resolution
DTS HD High
Resolution
PCM up to
7.1ch
DTS HD High
Resolution
DTS PCM 2ch DTS
2ch/7.1ch
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
DTS
DTS-HD
Master Audio
DTS-HD
Master Audio
PCM up to
7.1ch
DTS-HD
Master Audio
DTS PCM 2ch DTS
with SA
*
or
BCS
**
DTS
SACD Output settings
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/7.1ch
surround
SACD Priority HDMI Output
Multi-ch
DSD DSD up to 5.1ch No output 2ch/5.1ch
PCM PCM up to 5.1ch No output 2ch/5.1ch
2-ch
DSD DSD 2ch No output 2ch/2ch
PCM PCM 2ch No output 2ch/2ch
Notes
SETUP MENU
36 En
About the video output formats
When TV System is set to NTSC
* Depending on the disc or contents, this Player outputs 480p video signal.
When TV System is set to PAL
* Depending on the disc or contents, this Player outputs 576p video signal.
When TV System is set to Multi
When TV System is set to Multi, video signal is output at the same frequency as the source. Refer to the tables above for
details on the frequency setting of the TV and resolution of the output video signal.
While a menu screen such as SETUP menu is displayed, video signal is output at the same frequency as the source.
“Max” in the table means that resolution is set to the maximum resolution supported by the connected TV.
HDMI 1080p 24Hz setting is disabled when output resolution is other than 1080p.
When this Player outputs the 1080p 24 Hz video signal from HDMI, no signals are output from the
COMPONENT and VIDEO jacks.
When commercially-released DVD is played back with component output, maximum resolution is 480p/576p.
When TV System is set to NTSC and video source is not 60 Hz, the video output signal is converted to 60 Hz.
When TV System is set to PAL and video source is not 50 Hz, the video output signal is converted to 50 Hz.
Resolution Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24Hz Others
HDMI
Playback BD
Max Max Max 720p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 60 Hz
others 1080p 60 Hz
COMPONENT
Playback
commercially-
released DVD
480i 480i
480p 480p 480p 480p
Playback BD 480i 480i 480i off 480i
others 480p 720p 60 Hz * 1080i 60 Hz * 1080i 60 Hz *
VIDEO
Playback BD
480i 480i 480i 480i 480i
off
480i
others 480i
Resolution Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24Hz Others
HDMI
Playback BD
Max Max Max 720p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 50 Hz
others 1080p 50 Hz
COMPONENT
Playback
commercially-
released DVD
576i 576i
576p 576p 576p 576p
Playback BD 576i 576i 576i off 576i
others 576p 720p 50 Hz * 1080i 50 Hz * 1080i 50 Hz *
VIDEO
Playback BD
576i 576i 576i 576i 576i
off
576i
others 576i
Notes
37 En
SETTINGS
4
English
Some of the newly released BD discs cannot be played
back unless you upgrade this Player software to the latest
version. We recommend upgrading the software of this
Player with software upgrade so that this Player is
operated based on the latest software.
To check for the availability of a software upgrade, visit
http://download.yamaha.com/downloads/service/top/
?site=europe.yamaha.com&language=en
Software upgrade is automatically started after
loading the disc which contains upgrade file
package.
Do not remove the disc/USB memory device, set this
Player to standby mode or unplug the power cable/
LAN cable while the software upgrade is being
performed.
Upgrading the software
1. Prepare for the software upgrade.
When you upgrade the software from Disc/USB
Storage:
1 Save the upgrade file package to the appropriate
folder on the disc/USB memory device. For more
details, refer to the procedure document attached
with the upgrade file package.
2 Load the disc or connect the USB memory
device.
When the disc is loaded, software upgrade is
started automatically. Skip step 2.
When you upgrade the software from Network:
Confirm that this Player is connected to the
network.
2. Select the upgrade method and
start upgrade from SETUP menu.
1 Press SETUP to display SETUP menu screen.
2 Select General Setting = System = Upgrade.
3 Select the item which contains the upgrade file
package from Disc/USB Storage/Network.
3. The system will search for
upgrade file package.
4. Press ENTER to start upgrade.
5. Upgrade is completed. The system
will restart.
SOFTWARE UPGRADE
Hint
Note
38 En
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Refer to the table below when this Player does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed
below or if the instruction below does not help, turn off this Player, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest
authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
Power
Basic operation
Disc playback
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem Possible causes and solutions
No power. Connect the AC power cable properly.
Press p on the front panel to turn on the power.
The Player power is turned off. The power will be automatically turned off after 10 continuous minutes of inactivity (no
playback).
Problem Possible causes and solutions
The remote control does not work. Use the remote control within its operating range. (p. 5)
Replace the batteries. (p. 5)
Check the ID settings for the main unit and the remote control. (p. 9)
Buttons do not work. Press and hold p on the front panel for around 5 seconds to restart this Player.
To completely reset this Player, unplug the power cable from the AC outlet for 10
seconds or more, plug the power cable to the AC outlet again, and then turn on this
Player.
Password is forgotten.
Press and hold and on the front panel simultaneously when no disc is inserted
and playback is stooped to set the Player to default setting (Security setting (p. 31) is
also reset). After the power is turned off automatically, press p to turn on the power
again.
Problem Possible causes and solutions
The Player cannot play a disc. Take out the disc and clean it. (p. 4)
Make sure that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-side up). (p. 4)
Use a disc supported by the Player. (p. 3)
Remove the disc and then check whether the Player supports the disc or not. (p. 3)
Check the region code. (p. 3)
Check whether the disc is defective by trying another disc.
The CD-R/RW, DVD+R/RW/R DL, and DVD-R/RW/R DL must be finalized. (p. 3)
Video stops. The Player will stop if it senses shock or vibration.
The Player makes a snapping sound
when starting playback or loading a
disc.
These sounds are not malfunctions of the Player but are normal operating conditions.
TROUBLESHOOTING
39 En
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
5
English
Picture
Sound
Problem Possible causes and solutions
No picture. Make sure that the cables are connected correctly. (p. 10)
Make sure that the connected TV or the AV receiver is set to the correct input. (p. 10)
Connect this Player to the TV with VIDEO jack (p. 13) using the supplied video pin
cable and set Resolution properly. (p. 33)
TV System is set to the incorrect setting. Press and hold DIMMER on the remote
control to reset TV System setting to default setting.
Screen freezes and operation buttons
do not work.
Press , then restart playback.
Turn off the power and turn on the power again.
Press and hold p on the front panel for around 5 seconds to restart this Player.
Video is not output with the desired
resolution.
Set to the desired resolution. (p. 33)
Widescreen video appears vertically
stretched, or black bands appear at the
top and bottom of the screen. Or 4:3
video appears horizontally stretched.
Change the aspect ratio of your TV. (p. 32)
Square noise (mosaic) appears on the
screen.
Blocks in images may be visible in scenes with rapid movement due to the
characteristics of digital image compression technology.
The playback screen will be disturbed if
DVD video is recorded to a VCR, or
played back through a VCR.
This Player complies with analog copy protection. Some discs contain a copy
prohibiting signal. If you try to play back such discs through a VCR, or record to a VCR
and play back the signal, the copy protection will prevent normal playback.
Audio is not output, or images are not
played back properly.
The audio may not be output or the images may not be played back properly for some
discs in which copyright-protected contents are recorded.
Problem Possible causes and solutions
No sound, or sound is distorted. Check that the audio cable is connected correctly. (p. 10)
There is no sound during still mode, slow motion playback, fast forward and fast
reverse. (p. 7)
Audio may not be output depending on the audio recording status, such as when audio
other than an audio signal or non-standard audio is recorded for the audio content. (p. 3)
Left and right channels of audio are
reversed, or sound comes out of only
one side.
Check the audio connection. (p. 10)
Audio is not output, or images are not
played back properly.
The audio may not be output or the images may not be played back properly for some
discs in which copyright-protected contents are recorded.
Cannot hear the desired audio type and/
or number of channels.
Refer to Audio Output setting and “About the audio output formats”. (p. 34, 35)
Cannot hear the sound of PIP
(secondary audio).
Set Coaxial/Optical or HDMI to PCM/Reencode. (p. 34)
To hear secondary audio, press 2ND AUDIO. (p. 6)
Depending on the disc, you may need to set secondary audio on the top menu of the
disc. (p. 7)
TROUBLESHOOTING
40 En
Network
Messages on the screen
The following messages appear on the TV screen in case the disc you tried to play back is not appropriate or the
operation is not correct.
Problem Possible causes and solutions
Cannot connect to the Internet. Connect the Network cable properly.
Turn on the connected equipment, such as broadband router or modem.
Connect the broadband router and/or modem properly.
Set the proper value(s) in the network setting. Check “Network”. (p. 32)
Cannot download BD-Live contents. Connect the Network cable properly. (p. 16)
Connect USB memory device properly. Check that the USB memory device is
connected to the USB port of this Player. (p. 16)
Check if the BD disc supports BD-Live.
Check the setting for “Internet Connection”. (p. 32)
Connect the USB memory device formatted in FAT16 or FAT32.
It is recommended to connect the USB memory device with at least 2 GB of free space.
If there is not enough free space, format the USB memory device. (p. 30)
Refer to the supplied user's manual of the disc or consult the disc manufacturer.
Cannot detect the DLNA server. Connect the network cable properly.
Turn on the connected equipment, such as broadband router or the server.
Confirm the Player and the server are connected to the same access point.
Set the proper value(s) in the network setting. Check “Network”. (p. 32)
Depending on the DLNA server, the Player may need to be permitted from the server.
Cannot a play the file on the home
network server.
Make sure the file is playable. (p. 3)
Check your DLNA server’s setting.
The playback and operating quality may be affected by your home network condition.
Error message Possible causes and solutions
Not Support This File! The file is not supported with this Player. See “Types of discs/files that can be used with this Player”
(p. 3).
Wrong region code! The disc is an incompatible region code. See “Region management information” (p. 3).
Network has FAILED. This Player cannot be connected to the network. Check connection (p. 16) and Network setting (p. 32).
Network is OK, proxy has
FAILED.
This Player cannot be connected to the proxy server. See “Proxy Setting” (p. 32).
The Setting is prohibited,
please setup again.
BD-Live connection is prohibited. See “BD-Live Connection” (p. 32).
No valid upgrade file is
found!
Check if the upgrade file is in the appropriate folder.
Upgrade has failed for some
reason!
Upgrade is failed. Check if the upgrade file is corrupted or unreadable.
41 En
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
5
English
AVCHD
AVCHD is a new format (standard) for high definition
video cameras that can be used to record and play high-
resolution HD images.
BD-Live™
BD-Live is a BD standard that utilizes a network
connection, enabling this Player to go online to
download promotional videos and other data.
BDMV
BDMV (Blu-ray Disc Movie, BD-MV) refers to one of
the application formats used for BD-ROM which is one
of the Blu-ray Disc specifications. BDMV is a recording
format equivalent to DVD-Video of the DVD
specification.
Blu-ray 3D™
Blu-ray 3D enables you to view full high definition 3D
images.
BONUSVIEW
BONUSVIEW compatible discs let you simultaneously
enjoy video sub-channel for two screens, audio sub-
channel and sub-titles. A small screen appears within
the main screen during playback (Picture in Picture).
Closed caption
Closed captions are kind of subtitle, and the difference
between subtitles and captions is that subtitles are
intended for hearing persons and captions are for the
hearing impaired. Subtitles rarely show all of the audio.
For example, captions show sound effects (e.g., “phone
ringing” and “footsteps”), while subtitles do not. Before
you select this setting, please ensure that the disc
contains closed caption information.
Color Space
Color Space is a color range that can be represented.
RGB is a color space based on the RGB color model
(red, green and blue) and is typically used for PC
monitors. YCbCr is a color space based on a luminance
signal (Y) and two color difference signals (Cb and Cr).
Deep Color
Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in
displays, up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions
of the HDMI specification. This extra bit depth allows
HDTVs and other displays go from millions of colors to
billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding
for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations
between colors. The increased contrast ratio can
represent many times more shades of gray between
black and white. Also Deep Color increases the number
of available colors within the boundaries defined by the
RGB or YCbCr color space.
DivX®
DivX® is a popular media technology created by DivX,
Inc. DivX® media files contain highly compressed
video with high visual quality that maintains a relatively
small file size. DivX® files can also include advanced
media features like menus, subtitles, and alternate audio
tracks. Many DivX® media files are available for
download online, and you can create your own using
your personal content and easy-to-use tools from
DivX.com.
Dolby Digital
A sound system developed by Dolby Laboratories Inc.
that gives movie theater ambience to audio output when
the product is connected to a Dolby Digital processor or
amplifier.
Dolby Digital Plus
A sound system developed as an extension to Dolby
Digital. This audio coding technology supports 7.1
multi-channel surround sound.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a lossless coding technology that
supports up to 8 channels of multi-channel surround
sound for the next generation optical discs. The
reproduced sound is true to the original source bit-for-
bit.
DRC (Dynamic Range Control)
DRC lets you adjust the range between the loudest and
softest sounds (dynamic range) for playback at average
volume. Use this when it is hard to hear dialog, or
during times when playback may disturb neighbors.
DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
DSD technology stores audio signals on digital storage
media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using DSD, signals
are stored as single bit values at a high- frequency
sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while noise shaping and
oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common
occurrence with very high quantization of audio signals.
Due to the high sampling rate, better audio quality can
be achieved than that offered by the PCM format used
for normal audio CDs.
DTS
This is a digital sound system developed by DTS, Inc.
for use in cinemas.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a new technology
developed for the next generation high definition optical
disc format.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is a lossless audio compression
technology developed for the next generation high
definition optical disc format.
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential is a lossless audio
compression technology developed for the next
generation high definition optical disc format.
GLOSSARY
SPECIFICATIONS
42 En
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is an
interface that supports both video and audio on a single
digital connection. The HDMI connection carries
standard to high definition video signals and multi-
channel audio signals to AV components such as HDMI
equipped TVs, in digital form without degradation.
Letterbox (LB 4:3)
A screen size with black bars on the top and bottom of
the image to allow viewing of wide-screen (16:9)
material on a connected 4:3 TV.
Linear PCM Sound
Linear PCM is a signal recording format used for Audio
CDs and on some DVD and Blu-ray discs. The sound on
Audio CDs is recorded at 44.1 kHz with 16 bits. (Sound
is recorded between 48 kHz with 16 bits and 96 kHz
with 24 bits on DVD discs and between 48 kHz with 16
bits and 192 kHz with 24 bits on BD discs.)
Lip Sync
Lip Sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a
technical term that involves both a problem and a
capability of maintaining audio and video signals
synchronized during post-production and transmission.
Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex
end-user adjustments, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates
an automatic audio and video syncing capability that
allows devices to perform this synchronization
automatically and accurately without user interaction.
Mac address
The Mac address is a unique value assigned to a network
device for identification purposes.
Pan Scan (PS 4:3)
A screen size that cuts off the sides of the image to allow
viewing of wide-screen (16:9) material on a connected
4:3 TV.
Subtitles
These are the lines of text appearing at the bottom of the
screen which translate or transcribe the dialog. They are
recorded on many DVD and BD discs.
Top menu
In a BD-Video/DVD-Video, this is the menu for
selecting things like the chapter to be played back and
the subtitle language. In some DVD-Videos, the top
menu may be called the “Title Menu”.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color reproduces a greater range of color than
before, showing almost all of the colors that the human
eye can detect.
General
Power supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models]...................................AC 110-240 V, 60 Hz
[Central and South America models]................AC 110–240 V, 50/60 Hz
[Europe and Russia models] ..........................................AC 230 V, 50 Hz
[Australia model] ....................................................AC 110-240 V, 50 Hz
[Asia model]...................................................... AC 220–240 V, 50/60 Hz
[Taiwan model] ..................................................AC 110-120 V, 50/60 Hz
[Korea model] ................................................................ AC 220 V, 60 Hz
Power consumption (Normal) .............................................................. 25 W
Power consumption (Standby) .................................................0.5 W or less
Dimensions (W × H × D) ............................................. 435 × 96 × 316 mm
(17-1/8 × 3-3/4 × 12-1/2 in)
Weight ..............................................................................4.05 kg (8.93 lbs.)
Audio performance
Audio output level (1 kHz, 0 dB, BD/DVD/CD-DA).................... 2 ± 0.3 V
Signal to nose ratio (BD/DVD/CD-DA) ..............................115 dB or more
Dynamic range
BD/DVD ...........................................................................105 dB or more
CD-DA ..............................................................................100 dB or more
Harmonic distortion (1 kHz)
BD/DVD ......................................................................... 0.0028 % or less
CD-DA .............................................................................. 0.003 % or less
Frequency response
BD/DVD ............................................ 2 Hz to 22 kHz (48 kHz Sampling)
2 Hz to 44 kHz (96 kHz Sampling)
CD-DA ...............................................................................2 Hz to 20 kHz
Input/output
HDMI output.............................................................. Type A connector × 1
480i/576i/480p/576p/720p/1080i/1080p/1080p@24Hz,
Deep Color, x.v. Color support
Component video output..............................................Y: 1 Vp-p (75 ohms)
P
B, PR: 0.7 Vp-p (75 ohms)
Video output......................................................................1 Vp-p (75 ohms)
Digital output ..........................................................Optical × 1, Coaxial × 1
Analog audio output..................................................................... 7.1 ch × 1,
Mixed 2 ch × 1
USB............................................................................ Type A connector × 2
Other equipments ........................................................ Remote IN/OUT × 1,
RS-232C × 1 (for custom installer),
Ethernet × 1
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
43 En
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
5
English
Copyright
Audio-visual material may consist of copyrighted
works which must not be recorded without the
authority of the owner of the copyright. Refer to
relevant laws in your country.
This item incorporates copy protection technology
that is protected by U.S. patents and other
intellectual property rights of Rovi Corporation.
Reverse engineering and disassembly are prohibited.
Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s:
5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762;
6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929;
7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide
patents issued & pending. DTS and the Symbol are
registered trademarks, & DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master
Audio, and the DTS logos are trademarks of DTS,
Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All
Rights Reserved.
“Blu-ray Disc
TM
”, “Blu-ray
TM
”, “Blu-ray 3D
TM
”,
“BD-Live
TM
”, “BONUSVIEW
TM
”, and the logos
are trademarks of the Blu-ray Disc Association.
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition
Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
“x.v.Color” and “x.v.Color” logo are trademarks.
“AVCHD” and the “AVCHD” logo are trademarks
of Panasonic Corporation and Sony Corporation.
Java and all Java-based trademarks and logos are
trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun
Microsystems, Inc. in the United States and/or other
countries.
This product is licensed under the AVC patent
portfolio license and VC-1 patent portfolio license
for the personal and non-commercial use of a
consumer to (i) encode video in compliance with the
AVC Standard and VC-1 Standard (“AVC/VC-1
Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC/VC-1 Video that
was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal
and non-commercial activity and/or was obtained
from a video provider licensed to provide AVC/VC-
1 Video. No license is granted or shall be implied for
any other use. Additional information may be
obtained from MPEG LA, LLC.
See http://www.mpegla.com.
Windows Media Player is a registered trademark or
trademark of Microsoft corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
DLNA and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks and/
or service marks of Digital Living Network Alliance.
YouTube and the YouTube logo are trademarks of
Google. Inc.
“DivX®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus™ HD and
associated logos are registered trademarks of DivX,
Inc. and are used under license.”
“DivX Certified® to play DivX® and DivX Plus™
HD (H.264/.MKV) video up to 1080p HD and
premium content.”
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX® is a digital video format created by
DivX, Inc. This is an official DivX Certified® device that plays DivX
video. Visit divx.com for more information and software tools to
convert your files into DivX video.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: This DivX Certified® device
must be registered in order to play purchased DivX Video-on-Demand
(VOD) movies. To obtain your registration code, locate the DivX VOD
section in your device setup menu. Go to vod.divx.com for more
information on how to complete your registration.
Precaución-i Es
1 Para asegurar el mejor rendimiento de este aparato, lea
atentamente este manual. Y luego guárdelo en un lugar
seguro para poder consultarlo en el futuro en caso de ser
necesario.
2 Instale esta unidad en un lugar bien ventilado, fresco, seco y
limpio, alejado de la luz directa del sol, fuentes de calor,
vibración, polvo, humedad y/o frío. Para una adecuada
ventilación, permita que el equipo tenga el siguiente espacio
libre mínimo:
Superior: 10 cm
Posterior: 10 cm
Laterales: 10 cm
3 Coloque este aparato lejos de otros aparatos eléctricos,
motores o transformadores, para evitar así los ruidos de
zumbido.
4 No exponga este aparato a cambios bruscos de temperaturas,
del frío al calor, ni lo coloque en lugares muy húmedos (una
habitación con deshumidificador, por ejemplo), para impedir
así que se forme condensación en su interior, lo que podría
causar una descarga eléctrica, un incendio, daños en el
aparato y/o lesiones a las personas.
5 Evite instalar este aparato en un lugar donde puedan caerle
encima objetos extraños y/o donde quede expuesto al goteo o
a la salpicadura de líquidos. Encima de este aparato no ponga:
Otros componentes, porque pueden causar daños y/o
decoloración en la superficie de este aparato.
Objetos con fuego (velas, por ejemplo), porque
pueden causar un incendio, daños en el aparato y/o
lesiones a las personas.
Recipientes con líquidos, porque pueden caerse y
derramar el líquido, causando descargas eléctricas al
usuario y/o dañando el aparato.
6 No tape este aparato con un periódico, mantel, cortina, etc.
para no impedir el escape del calor. Si aumenta la
temperatura en el interior del aparato, esto puede causar un
incendio, daños en el aparato y/o lesiones a las personas.
7 No enchufe este aparato a una toma de corriente hasta
después de haber terminado todas las conexiones.
8 No ponga el aparato al revés. Podría recalentarse y
posiblemente causar daños.
9 No utilice una fuerza excesiva con los conmutadores, los
controles y/o los cables.
10 Cuando desconecte el cable de alimentación de la toma de
corriente, sujete la clavija y tire de ella; no tire del propio
cable.
11 No limpie este aparato con disolventes químicos porque
podría estropear el acabado. Utilice un paño limpio y seco
para limpiar el aparato.
12 Utilice solamente la tensión especificada en este aparato.
Utilizar el aparato con una tensión superior a la especificada
resulta peligroso y puede producir un incendio, daños en el
aparato y/o lesiones a las personas. Yamaha no se hará
responsable de ningún daño debido al uso de este aparato con
una tensión diferente de la especificada.
13 Para impedir daños debidos a relámpagos, desconecte el
cable de alimentación de la toma de corriente durante una
tormenta eléctrica.
14 No intente modificar ni arreglar este aparato. Póngase en
contacto con el personal de servicio Yamaha cualificado
cuando necesite realizar alguna reparación. La caja no deberá
abrirse nunca por ninguna razón.
15 Cuando no piense utilizar este aparato durante mucho tiempo
(cuando se ausente de casa por vacaciones, por ejemplo)
desconecte el cable de alimentación de la toma de corriente.
16 Asegúrese de leer la sección “RESOLUCIÓN DE
PROBLEMAS” antes de dar por concluido que su aparato
está averiado.
17 Antes de trasladar este aparato, pulse p para ponerlo en el
modo de espera, y luego desconecte el cable de alimentación
de CA de la toma de corriente.
18 La condensación se formará cuando cambie de repente la
temperatura ambiental. Desconecte en este caso el cable de
alimentación de la toma de corriente y no utilice el aparato.
19 El aparato se calentará cuando la utilice durante mucho
tiempo. Desconecte en este caso la alimentación y luego no
utilice el aparato para permitir que se enfríe.
20 Instale este aparato cerca de la toma de CA y donde se pueda
alcanzar fácilmente la clavija de alimentación.
21 Las baterías no deberán exponerse a un calor excesivo como,
por ejemplo, el que producen los rayos del sol, el fuego y
similares.
SEGURIDAD CONTRA LA RADIACIÓN LÁSER
Este aparato utiliza rayos láser. Debido a la posibilidad de
que se produzcan daños en los ojos, la extracción de la
cubierta del aparato o las reparaciones solamente deberán ser
realizadas por un técnico cualificado.
PELIGRO
Este aparato emite radiación láser visible cuando se abre.
Evite la exposición directa a los rayos láser. Cuando se
conecte este aparato a una toma de corriente no acerque sus
ojos a la abertura de la bandeja del disco ni a otras aberturas
para mirar al interior.
PRECAUCIÓN: LEA LAS INDICACIONES SIGUIENTES ANTES DE
UTILIZAR ESTE APARATO
Este aparato no se desconecta de la fuente de
alimentación de CA si está conectada a una toma de
corriente, aunque la propia aparato esté apagada con p.
A este estado se le llama modo de espera. En este
estado, este aparato ha sido diseñada para que consuma
un cantidad de corriente muy pequeña.
ADVERTENCIA
PARA REDUCIR EL RIESGO DE INCENDIO O
DESCARGA ELÉCTRICA, NO EXPONGA ESTE
APARATO A LA LLUVIA NI A LA HUMEDAD.
El componente láser de este producto es capaz de emitir
radiación que sobrepasa el límite establecido para la
clase 1.
PRECAUCIÓN
El uso de los controles, los ajustes o los procedimientos
que no se especifican enste manual pueden causar una
exposición peligrosa a la radiación.
Especificaciones LÁSER:
Producto LÁSER de Clase 1
Longitud de onda: 790 nm (CD)/655 nm (DVD)/405 nm (BD)
Salida de láser: máxima de 1 mW
1 Es
1
2
3
4
5
Español
QUÉ PUEDE HACER CON ESTE
REPRODUCTOR ............................................. 2
PIEZAS INCLUIDAS............................................ 2
INFORMACIÓN SOBRE DISCOS Y ARCHIVOS 3
Tipos de discos/archivos que se pueden utilizar
con este reproductor................................................... 3
Para cargar un disco........................................................ 4
Precauciones con los discos............................................ 4
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES ............................. 5
Panel delantero ............................................................... 5
Mando a distancia........................................................... 6
INTRODUCCIÓN A LAS CONEXIONES........... 10
Panel trasero ................................................................. 10
HDMI CONEXIONES ......................................... 12
Conexión con el terminal HDMI.................................. 12
Conexión para la reproducción de discos 3D de
Blu-ray ..................................................................... 12
CONEXIONES DE VÍDEO ................................. 13
Conexión a la toma de vídeo componente.................... 13
CONEXIONES DE AUDIO................................. 14
Conexión con el terminal/toma de audio digital........... 14
Conexión con las tomas de audio ................................. 15
CONEXIÓN DE RED Y USB.............................. 16
Conexión con el terminal NETWORK
y el puerto USB........................................................ 16
OTRAS CONEXIONES...................................... 17
Conexión a las tomas REMOTE CONTROL............... 17
Conexión del cable de alimentación............................. 17
ASISTENTE INICIAL/CONFIGURACIÓN
SENCILLA ..................................................... 18
Configuración con el Asistente inicial/
Configuración Sencilla............................................. 18
MENÚ HOME/MEDIA ........................................ 19
Reproducción de Foto/Música/Vídeo........................... 19
Uso del contenido de red .............................................. 21
USO DE SERVICIOS DE RED .......................... 22
REPRODUCCIÓN DE VÍDEOS DESDE
YouTube™ .................................................... 22
FUNCIONAMIENTO DE REPRODUCCIÓN
AVANZADO ................................................... 23
Menú en pantalla .......................................................... 23
Menú de estado............................................................. 24
Uso de Marcador .......................................................... 25
Reproducción de programa........................................... 25
Uso de la búsqueda ....................................................... 25
Disfrute de BONUSVIEW™ y BD-Live™ ................. 26
Utilización de la función Imagen en Imagen
(reproducción de audio/vídeo secundario) ............... 26
Utilización de la función de BD-Live™....................... 26
MENÚ SETUP.................................................... 27
Ejemplo de funcionamiento del menú SETUP............. 29
Configuración General ................................................. 30
Configuración de pantalla ............................................. 32
Configuración de audio................................................. 34
Sistema de Información ................................................ 34
Formatos de salida de audio.......................................... 35
Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo .................... 36
ACTUALIZACIÓN DE SOFTWARE .................. 37
Actualización del software............................................ 37
RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS...................... 38
Alimentación................................................................. 38
Funcionamiento básico ................................................. 38
Reproducción de disco.................................................. 38
Imagen........................................................................... 39
Sonido ........................................................................... 39
Red ................................................................................ 40
Mensajes en pantalla ..................................................... 40
GLOSARIO ........................................................ 41
ESPECIFICACIONES ........................................ 42
Generalidades................................................................ 42
Rendimiento de audio ................................................... 42
Entrada/salida................................................................ 42
Propiedad intelectual..................................................... 43
(al final de este manual)
Acerca de este manual
Este manual describe cómo utilizar este reproductor
con un mando a distancia, excepto cuando no esté
disponible. También se puede acceder a algunas de
estas operaciones mediante los botones del panel
delantero.
Las notas contienen información importante sobre
seguridad e instrucciones de funcionamiento. Las
indicaciones señalan consejos de funcionamiento.
Este manual se ha impreso antes de la fabricación.
El diseño y las especificaciones están sujetos a cambios
en parte como resultado de mejoras, etc. En caso de
diferencias entre el manual y el producto, este último
tiene prioridad.
Iconos utilizados en este manual
Los iconos se utilizan para indicar botones/funciones
disponibles para un formato particular.
: Vídeo BD
: Vídeo DVD, DVD-VR, DVD+VR, DVD-Audio
: Audio CD, Super Audio CD
: AVCHD, WMV, DivX
: MP3, WMA, WAV
: JPEG
CONTENIDO
1. INTRODUCCIÓN
2. CONEXIONES
3. REPRODUCCIÓN
4. AJUSTES
5. INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
Information about software ....................................i
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
2 Es
INTRODUCCIÓN
* Para conocer los detalles sobre los discos y formatos que se pueden reproducir, consulte la página 3.
** Para utilizar esta función es necesaria la configuración de red.
Asegúrese de que con el producto se han suministrado los siguientes accesorios.
QUÉ PUEDE HACER CON ESTE REPRODUCTOR
Configuración sencilla de idioma, resolución, relación de aspecto
de la pantalla
\ pág. 18
Puede ajustar la configuración de idioma y TV.
Reproducción de discos Blu-ray™/DVD/CD/SA-CD/DVD-Audio
lanzados comercialmente
*
\ pág. 23
Además de Blu-ray Discs™ (discos BD), este reproductor también admite la reproducción de
otros discos diversos.
Reproducción de BONUSVIEW™, BD-Live™, etc.
*
\ pág. 26
Puede disfrutar de películas adicionales en los discos BD más recientes.
Reproducción de archivos de Vídeo, Música, Foto de un disco
*
\ pág. 19
Este reproductor puede reproducir los discos que usted grabe.
Reproducción de archivos de Vídeo, Música, Foto de un disco/
dispositivos de memoria USB
*
\ pág. 19
Con este reproductor se pueden reproducir archivos grabados en discos/dispositivos
de memoria USB.
Reproducción de archivos de Vídeo, Música, Foto de un servidor
doméstico de red
*
**
\ pág. 21
El contenido del PC se puede reproducir en el televisor o el receptor de A/V conectando este
reproductor a un servidor de red.
Funcionamiento con el mando a distancia del televisor,
receptor de A/V, etc.
\ pág. 30
Puede conectar dispositivos con un cable HDMI y controlarlos con un único mando a distancia
utilizando la función Control HDMI.
Transferencia de contenidos de reproducción en los servicios de
red
**
\ pág. 22
Puede disfrutar instantáneamente de vídeos a través de Internet con este reproductor.
PIEZAS INCLUIDAS
Pilas (×2)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
Cable de alimentaciónMando
adistancia
Cable de clavijas
de audio
Cable de clavijas
de vídeo
3 Es
Español
INTRODUCCIÓN
1
Tipos de discos/archivos que se
pueden utilizar con este
reproductor
En este reproductor se pueden reproducir discos
de 12 cm y 8 cm. No utilice un adaptador de 8 cm
a12cm.
Utilice discos que sean compatibles con los
estándares que se indican con la presencia de
logotipos oficiales marcados en la etiqueta del disco.
La reproducción de discos que no cumplan con estos
estándares no está garantizada. Además, la calidad
de imagen o sonido no está garantizada incluso si
tales discos se pueden reproducir.
Los discos y los reproductores de vídeo BD/DVD
tienen códigos de región que dictan las regiones en
las que se puede reproducir un disco.
Las operaciones y funciones de vídeo BD/DVD
pueden ser diferentes de las explicaciones que
aparecen en este manual y algunas operaciones
pueden estar prohibidas debido a las configuraciones
del fabricante del disco.
Si se visualiza una pantalla de menú o instrucciones de
funcionamiento durante la reproducción de un disco,
siga el procedimiento de funcionamiento visualizado.
Según el disco, puede que no sea posible la
reproducción de algunos de los discos de las tablas
de la columna izquierda.
Finalice todos los medios de reproducción que se
reproduzcan en este reproductor.
“Finalizar” hace referencia a un procesamiento del
grabador sobre un disco grabado para que se pueda
reproducir en otros reproductores/grabadores, así como
en este reproductor. Sólo se podrán reproducir en el
reproductor los discos que se hayan finalizado. (Este
reproductor no dispone de función para finalizar discos.)
No se garantiza la reproducción de todos los archivos
del disco, dispositivo de memoria USB y red.
INFORMACIÓN SOBRE DISCOS Y ARCHIVOS
Tipo de disco
Formato
de grabación
Formato
de datos
BD-ROM/BD-R/
BD-RE
Vídeo BD --
DVD-ROM Vídeo DVD/DVD-
Audio
--
DVD-R/DVD-R DL/
DVD-RW
Vídeo DVD/DVD-
VR/AVCHD/disco
de datos
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
DVD+R/DVD+R
DL/DVD+RW
Vídeo DVD/
DVD+VR/AVCHD/
disco de datos
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
CD-ROM CDDA/HDCD --
CD-R/CD-RW CDDA/disco de
datos
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
SA-CD SA-CD --
USB -- DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
Red -- WMV/MP3/WMA/
WAV/JPEG
Información de gestión de la región
Destino Vídeo BD Vídeo DVD
EE.UU. y Canadá Código de región
“A” o “ALL
Número de región
“1” o “ALL”
Asia Código de región
“A” o “ALL
Número de región
“3” o “ALL”
Taiwán Código de región
“A” o “ALL
Número de región
“3” o “ALL”
1
ALL
3
ALL
3
ALL
Corea Código de región
“A” o “ALL”
Número de región
“3” o “ALL”
América Central
y del Sur
Código de región
“A” o “ALL”
Número de región
“4” o “ALL”
Europa Código de región
“B” o “ALL”
Número de región
“2” o “ALL”
Australia Código de región
“B” o “ALL”
Número de región
“4” o “ALL”
Rusia Código de región
“C” o “ALL”
Número de región
“5” o “ALL”
Notas
Información de gestión de la región
Destino Vídeo BD Vídeo DVD
3
ALL
4
ALL
2
ALL
4
ALL
5
ALL
4 Es
INFORMACIÓN SOBRE DISCOS Y ARCHIVOS
Un archivo con propiedad intelectual protegida no se
puede reproducir a través de un dispositivo de
memoria USB o red.
Requisitos de archivos de audio MP3/
WMA/WAV
Frecuencia de muestreo: entre 32 – 48 kHz (MP3/
WMA), LPCM 44,1 kHz/16 bits/estéreo (WAV)
Bitrate: entre 8 – 320 kbps (MP3), 32 – 192 kbps
(WMA)
Requisitos de archivo WMV
WMV9, la resolución máxima es 1.920 × 1.080.
Acerca de Super Audio CD (SA-CD)
Formato de audio basado en los estándares actuales
de CD pero con mayor cantidad de información, lo
que se traduce en un sonido de una calidad superior.
Existen tres tipos de discos: de una capa, de doble
capa e híbridos. El disco híbrido puede reproducirse
en los reproductores de CD existentes y en los
reproductores de Super Audio CD, ya que contiene
información de CD de audio estándar y de Super
Audio CD.
Este reproductor admite la transmisión de datos DSD
a través de HDMI con un receptor A/V compatible.
Esta unidad no muestra los datos de texto incluidos
en los discos en el visor del panel delantero.
Para cargar un disco
Inserte el disco con la etiqueta hacia arriba.
En el caso de un disco grabado por ambos lados,
ponga boca abajo el lado que va a reproducir.
La reproducción podría iniciarse automáticamente,
dependiendo del disco y la configuración del
reproductor.
El menú podrá visualizarse primero, según el disco.
El tiempo para cargar el disco puede variar
dependiendo del disco.
Precauciones con los discos
Tenga cuidado con los arañazos y el
polvo
Los discos BD, DVD y CD son sensibles al polvo, a las
huellas dactilares y especialmente, a los arañazos.
Es posible que no se pueda reproducir un disco con
arañazos. Maneje los discos con cuidado y almacénelos
en un lugar seguro.
Almacenamiento apropiado de los
discos
Precauciones para el manejo
Limpieza de la lente lectora
No utilice nunca discos de limpieza de venta en el
comercio. La utilización de esos discos podría dañar
la lente.
Solicite la limpieza de la lente en el centro de atención
al cliente aprobado por Yamaha más cercano.
Consejo
Nota
1
2
3
Tipo de disco Super Audio CD
Disco de una
capa
Capa de HD
Disco de doble
capa
Disco de capa
híbrida
Capa de HD
Capa de CD
Capa de HD
Disco Super Audio CD híbrido
Capa de CD que se reproduce
en cualquier reproductor de CD
- DSD estéreo de alta calidad
- DSD multicanal de alta calidad
Capa de alta densidad que
Notas
Ponga el disco en el centro de la caja
y almacene la caja y el disco en posición
vertical.
Evite guardar los discos en lugares con luz
solar directa, cerca de dispositivos de
calefacción o en lugares con alta humedad.
No deje caer los discos ni los someta
a vibraciones o impactos fuertes.
Evite almacenar los discos en lugares
donde haya mucha cantidad de polvo
o humedad
Si la superficie tiene manchas, límpiela
suavemente con un paño suave
humedecido (con agua solamente).
Cuando limpie los discos, mueva siempre
el paño desde el orificio central hacia el
borde exterior.
No utilice pulverizadores de limpieza de
discos de vinilo, bencina, diluyente,
líquidos para prevención de electricidad
estática u otros disolventes.
No toque la superficie.
No adhiera papel ni etiquetas adhesivas en el disco.
Si la superficie de reproducción de un disco está
manchada o raspada, el reproductor podrá decidir
que el disco es incompatible y expulsar la bandeja
portadiscos, o podría no reproducir el disco
correctamente. Limpie cualquier mancha de la
superficie de reproducción con un paño suave.
5 Es
Español
INTRODUCCIÓN
1
Panel delantero
1 p (Encendido/En espera)
2 Puerto USB (pág. 16)
3 Indicador SA-CD: Se enciende cuando se carga un
SA-CD y se selecciona la capa SA-CD (pág. 4).
4 Visor del panel delantero
5 Bandeja portadiscos (pág. 4)
6 (Expulsar): Abre/cierra la bandeja portadiscos.
7 (Búsqueda hacia atrás/Salto hacia
atrás): Pulse para saltar hacia atrás y mantenga
pulsado para buscar hacia atrás.
8 (Búsqueda hacia adelante/Salto
hacia adelante):
Pulse para saltar hacia adelante y mantenga pulsado
para buscar hacia adelante.
9 (Reproducción)
0 (Pausa)
A (Detener)
B PURE DIRECT: Pulse esta opción para cambiar el
modo Pure Direct (pág. 7) a modo 1/modo 2/
desactivado. Este botón se enciende cuando el modo
Pure Direct se sitúa en modo 1/modo 2.
Instalación de las pilas en el mando
a distancia
No someta al mando a distancia a golpes, agua ni
humedad excesiva.
El mando a distancia podría no funcionar si el sensor
del reproductor está expuesto a la luz solar directa
o cualquier otra luz fuerte.
El uso incorrecto de las pilas puede provocar que
revienten o tengan fugas. Lea las advertencias para
las pilas y utilícelas correctamente.
No mezcle pilas viejas y nuevas, ni mezcle diferentes
marcas.
Extraiga las pilas si no va a utilizar el mando
a distancia durante un periodo de tiempo prolongado.
Deshágase de las pilas según la normativa de su
región.
Alcance aproximado de funcionamiento
del mando a distancia
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES
2 5 61 43 7 8 9 0 A B
Notas
1
3
2
30˚30˚
Sensor del mando a distancia
6 m
6 Es
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES
Mando a distancia
En la esquina superior izquierda de la pantalla aparecerá
cuando la tecla pulsada no esté disponible.
1 Transmisor de señales infrarrojas: Emite la
señal infrarroja. Oriente esta ventana al sensor del
mando a distancia (pág. 5).
2 MARKER : Establece un Marcador
(pág. 25) en un punto especificado de una película.
Tras definir un Marcador, para seleccionar el punto de
ajuste al que desea saltar, pulse DIGEST. Puede definir
hasta 12 marcadores.
3 : Abre/cierra la bandeja portadiscos.
4 PROGRAM : Establece el orden de
reproducción (pág. 25). Puede configurar hasta
15 pistas (para discos de audio) o títulos/capítulos
(Vídeo DVD).
5 Teclas de colores : Utilice estas teclas según
las instrucciones en pantalla.
6 Teclas numéricas: Permiten introducir números,
o durante la reproducción, saltar a la pista/capítulo
correspondiente al número introducido. Es posible que
estos botones no estén disponibles en función del tipo
de disco y la situación de reproducción.
7 CLEAR: Borra el número introducido o elemento
establecido.
8 SETUP: Muestra la pantalla de menú SETUP
(pág. 27).
9 PIP : Permite encender/apagar la función Imagen
en imagen (pág. 26). Marca PIP ( ) se muestra en
pantalla cuando esta función está disponible. También
puede seleccionar este elemento desde el menú en
pantalla (pág. 23).
Marca PIP se muestra sólo cuando la Marca PIP está
encendida (pág. 31).
0 2ND AUDIO : Selecciona el audio secundario de
la función Imagen en imagen (pág. 26) o los
comentarios de audio. Cuando esta función está
disponible se muestra en pantalla Marca Audio
Secundario ( ) (pág. 34). También puede
seleccionar este elemento desde el menú en pantalla
(pág. 23).
Marca Audio Secundario se muestra sólo cuando la
Marca Audio Secundario está encendida (pág. 31).
Nota
Nota
Nota
DVD
VIDEO
DVD CD
BD
BD
BD
7 Es
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES
Español
INTRODUCCIÓN
1
A TOP MENU : Muestra la pantalla de
menú principal (pág. 42) si el disco contiene un menú.
Seleccione el elemento deseado mediante 5/a /2/3
y ENTER.
Las operaciones concretas pueden diferir dependiendo
del disco. Siga las instrucciones de cada pantalla
de menú,
B Teclas de cursor (5 /a /2 /3): Permiten mover la
selección en la pantalla de menú.
ENTER: Elige el menú/elemento seleccionado.
C
RETURN:
Permite volver al menú o pantalla anterior, etc.
D SUBTITLE : Permite cambiar
el idioma de los subtítulos (pág. 42) si está disponible.
También puede seleccionar este elemento desde el
menú en pantalla (pág. 23).
E STATUS: Muestra la información de reproducción
(pág. 24).
F Teclas de control
/
:
Permite buscar hacia atrás/hacia adelante. La
velocidad de búsqueda cambiará cada vez que pulse la
techa (buscar hacia atrás/adelante: 5 pasos cada una).
Pulse para reanudar la reproducción normal.
: Permite cambiar la velocidad de un pase de
diapositivas (más lento/más rápido: 3 pasos).
/ :
Manténgalo pulsado para realizar una búsqueda o una
repetición instantánea. La búsqueda instantánea salta
30 segundos en el contenido. La repetición instantánea
reproduce el contenido desde 10 segundos antes.
/: Permite saltar hacia atrás/hacia adelante.
:
Detiene la reproducción. Para detener la
reproducción completamente, pulse este botón dos veces.
: Pausa la reproducción.
: Reproduce el contenido.
()/ ()
: Realiza una ejecución lenta hacia atrás/
hacia adelante. La velocidad de reproducción lenta
cambiará cada vez que pulse la tecla (reproducción
lenta hacia atrás/adelante: 4 pasos cada una).
Estos botones también permiten la reproducción de
avance/retroceso de fotograma durante la pausa.
Pulse para reanudar la reproducción normal.
Muchos discos de DVD-Audio permiten reproducir
pases de diapositivas y girar páginas. Pulse / para
pasar a una página anterior o siguiente. Esta función
sirve solamente para los DVD-Audio.
Algunos discos BD/DVD no son compatibles con la
reproducción de avance/retroceso de fotograma.
En función del disco, el reproductor reanuda la
reproducción desde el punto en el que se paró
anteriormente el reproductor. Para reproducir desde
el principio, pulse dos veces y después .
G SA-CD/CD: Cambia la capa de reproducción de un
SA-CD híbrido entre SA-CD y CD (pág. 4).
El indicador SA-CD/CD (pág. 5), situado en el panel
delantero, se enciende cuando se carga un SA-CD
y se selecciona la capa SA-CD (pág. 34).
Las señales de audio solamente se emiten desde las
tomas AUDIO OUT (pág. 11) si la capa SA-CD está
seleccionada.
No es posible reproducir en este reproductor señales
de audio grabadas en formato DSD multicanal.
H PURE DIRECT: Permite cambiar el modo Pure
Direct. El modo Pure Direct mostrado a continuación
cambiará cada vez que se pulse el botón. El modo Pure
Direct mejora la calidad del sonido. En el panel
delantero, se enciende PURE DIRECT cuando el
modo Pure Direct está en modo 1/modo 2.
Modo 1:
el panel delantero se apaga y no se emiten
señales de vídeo. Este modo es ideal para escuchar audio.
Modo 2: el visor del panel delantero se apaga y no se
emiten las señales de vídeo que no sean del terminal
HDMI. Este modo es adecuado para ver películas con
sonido de alta calidad.
desactivado: Reproducción normal.
I DIMMER: Cambia el brillo del visor del panel
delantero en 5 pasos.
J
DIGEST :
Muestra 12 fotografías en
miniatura. Cuando se muestran las miniaturas, puede
continuar a la página siguiente o anterior con / .
: Muestra la barra de selección
Marcador (pág. 25).
K
p
:
Enciende el reproductor o lo pone en modo de espera.
L ZOOM : Ampliar/reducir
zoom. El tamaño de la pantalla cambiará cada vez que
pulse la tecla (ampliar/reducir zoom: 3 pasos cada uno).
Nota
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
Notas
Consejo
Notas
PHOTO
DVD VIDEO
DVD VIDEO PHOTO
Continúa en la página siguiente.
\
8 Es
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES
M SEARCH :
Permite saltar a un punto especificado durante la
reproducción. Para conocer los detalles sobre esta
función, consulte “Uso de la búsqueda” (pág. 25).
También puede seleccionar este elemento desde el
menú de estado (pág. 24).
N HOME: Muestra la pantalla de menú HOME (pág. 19).
O REPEAT
: Permite cambiar el modo de repetición. El
modo de repetición mostrado a continuación cambiará
cada vez que se pulse el botón.
: Permite repetir el título que se está
reproduciendo.
: Permite repetir el capítulo que se está
reproduciendo.
: Permite repetir la carpeta que se está
reproduciendo.
: Permite repetir todas las pistas o los archivos del
disco.
: Permite repetir la pista o el archivo que se está
reproduciendo.
P A/B : Permite
reproducir una parte específica que desee repetir.
1 Pulse A/B en la escena donde desee establecer el
punto inicial. En la pantalla se muestra “A-”.
2 Vuelva a pulsar A/B en la escena donde desee
establecer el punto final. En la pantalla se muestra
“A-B”. Se inicia la reproducción de repetición.
3 Para cancelar la reproducción de repetición, pulse
A/B. “A-B” desaparece y finaliza la reproducción
de repetición.
Es posible que esta función no se pueda realizar
dependiendo de las especificaciones del disco.
Q POP-UP/MENU : Muestra el menú
emergente. Los contenidos del menú que se visualiza
varían en función del disco. Consulte los detalles
sobre cómo ver y operar el menú emergente en el
manual del disco.
La pantalla del menú principal se puede mostrar
pulsando POP-UP/MENU, dependiendo del DVD.
R ON SCREEN: Muestra el menú en pantalla (pág. 23).
S
ANGLE :
Permite cambiar el ángulo de la
cámara si el vídeo se ha grabado con varios ángulos.
Cuando esta función está disponible se muestra en pantalla
Marca de Angulo ( ). También puede seleccionar este
elemento desde el menú en pantalla (pág. 23).
Nota
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
BD DVD
9 Es
CONTROLES Y FUNCIONES
Español
INTRODUCCIÓN
1
Marca de Angulo se muestra sólo cuando la Marca
de Angulo está encendida (pág. 31).
T AUDIO : Permite cambiar el idioma
o formato de audio. También puede seleccionar este
elemento desde el menú en pantalla (pág. 23).
Función ID
Puede modificar el ID del mando a distancia para evitar
una utilización no deseada de otro reproductor Yamaha,
como un reproductor de DVD. Si modifica el ID del
mando a distancia, seleccione el mismo ID para la unidad
principal. La configuración predeterminada es ID1.
1 Configuración del mando a distancia
Para modificar el ID de ID1 a ID2, mantenga
pulsado el botón de color rojo y el botón 2 de los
botones numéricos simultáneamente durante
7 segundos. Para modificar el ID de ID2 a ID1,
mantenga pulsado el botón de color rojo y el
botón 1 de los botones numéricos simultáneamente
durante 7 segundos.
2 Configuración de la unidad principal
Mantenga pulsado y en el
panel delantero simultáneamente durante
2 segundos para mostrar el ID actual si:
No hay ningún disco en el reproductor.
La bandeja portadiscos está cerrada.
Se detiene la reproducción.
“NO DISC” aparece en el visor del panel
delantero.
Mantenga pulsadas las teclas durante 2 segundos
más para cambiar el ID de ID1 a ID2.
Si el mando a distancia está sin pilas durante unos
minutos o si se dejan pilas agotadas en el mando
a distancia, el ID del mando a distancia se ajusta
automáticamente en ID1. Si desea utilizar el mando
a distancia con el ajuste ID2, coloque pilas nuevas
y vuelva a configurar el ID del mando a distancia.
Nota
Nota
BD DVD
10 Es
CONEXIONES
Encuentre el método de conexión que corresponde a su equipo de vídeo/audio. Le recomendamos que utilice el terminal
HDMI que ofrece audio y vídeo digital de alta calidad en una única conexión. Si utiliza los demás terminales/conectores,
conecte el vídeo en primer lugar. A continuación, conecte el audio.
Panel trasero
INTRODUCCIÓN A LAS CONEXIONES
No
¿Utilizar receptor de A/V?
¿Terminal HDMI en el
receptor de A/V? *
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
Conecte el vídeo y el audio al televisor mediante cable HDMI.
Conecte el vídeo al televisor.
Conecte el vídeo al televisor mediante cable HDMI.
Conecte el vídeo al receptor de AV.
Conecte el vídeo y audio al
receptor de A/V mediante cable
HDMI.
Consulte el manual de
instrucciones del
receptor de A/V.
INICIO
* Cuando conecte a un receptor de A/V que no pueda dar salida a la entrada de
sonido a través de su terminal HDMI, consulte el manual de instrucciones del
receptor de A/V.
67 0 A93214 85
11 Es
Español
CONEXIONES
2
1 NETWORK (pág. 16)
2 HDMI (pág. 12)
3 Puerto USB (pág. 16)
4 REMOTE CONTROL (IN/OUT/RS-232C)
(pág. 17)
5 Sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales
(AUDIO OUT) (pág. 15)
6 MIXED 2CH (AUDIO OUT) (pág. 15)
7 VIDEO (pág. 13)
8 COMPONENT (pág. 13)
9 COAXIAL (pág. 14)
0 OPTICAL (pág. 14)
A AC IN (pág. 17)
Conexiones para vídeo
Conecte el audio al
receptor de AV.
Conexiones de vídeo al televisor
Conecte el audio al
televisor.
HDMI (pág. 12)
A
Conexión de audio y vídeo
al receptor de A/V
Conexiones de audio para
el receptor de A/V
Conexiones de vídeo y audio
al televisor
Conexiones de audio al televisor
HDMI (pág. 12)
A’
COMPONENT (pág. 13)
B
VIDEO (pág. 13)
C
al televisor
al receptor de A/V
o
COMPONENT (pág. 13)
B’
VIDEO (pág. 13)
C’
o
COAXIAL (pág. 14)
D
OPTICAL (pág. 14)
E
o
MIXED 2CH (pág. 15)
F
o
COAXIAL (pág. 14)
D’
OPTICAL (pág. 14)
E’
o
MIXED 2CH (pág. 15)
F’
o
HDMI (pág. 12)
A’
Sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales (pág. 15)
G
o
12 Es
Conexión con el terminal HDMI
Puede disfrutar de imagen y sonido digital de alta calidad a través del terminal HDMI.
Conecte con firmeza un cable HDMI (de venta en el comercio) a los terminales HDMI.
Consulte la página 35 para obtener información sobre los formatos de salida de audio/vídeo.
Utilice cables HIGH SPEED HDMI que dispongan del logotipo HDMI (tal como se muestra en la cubierta trasera).
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber finalizado todas las
conexiones.
HDMI CONEXIONES
HDMI IN
Este reproductor
Al terminal
HDMI
Cable HDMI
(de venta en el comercio)
Cuando utilice la función Control HDMI,
consulte “Control HDMI” (pág. 30).
Para más información sobre el modo de salida
del terminal HDMI, consulte “HDMI” (pág. 34).
Si no se muestra la imagen, consulte
“RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS”
(pág. 39).
Conexión para la
reproducción de discos 3D
de Blu-ray
Para disfrutar de discos 3D de Blu-ray en este
reproductor, necesita los equipos y conexiones
siguientes:
Necesita un televisor y un receptor de A/V (en
caso necesario) con funcionalidad 3D.
Todos los componentes deben estar
conectados con cables HDMI.
El disco Blu-ray debe contener imágenes 3D.
Consejos
Receptor de A/V
TV
A A’
Al terminal de entrada
HDMI
13 Es
Español
CONEXIONES
2
Conexión a la toma de vídeo componente
Puede disfrutar de una reproducción de color precisa y de imágenes de alta calidad a través de las tomas de componente.
Conecte con firmeza un cable de vídeo componente (vendido en comercios) o un cable de clavijas de vídeo a la
toma COMPONENT/toma de VIDEO.
Consulte la página 36 para obtener información sobre los formatos de salida de vídeo.
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber finalizado todas las
conexiones.
Si reproduce la imagen mediante una videograbadora, la imagen puede deteriorarse debido a la función de
protección contra la copia.
Para disfrutar de discos BD-3D en este reproductor, necesita conectar un receptor de A/V, un televisor y este
reproductor con cables HDMI. Consulte la página anterior.
CONEXIONES DE VÍDEO
COMPONENT IN
Y
PB
PR
Este reproductor
Cable de vídeo componente
(de venta en el comercio)
Receptor de A/V
TV
(Verde)
(Azul)
(Rojo)
(Verde)
(Azúl)
(Rojo)
A la toma
COMPONENT
A las tomas de entrada
de componente
B B’
(Verde)
(Azúl)
(Rojo)
(Verde)
(Azúl)
(Rojo)
VIDEO
AV INPUT
Este reproductor
Cable de clavijas de vídeo
(suministrado)
Receptor de A/V TV
(Amarillo)
(Amarillo)
(Amarillo)
A la toma
VIDEO
A la toma de entrada
de vídeo
(Amarillo)
C C’
Notas
14 Es
Conexión con el terminal/toma de audio digital
Puede conectar el equipo de audio o el televisor en la toma COAXIAL o el terminal OPTICAL.
Conecte con firmeza un cable de audio digital coaxial (de venta en el comercio) o un cable óptico (de venta en el
comercio) a la toma de audio digital coaxial o al terminal de audio digital óptico.
Consulte la información sobre los formatos de salida de audio en la página 35.
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber finalizado todas las
conexiones.
Para más información sobre el modo de salida de la toma COAXIAL o terminal OPTICAL, consulte “Coaxial/
Optica” (pág. 34).
CONEXIONES DE AUDIO
Consejo
AV INPUT
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
OPTICAL
Este reproductor
Al terminal
OPTICAL
TVReceptor de A/V
Cable óptico
(de venta en el comercio)
Cable de audio digital coaxial
(de venta en el comercio)
Este reproductor
Receptor de A/V
D D’
A la toma
COAXIAL
A la toma de
entrada coaxial
Al terminal de
entrada óptica
TV
D’ E E’
CONEXIONES DE AUDIO
15 Es
Español
CONEXIONES
2
Conexión con las tomas de audio
Puede conectar el equipo de audio o el televisor en las tomas MIXED 2CH/sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales.
Conecte con firmeza cables de clavijas de audio (suministrados o vendidos en comercios) a las tomas MIXED 2CH
o las tomas de sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales.
Consulte la información sobre los formatos de salida de audio en la página 35.
Si desea reproducir audio SA-CD y DVD-Audio multicanal, conecte las tomas de sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales
a las tomas de entrada correspondientes del receptor de A/V mediante cables de clavijas de audio vendidos en
comercios.
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber finalizado todas las
conexiones.
Puede conectar un altavoz de graves directamente a la toma SUBWOOFER. Si conecta el televisor directamente
a este reproductor, conecte un altavoz de graves activo, como el Yamaha Active Servo Processing Subwoofer
System, a esta toma.
Para emitir la señal de audio desde las tomas MIXED 2CH/de sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales, consulte “Ajuste
de altavoz” (pág. 34).
AUDIO
AUDIO IN
LR
A las tomas
AUDIO OUT
MIXED 2CH
Cable de clavijas
de audio
(suministrado)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco) (Rojo)
TVReceptor de A/V
Este reproductor
A la toma de
entrada de audio
F F’
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
MULTICH IN
SURROUND
LR
SURROUND BACK
LR
FRONT
LR
CENTER SUBWOOFER
Receptor de A/V
Este reproductor
G
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
Cables de clavijas de
audio (suministrados
y vendidos en
comercios)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
A las tomas de
sonido envolvente
de 7.1 canales
A la toma
MULTI CH IN
(Blanco)(Rojo) (Blanco) (Rojo) (Blanco) (Rojo)
Consejos
16 Es
Conexión con el terminal NETWORK y el puerto USB
El contenido del PC se puede reproducir conectando este reproductor a la red.
Puede disfrutar de una variedad de contenido con funciones interactivas gracias a la conexión a Internet cuando
reproduzca discos compatibles BD-Live. Consulte la página 26 para obtener información adicional sobre las
funciones de BD-Live.
Puede conectar un dispositivo de memoria USB (2 GB o superior y formateado con FAT 32/16) para BD
Almacenamiento Local al puerto USB del panel posterior (o delantero) del reproductor para guardar los datos
BD-Live o para actualizar el software de este reproductor.
Conecte con firmeza un cable de red (vendido en comercios) y un dispositivo de memoria USB
(vendido en comercios) al terminal NETWORK y al puerto USB.
Utilice sólo un cable de red STP (par trenzado blindado).
Cuando se emplee Internet, se necesita una conexión a Internet de banda ancha como se muestra más abajo.
Conecte el otro conector del cable de red al nodo/enrutador de banda ancha.
Antes de utilizar el dispositivo de memoria USB
Después de la conexión
Para establecer el parámetro de Red manualmente, consulte “Red” (pág. 32).
Para reproducir el contenido del PC en su red, consulte “Uso del contenido de red” (pág. 21).
CONEXIÓN DE RED Y USB
LAN
Este reproductor
Cuando utilice una conexión a Internet de
banda ancha, es necesario un contrato con
un proveedor de servicios de Internet. Para
más información, póngase en contacto con
su proveedor de servicios de Internet más
cercano.
Consulte el manual de manejo de su equipo
ya que el equipo conectado y el método de
conexión pueden variar dependiendo de su
entorno de Internet.
Emplee un cable de red/enrutador
compatible con 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX.
PRECAUCIÓN:
No desconecte el dispositivo de memoria
USB ni desenchufe el cable de alimentación
mientras se estén realizando las operaciones
de BD-Live (pág. 26) o se esté llevando a
cabo la actualización del software.
No utilice un cable de extensión USB
cuando conecte un dispositivo de memoria
USB al puerto USB del reproductor. El uso
de un cable de extensión USB podría
impedir que el reproductor funcione
correctamente.
Yamaha no puede garantizar que todas
las marcas de dispositivos de memoria
USB funcionen con este reproductor.
Notas
Nota
Al terminal
NETWORK
Internet
Módem
Cable de red
(de venta en el comercio)
Nodo o enrutador
de banda ancha
PC
Al puerto USB
Dispositivo de memoria USB
(de venta en el comercio)
Al terminal LAN
Para guardar los datos de
BD-Live en el
dispositivo de memoria
USB del panel frontal,
establezca
Almacenamiento Local
en USB Frontal
(pág. 30).
Consejo
17 Es
Español
CONEXIONES
2
Conexión a las tomas REMOTE
CONTROL
Puede transmitir y recibir las señales del mando
a distancia conectando a las tomas REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT/IN).
Conecte con firmeza cables con mini clavija mono
de 3,5 mm (de venta en el comercio) en los
terminales REMOTE CONTROL (OUT/IN).
Si su receptor de AV es un producto Yamaha y tiene
la capacidad de transmitir señales de control
SCENE, puede controlar el reproductor con
la función SCENE.
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del
reproductor hasta haber finalizado todas
las conexiones.
Para más detalles sobre la función SCENE, consulte
el manual de instrucciones de su receptor de A/V
Yamaha.
Puede conectar un componente Yamaha (como, por
ejemplo, un reproductor de CD) que sea compatible
con la función SCENE a la toma REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT) de este reproductor.
El terminal RS-232C es un terminal de ampliación
de control para usos comerciales. Solicite más
información a su distribuidor.
Conexión del cable de
alimentación
Después de realizar todas las conexiones, enchufe el
cable de alimentación suministrado a la AC IN de la
parte trasera del reproductor. A continuación
enchúfelo en una toma de CA.
PARA PREVENIR EL RIESGO DE DESCARGAS
ELÉCTRICAS, NO TOQUE LAS PARTES SIN
AISLAMIENTO DE NINGÚN CABLE CUANDO EL
CABLE DE ALIMENTACIÓN ESTÉ CONECTADO.
OTRAS CONEXIONES
Consejos
REMOTE CONTROL IN
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
Este reproductor
A la toma
REMOTE
CONTROL (IN)
Cable con mini clavija
mono de 3,5 mm
(de venta en el
comercio)
A la toma de
entrada del
mando
a distancia
Componente Yamaha
A la toma de
salida del
mando
a distancia
Cable con mini clavija
mono de 3,5 mm
(de venta en el
comercio)
Receptor de señales infrarrojas
o componente Yamaha
(por ejemplo, un receptor A/V)
A la toma
REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT)
Nota
A la toma de CA
A AC IN
18 Es
REPRODUCCIÓN
Configuración con el Asistente
inicial/Configuración Sencilla
Asistente inicial/Configuración Sencilla le permite establecer
con facilidad el idioma, la resolución y la relación de aspecto
de pantalla. La pantalla Asistente inicial se muestra cuando
enciende el reproductor por primera vez después de la compra
o actualización. El mismo ajuste se puede realizar desde el
menú SETUP
=
Sistema
=
Configuración Sencilla.
1 Cuando se muestre la pantalla Configuración Sencilla,
pulse ENTER para iniciar Configuración Sencilla.
2 Pulse 5/a para seleccionar el idioma que desea ver en
la pantalla y, después, pulse ENTER.
3 Pulse 5/a para seleccionar la resolución,
a continuación pulse ENTER. Para obtener detalles
sobre la configuración de elementos, consulte
“Resolución” (pág. 33).
4 Pulse 5/a para seleccionar la relación de aspecto de
pantalla, a continuación pulse ENTER. Para más
detalles sobre la configuración de elementos, consulte
“Pantalla de TV” (pág. 32).
La Configuración Sencilla se ha completado.
5 Pulse ENTER para salir de Configuración Sencilla.
Si no se muestra la imagen tras completar Asistente
inicial/Configuración Sencilla, consulte
“RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS” (pág. 39).
Aparecerá un mensaje de advertencia acerca de la
reproducción de vídeo en 3D cuando este
reproductor esté encendido. Pulse ENTER para
descartar el mensaje o CLEAR para desactivarlo
(pág. 30).
ASISTENTE INICIAL/CONFIGURACIÓN SENCILLA
Notas
ENTER
FinalizarAnterior
Configuración
Página: 5/5
Configuración Sencilla
¡ se va a finalizar el asistente !
Ahora presione el botón Finalizar para ir al Menú
Inicio. Por favor, disfrútelo.
19 Es
Español
REPRODUCCIÓN
3
Los menús HOME y MEDIA le permiten examinar y
reproducir archivos multimedia en discos de datos,
dispositivos de memoria USB y su red.
Para conocer los detalles sobre los discos y formatos
que se pueden reproducir, consulte la página 3.
Reproducción de Foto/Música/
Vídeo
Funcionamiento básico
5/a : Mueve la selección.
2: Vuelve a la carpeta principal.
3: Activa/desactiva el archivo/carpeta simple.
HOME: Permite entrar/salir de la pantalla de menú HOME.
ENTER: Confirma la carpeta/archivo.
Iconos sobre el menú MEDIA
: Reproduce el disco que hay en la bandeja o muestra
el contenido del disco de datos.
: Muestra el contenido del dispositivo de memoria
USB conectado al puerto USB.
: Busca un servidor DLNA (pág. 21) en la red.
: Muestra el contenido del servidor DLNA conectado.
Operaciones comunes para la
reproducción de archivos en una
carpeta seleccionada
Ejemplo: Selección de un archivo de película en un
dispositivo de memoria USB
Detenga la reproducción del vídeo antes de
desplazarse a la pantalla de menú MEDIA.
1 Pulse HOME para pasar a la pantalla del menú HOME.
Pulse 2/3 para seleccionar MEDIA y pulse ENTER.
2 Aparece la pantalla MEDIA.
3 Seleccione el elemento que contiene el archivo que
desea reproducir, a continuación pulse ENTER.
MENÚ HOME/MEDIA
Nota
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
2ND
AUDIO
A/B
HOME
Nota
MENÚ HOME/MEDIA
20 Es
4 Seleccione la carpeta Foto, Música, Vídeo o AVCHD
que desea reproducir, a continuación pulse ENTER.
Para volver a la carpeta principal, pulse
2
o seleccione .
Tenga en cuenta que en el siguiente paso sólo se
mostrarán los archivos del tipo que seleccione en
este paso. Por ejemplo, si selecciona la carpeta Foto
en este paso, sólo se mostrarán archivos de fotos
después de este paso. Cuando desee reproducir un
tipo de archivo distinto a foto, vuelva a esta jerarquía
y seleccione de nuevo el tipo de archivo.
5 Seleccione las carpetas que contienen el archivo que
desea reproducir.
6 Seleccione el archivo que desea reproducir,
a continuación pulse ENTER.
Cuando se selecciona un archivo de vídeo se inicia la
reproducción.
Cuando se selecciona un archivo de música, se muestra
la pantalla de estado y se inicia la reproducción.
Cuando se selecciona un archivo de fotografía se inicia
el pase de diapositivas.
Para disfrutar del pase de diapositivas con música,
pulse
HOME
para volver a la pantalla de menú HOME
mientras se reproduce la música y seleccione archivo
de fotos.
Es posible que el archivo mostrado no se reproduzca
dependiendo del contenido.
Operaciones para visualización de
fotos
Mientras se ven fotos los botones del mando a distancia
funcionan como se indica a continuación.
: Detiene el pase de diapositivas y vuelve al explorador
de archivos.
: Establece una pausa en un pase de diapositivas.
: Reproduce un pase de diapositivas.
: Pasa a la fotografía siguiente.
: Pasa a la fotografía anterior.
: Acelera un pase de diapositivas en 3 pasos.
: Ralentiza un pase de diapositivas en 3 pasos.
5: Invierte una foto.
a : Muestra la foto reflejada.
2: Gira una foto en sentido contrario a las agujas del reloj.
3: Gira una foto en el sentido de las agujas del reloj.
ZOOM: Amplía/reduce una foto (ampliar/reducir zoom:
3 pasos cada uno).
5/a /2/3 : Permite desplazarse en modo de zoom
cuando la foto es mayor que la pantalla.
DIGEST: Cambia a modo de miniaturas (pág. 7). Cuando
se muestran las miniaturas, puede continuar a la página
siguiente o anterior con / .
Nota
Consejo
Nota
MENÚ HOME/MEDIA
21 Es
REPRODUCCIÓN
3
Español
Uso del contenido de red
Este reproductor es un reproductor multimedia digital
certificado para DLNA. Puede administrar contenido de
fotos, música y vídeo almacenado en servidores DLNA en
su red doméstica.
Acerca de DLNA
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance) permite compartir
de forma sencilla medios digitales a través de una red
doméstica y puede disfrutar del contenido digital almacenado
en su software, PC instalado, servidor DLNA u otro
dispositivo compatible con DLNA con su TV a través de este
reproductor. Para conectar este reproductor a sus servidores
DLNA se requieren algunos ajustes del dispositivo o del
servidor DLNA. Para más detalles, consulte el software del
servidor DLNA o el dispositivo DLNA.
Reproducción de contenido compartido
1 Para reproducir archivos en el PC, instale un software de
servidor DLNA como, por ejemplo Windows Media
Player 12 y comparta los archivos que desee reproducir.
2 Encienda el PC con el software de servidor DLNA
instalado o el dispositivo DLNA conectado a su red
doméstica.
3 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla de menú HOME.
Seleccione MEDIA para pasar al menú MEDIA. Los
servidores DLNA conectados a la red aparecen en
pantalla.
Si su servidor DLNA no aparece en la lista,
seleccione Buscar DLNA para buscarlo.
Dependiendo del servidor DLNA, es posible que sea
necesario autorizar al reproductor desde el servidor.
Para reproducir el archivo en el servidor DLNA, el
reproductor y el servidor deben estar conectados al
mismo punto de acceso.
Es posible que los requisitos de archivo no siempre
sean compatibles. Podría haber algunas restricciones
dependiendo de las características de los archivos
y de la capacidad del servidor DLNA.
4 Seleccione el archivo que desee reproducir.
La calidad de funcionamiento y reproducción podría
verse afectada por las condiciones de la red doméstica.
Es posible que los archivos de medios extraíbles
tales como dispositivos de memoria USB o unidades
de DVD del servidor de medios no se compartan
correctamente.
Notas
Notas
22 Es
Puede ver instantáneamente los vídeos que proporcionan los servicios de red siguientes.
YouTube
El acceso a contenido suministrado por terceros requiere una conexión de Internet de alta velocidad y también un
registro de cuenta y una suscripción de pago.
Los servicios de contenido de terceros pueden modificarse, suspenderse, interrumpirse o dejar de proporcionarse en
cualquier momento sin previo aviso, y Yamaha no asume ninguna responsabilidad en relación con dichos sucesos.
Es posible que parte del contenido sólo esté disponible para países específicos y que se presente en idiomas
específicos.
Yamaha no representa ni garantiza que los servicios de contenido se seguirán proporcionando o estarán disponibles
durante un periodo de tiempo concreto, y se rechaza cualquier garantía de este tipo, ya sea expresa o implícita.
Puede ver películas desde YouTube a través de Internet
mediante este reproductor.
Los servicios pueden modificarse sin previo aviso.
1 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla de menú HOME.
La pantalla de menú HOME puede variar en función
del modelo.
2 Pulse 5/a /2/3 para seleccionar YouTube, a
continuación pulse ENTER.
Para volver a la pantalla de menú HOME, pulse
RETURN.
USO DE SERVICIOS DE RED
Notas
REPRODUCCIÓN DE VÍDEOS DESDE YouTube™
Consejo
Consejo
EnterSeleccione
23 Es
Español
REPRODUCCIÓN
3
En este capítulo se explica la reproducción de discos BD
y DVD vendidos en comercios, SA-CD, CD y discos
DVD-RW/R grabados.
Para conocer el funcionamiento básico de reproducción,
consulte la página 6.
Menú en pantalla
Para mostrar el menú en pantalla, pulse ON SCREEN.
A continuación, pulse 5/a /2/3 para seleccionar un
elemento, después pulse ENTER para utilizar la función
deseada.
El menú en pantalla consta de los siguientes elementos.
Título : Muestra el número del
título que se está reproduciendo. Puede saltar al título
deseado seleccionándolo desde este elemento.
Capítulo : Muestra el número del
capítulo que se está reproduciendo. Puede saltar al
capítulo deseado seleccionándolo desde este elemento.
Pista/Archivo :
Muestra el número de la pista o archivo que se está
reproduciendo. Puede saltar a la pista o al archivo deseado
seleccionándolo desde este elemento.
Hora : Muestra el
tiempo de reproducción. Seleccione el tipo de
visualización entre los siguientes:
Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido del título,
capítulo, disco, pista o archivo
Tiempo de reproducción restante del título, capítulo,
disco, pista o archivo
Modo/Modo de reproducción
: Muestra el
modo de reproducción actual. Puede seleccionar uno de
los modos de reproducción siguientes:
Normal: Reproducción normal.
Shuffle: Reproducción aleatoria sin repetición.
Aleatorio: Reproducción aleatoria con repetición.
Normal
Shuffle CH (capítulo)
Shuffle TT (título)
Shuffle All
Aleatorio CH (capítulo)
Aleatorio TT (título)
Aleatorio All
Normal
Shuffle F (carpeta)
Shuffle All
Aleatorio F (carpeta)
Aleatorio All
Audio : Muestra el idioma/señal de
audio del disco BD/DVD seleccionado actualmente.
Puede seleccionar el tipo de audio deseado.
Ángulo : Muestra el número del ángulo
seleccionado actualmente. Si el vídeo se ha grabado con
varios ángulos, puede cambiar el ángulo.
Subtítulo : Muestra el idioma de
los subtítulos seleccionados actualmente si hay subtítulos.
Estilo subtítulos : Muestra el estilo de los
subtítulos seleccionados actualmente. Esta función sólo
está disponible para subtítulos externos de archivo de
vídeo. Puede seleccionar el estilo de texto deseado de los
subtítulos.
Bitrate : Muestra el
bitrate de la señal de audio/vídeo.
Video secundario : Activa o desactiva PIP (pág. 6).
Audio Secundario : Activa o desactiva el audio
secundario (pág. 6).
Búsqueda Ins
: Salta 30 segundos.
Repetición Ins
: Reproduce el
contenido desde 10 segundos antes.
Pase de diapositivas :
Muestra la velocidad del pase de diapositivas. Puede
seleccionar la velocidad del pase de diapositivas entre
Lento/Medio/Rápido.
Transición : Muestra cómo aparece la foto en
la pantalla. Puede seleccionar el tipo de transición.
Code Page : Permite seleccionar el código de
caracteres de los subtítulos que ha agregado al vídeo DivX
(pág. 41).
FUNCIONAMIENTO DE REPRODUCCIÓN AVANZADO
Nota
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD VIDEO
CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
CD
DVD
VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
PHOTO
VIDEO
FUNCIONAMIENTO DE REPRODUCCIÓN AVANZADO
24 Es
Menú de estado
Muestra varios ajustes, cómo los subtítulos, el ángulo y el
número de título/capítulo/pista reproducido actualmente.
Para mostrar el menú de estado, pulse STATUS. El menú
de estado consta de los siguientes menús.
Ejemplo: Iconos cuando se reproduce BD
1 (Estado de reproducción)
2 (Icono de tipo de disco/archivo de vídeo)
3 (Número de título que se reproduce): Puede
saltar al título especificado con la tecla SEARCH
(pág. 8).
4 (Número de capítulo que se reproduce):
Puede saltar al capítulo especificado con la
tecla SEARCH (pág. 8).
5 (Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido):
Puede saltar al punto especificado con la
tecla SEARCH (pág. 8).
6 (Subtítulos seleccionados actualmente):
Puede cambiar el idioma de los subtítulos con la
tecla SUBTITLE.
7 (Audio seleccionado actualmente): Puede
cambiar el formato o idioma de audio con la
tecla AUDIO.
8
(Modo repetición):
Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 8).
Ejemplo
: Iconos cuando se reproduce un archivo de música
1 (Estado de reproducción)
2
(Modo repetición):
Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 8).
3 (Icono de tipo de disco/archivo de música)
4 (Gráficos) : Muestra gráficos si están
contenidos en el archivo.
5 (Número de pista/archivo que se
reproduce): Puede saltar a la pista especificada con
la tecla SEARCH (pág. 8).
6 (Información) : Muestra información
musical si está contenida en el archivo.
7 (Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido):
Puede saltar al punto especificado con la tecla
SEARCH (pág. 8).
8 (Barra de progreso) : Muestra el estado de
progreso de la canción actual.
9 (Medidor de nivel de audio): Muestra el nivel de
volumen actual.
1 (Estado de reproducción)
2 (Icono de archivo de fotos)
3 (Número de archivo que se muestra)
4
(Modo repetición):
Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 8).
5 (Velocidad de pase de diapositivas)
BD DVD VIDEO
13
678
245
DVD CD MUSIC
14327
89
65
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
PHOTO
FUNCIONAMIENTO DE REPRODUCCIÓN AVANZADO
25 Es
REPRODUCCIÓN
3
Español
Uso de Marcador
Le permite establecer un Marcador en un punto
especificado del vídeo. Después de establecer el
Marcador, puede saltar al punto utilizando esta función.
Puede definir hasta 12 marcadores.
1 Pulse MARKER durante la reproducción de la película
para definir el Marcador. Se muestran el número de
Marcador y el estado.
2 Después de establecer el Marcador, pulse DIGEST
para mostrar la barra de selección de Marcador.
3 Pulse 2/3 para seleccionar el Marcador que desee
reproducir, a continuación pulse ENTER.
Pulse CLEAR para eliminar el Marcador seleccionado.
Cuando finaliza la reproducción (por ejemplo,
al expulsar el disco o al presionar dos veces),
los marcadores se eliminan automáticamente.
Reproducción de programa
Esta opción le permite programar el orden de reproducción
de las pistas de un disco de audio o de los capítulos de DVD.
Pulse PROGRAM durante la reproducción para mostrar
la ventana PROGRAMA para programar el orden de
reproducción.
Puede programar hasta 15 pistas/capítulos.
Ejemplo: Programación del orden de reproducción de
pistas de CD
1 Pulse PROGRAM durante la reproducción.
2 Pulse ENTER para programar el orden de reproducción.
Para un disco de audio, pulse 5/a para seleccionar
una pista deseada y, a continuación, pulse ENTER.
Para un disco DVD-Vídeo, seleccione un título
deseado (mostrado como TT) y capítulo (mostrado
como CH) en lugar de una pista.
Para borrar una pista establecida, seleccione la pista
que desea borrar y, a continuación, pulse CLEAR.
Pulse RETURN para cancelar la reproducción del
programa.
3 Una vez finalizada la programación, pulse para
definir e iniciar la reproducción del programa.
4 Para cancelar la reproducción del programa, detenga la
reproducción por completo pulsando dos veces.
Uso de la búsqueda
Esta opción le permite saltar a un punto específico durante
la reproducción.
1 Pulse SEARCH durante la reproducción. Aparece la
barra de estado.
2 Pulse 5/a /2/3 para seleccionar uno de los
elementos siguientes, a continuación pulse ENTER.
:
Número de título (mostrado como )
Número de capítulo (mostrado como )
Tiempo de título transcurrido (mostrado como )
Tiempo de capítulo transcurrido (mostrado como )
:
Número de pista (mostrado como )
Tiempo de pista transcurrido (mostrado como )
Tiempo de disco transcurrido (mostrado como )
:
Número de archivo (mostrado como )
Tiempo de archivo transcurrido (mostrado como )
3 Pulse 5 /a o las teclas de número para definir o ajustar
el valor del elemento seleccionado y pulse ENTER
para saltar al punto especificado.
4 Para cerrar la barra de estado, pulse STATUS.
Nota
DVD VIDEO
DVD CD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
CD
VIDEO MUSIC
FUNCIONAMIENTO DE REPRODUCCIÓN AVANZADO
26 Es
Disfrute de BONUSVIEW™ y BD-
Live™
Este reproductor admite las funciones de reproducción de
BONUSVIEW (pág. 41) (BD-ROM Perfil 1 Versión 1.1)
y BD-Live (pág. 41) (BD-ROM Perfil 2).
Las funciones y el método de reproducción varían
según el disco. Siga las indicaciones del disco o del
manual de usuario suministrado.
Utilización de la función Imagen
en Imagen (reproducción de
audio/vídeo secundario)
El Vídeo BD que incluye audio y vídeo secundario
compatible con Imagen en Imagen se puede reproducir
con audio y vídeo secundario simultáneamente como un
vídeo pequeño en la esquina.
Mientras se muestra Marca PIP ( )
o Marca Audio Secundario ( ),
pulse PIP para activar o desactivar
la función Imagen en imagen.
Para escuchar audio secundario, asegúrese de que el
ajuste Salida de audio (Coaxial/Optica o HDMI) se
ha definido en PCM o Recodificar (pág. 34).
Dependiendo del disco, para escuchar audio
secundario, es posible que tenga que activar el audio
secundario en el menú principal del disco (pág. 7).
Dependiendo del contenido, el audio y el vídeo
secundario para Imagen en Imagen pudiera
reproducirse y desaparecer automáticamente.
Además, pudiera haber restricción respecto a las
áreas que pueden visualizarse.
Utilización de la función de BD-
Live
1. Ajuste de la configuración de red
(pág. 32).
2. Conecte el dispositivo de memoria
USB al reproductor (pág. 16).
Los datos de BD-Live se guardan en un dispositivo de
memoria USB conectado a este reproductor. Para
disfrutar de estas funciones, conecte un dispositivo de
memoria USB (2 GB o superior y formateado con
FAT 32/16) compatible con USB 2.0 de alta velocidad
(480 Mbit/s) al puerto USB seleccionado en
Almacenamiento Local (pág. 30). La configuración
predeterminada es el puerto USB del panel trasero.
La carpeta BUDA se crea automáticamente en el
dispositivo de memoria USB cuando es necesario.
Si el espacio de almacenamiento es insuficiente, los datos
no se copiarán/descargarán. Elimine datos innecesarios
o utilice un nuevo dispositivo de memoria USB.
Puede requerirse algún tiempo para que se carguen
(lectura/escritura) los datos.
Yamaha no puede garantizar que todas las marcas de
dispositivos de memoria USB funcionen con este
reproductor.
No utilice un cable de extensión USB cuando conecte un
dispositivo de memoria USB al puerto USB del
reproductor. El uso de un cable de extensión USB podría
impedir que el reproductor funcione correctamente.
3. Reproducción del disco.
4. Ejecute BD-Live siguiendo las
instrucciones del disco.
En relación con el método de reproducción de contenidos
BD-Live, etc., lleve a cabo las operaciones de acuerdo
con las instrucciones del manual del disco BD.
Para disfrutar de las funciones de BD-Live, realice la
conexión de red (pág. 16) y los ajustes de Red (pág. 32).
Consulte la “Conexión BD-Live” (pág. 32) en
relación con la configuración para restringir el
acceso a contenidos BD-Live.
El tiempo que se necesita para descargar los
programas que se ofrecen al dispositivo de memoria
USB conectado en este reproductor depende de las
velocidades de conexión a Internet y del volumen de
datos de los programas.
Los programas BD-Live suministrados a través de
Internet podrían no ser capaces de mostrar la conexión
dependiendo del estado (actualización) del proveedor.
En tal caso, extraiga el disco y vuelva a intentarlo.
Si la pantalla BD-Live no aparece durante un rato
después de seleccionar la función BD-Live en el menú
del disco BD, es posible que el dispositivo de memoria
USB no tenga suficiente espacio libre. En tal caso,
expulse el disco del reproductor y, a continuación, borre
los datos del dispositivo de memoria USB utilizando el
menú “Formato” de “Almacenamiento Local” (pág. 30).
Nota
Notas
Vídeo principal Vídeo secundario
Notas
Notas
27 Es
Español
AJUSTES
4
AJUSTES
El Menú SETUP permite realizar diversos ajustes y configuraciones audiovisuales en las funciones utilizando el mando
a distancia.
MENÚ SETUP
Menú/Submenú Elemento Función Página
Configuración
General
Sistema Protector de
pantalla
Activa/desactiva el protector de pantalla.
30
Reproducción
Automática Disco
Ajusta el reproductor para que inicie automáticamente
la reproducción del disco.
30
Control HDMI Configura el reproductor para que reciba la señal de control
desde el mando a distancia de su receptor de TV/AV.
30
Control de Red Activa o desactiva el control a través de Ethernet. 30
Cargar
configuración
por defecto
Restablece todos los ajustes a los valores predeterminados,
excepto el ajuste Seguridad. 30
Actualizar Realiza la actualización del reproductor. 30
Configuración
Sencilla
Ajusta el idioma, la resolución y la relación de aspecto
de la pantalla.
30
Almacenamiento
Local
Muestra el estado de Almacenamiento Local (pág. 30),
formatea Almacenamiento Local y selecciona el puerto
USB delantero o posterior de Almacenamiento Local.
30
Mensaje
Reproducción 3D
Muestra un mensaje de advertencia acerca de la reproducción
de vídeo en 3D cuando este reproductor esté encendido.
30
Idioma OSD Selecciona el idioma del menú en pantalla. 31
Menú Permite dar prioridad al idioma del menú del disco. 31
Audio Permite dar prioridad al idioma del audio. 31
Subtítulo Permite dar prioridad al idioma de los subtítulos. 31
Reproducción Subtítulos Activa o desactiva los subtítulos. 31
Marca de Angulo Ajuste para mostrar la Marca de Angulo cuando se reproducen
BD/DVD con ángulos múltiples.
31
Marca PIP Ajuste para mostrar la Marca PIP cuando se reproducen BD/
DVD con Imagen en imagen.
31
Marca Audio
Secundario
Ajuste para mostrar la Marca Audio Secundario cuando
se reproducen BD/DVD con audio secundario.
31
DivX(R) VOD
DRM
Muestra el código de registro del vídeo DivX(R).
31
Modo DVD-Audio Ajusta el modo DVD-Audio en DVD-Audio/DVD-Vídeo. 31
Seguridad Cambiar
Contraseña
Permite cambiar la contraseña de Control Paterno y Código
de país.
31
Control Paterno Establece el Control Paterno en función del contenido
del disco.
31
Código de país Establece el Código de país. 31
Red Conexión a Internet Permite definir la conexión a Internet en Permitir/Desactivar. 32
Información Muestra la pantalla de información de red. 32
Prueba de conexión Realiza la prueba de conexión de red. 32
Configuración IP Permite definir la configuración IP en Auto/Manual. 32
Conexión BD-Live Permite definir la conexión a BD-Live en Autorizada/
Permitida Parcialmente/Prohibido.
32
DLNA Permite definir la conexión a DLNA en Permitir/Desactivar. 32
Configuración
Proxy
Permite definir la configuración proxy.
32
MENÚ SETUP
28 Es
Configuración
de pantalla
TV Salida 3D Selecciona vídeos en 3D o 2D. 32
Pantalla de TV Ajusta la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del televisor
conectado, y ajusta la salida de vídeo.
32
Resolución Selecciona la resolución del vídeo de salida. 33
Sistema de TV Permite seleccionar el Sistema de TV entre NTSC/PAL/Multi. 33
Color Space Selecciona el espacio de color entre las opciones RGB/YCbCr
4:4:4/YCbCr 4:2:2/Full RGB.
33
HDMI Deep Color Permite seleccionar HDMI Deep Color entre 30 bits/36 bits/
Desactivar.
33
HDMI 1080p 24Hz Activa o desactiva HDMI 1080p 24Hz. 33
Sincronismo de
labios
Ajusta el retardo entre vídeo y audio, como por ejemplo
cuando el movimiento de la boca no se corresponde con la voz.
33
Procesamiento
de Video
Modo de Vídeo Ajusta la imagen visual. 33
Ajuste de color Ajusta Brillo/Saturación/Tonalidad para cada color. 33
Contraste
automático
Ajusta el contraste para optimizar la imagen reproducida.
33
Reducción de ruido Ajusta el nivel de Reducción de ruido. 33
Modo
desentrelazado
Ajusta cómo detectar la señal de vídeo.
34
Configuración
de audio
Salida de audio Coaxial/Optica Permite seleccionar el modo de salida de la toma COAXIAL/
terminal OPTICAL entre Bitstream/PCM/Recodificar/
Desactivar.
34
HDMI Permite seleccionar el modo de salida del terminal HDMI entre
Bitstream/PCM/Recodificar/Desactivar.
34
Downsampling Permite seleccionar la frecuencia de submuestreo de la señal de
audio digital entre 48k/96k/192k.
34
DRC Define el DRC (Control de gama dinámica). 34
Salida SACD Prioridad SACD Selecciona un contenido cuando se reproduce un SA-CD
híbrido.
34
Salida HDMI Selecciona el modo de salida del terminal HDMI entre DSD/
PCM cuando se reproduce un SA-CD.
34
Ajuste de
altavoz
Configuración Establece la salida de audio de la toma sonido envolvente de
7.1 canales.
34
Mezcla descendente
2 Canales
Selecciona el método de mezcla descendente de 2 canales
analógico.
34
Post-
procesamiento
Mezcla ascendente Convierte la señal de audio de 2 canales en multicanal.
34
Sistema de
Información
Muestra la versión de software y la dirección MAC (pág. 42).
34
Menú/Submenú Elemento Función Página
MENÚ SETUP
29 Es
AJUSTES
4
Español
Ejemplo de funcionamiento del
menú SETUP
Debe llamar a la pantalla de menú SETUP para realizar
los ajustes en el reproductor. A continuación se explican
las operaciones básicas del menú SETUP.
Ejemplo: Ajuste de Control Paterno
Algunos elementos no se pueden ajustar durante la
reproducción. En este caso, pulse dos veces para
detener la reproducción completamente antes de
realizar el ajuste.
1. Muestre la pantalla de menú SETUP.
Pulse
SETUP
para mostrar la pantalla de menú SETUP.
Pulse 2/3 para seleccionar Configuración General,
a continuación pulse ENTER o a .
2. Seleccione un submenú.
Pulse 5/a para seleccionar Seguridad,
a continuación pulse ENTER o el cursor 3.
3. Seleccione un elemento del menú.
Pulse 5 /a para seleccionar Control Paterno,
a continuación pulse ENTER o el cursor 3.
4. Introduzca la contraseña.
Introduzca la contraseña con las teclas numéricas.
La contraseña predeterminada es 0000.
No puede ir a la siguiente pantalla de configuración
hasta que no haya introducido la contraseña correcta.
Para cambiar la contraseña, consulte “Cambiar
Contraseña” (pág. 31).
5. Seleccione un elemento siguiente.
Pulse 5/a para seleccionar el nivel de Control
Paterno para BD/DVD, a continuación pulse ENTER.
6. Salga de la pantalla del menú
Pulse 2 para volver al menú anterior.
Nota
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
CLEAR SEARCH
SETUP
PIP
REPEAT
HOME
MENÚ SETUP
30 Es
Configuración General
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “
*
”.
Sistema
Protector de pantalla
Puede definir el protector de pantalla en activado o desactivado.
Cuando se activa, el reproductor pasará a modo de protector
de pantalla si no se utiliza durante 3 minutos. Posteriormente,
el reproductor pasará a modo de espera cuando no se utilice
durante 6 minutos.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
Reproducción Automática Disco
Puede activar o desactivar la Reproducción Automática
Disco. Cuando se activa, el disco se reproducirá
automáticamente después de cargarlo.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
Control HDMI
Puede ajustar el reproductor para que reciba una señal de
control desde un receptor de TV/AV compatible con la
función Control HDMI a través de un cable HDMI (pág. 12).
Activar, Desactivar
*
Control de Red
Puede activar el control a través de Ethernet. Este
reproductor utiliza el protocolo Yamaha Network
Control (YNC).
Activar, Desactivar
*
Cuando está activado, el consumo de energía durante
el modo de espera aumenta por la función de control
de red.
Cuando está activado, se reduce el tiempo de inicio
del sistema.
Cargar configuración por defecto
Puede restablecer todos los ajustes de este reproductor al
ajuste predefinido, excepto el ajuste Seguridad (pág. 31).
Para conocer detalles sobre los ajustes predeterminados,
consulte las páginas 27-34.
Actualizar
Puede actualizar el software manualmente desde Disc,
USB Storage o Network. Para conocer detalles sobre la
actualización de software, consulte “ACTUALIZACIÓN
DE SOFTWARE” (pág. 37).
Configuración Sencilla
Puede realizar la Configuración Sencilla (pág. 18).
Almacenamiento Local
Puede mostrar información de Almacenamiento Local,
formatear Almacenamiento Local y seleccionar USB
Frontal/USB Trasera para guardar los datos de BD-Live.
Para formatear (vaciar) la carpeta “BUDA” en el
dispositivo de memoria USB, seleccione Información y
pulse ENTER mientras “Formato” está seleccionado en la
pantalla.
USB Frontal, USB Trasera
*
Almacenamiento Local se utiliza como memoria
auxiliar cuando se reproduce el disco Blu-ray.
Mensaje Reproducción 3D
Puede activar o desactivar un mensaje de advertencia
acerca de la reproducción de vídeo en 3D que aparezca en
el televisor cuando este reproductor está activado.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
Utilización de la función Control HDMI
Con la función de Control HDMI, puede operar
interactivamente este reproductor con su televisor
(si soporta la función de Control HDMI).
Cuando se conecta el reproductor al televisor compatible
con la función de Control HDMI mediante un cable HDMI
y se activa el Control HDMI en el menú SETUP (pág. 30),
puede realizar las funciones indicadas a continuación.
Función de selección de entrada automática
Cuando inicie la reproducción en este reproductor, el
selector de entrada del televisor (y de un receptor A/V
si este reproductor esta conectado con el televisor
mediante un receptor A/V) cambia automáticamente
a este reproductor. La alimentación del televisor se
enciende automáticamente dependiendo del televisor.
Función de apagado automático
Si apaga el televisor cuando este reproductor está en
modo de parada y no se visualiza menú SETUP, este
reproductor también se apagará automáticamente.
Es posible que la función de Control HDMI no
funcione correctamente dependiendo del televisor.
Otras funciones, aparte de las que se han
mencionado anteriormente, pueden funcionar
según el televisor o receptor A/V.
Para hacer que la función de Control HDMI esté
disponible, configure los ajustes de la función de Control
HDMI en TODOS los componentes (este reproductor, el
televisor y el receptor de A/V). Es posible que también
sean necesarias determinadas operaciones.
Cada función se puede configurar de forma independiente
para activar o desactivar según el televisor.
Consulte los detalles relacionados con la
configuración en los manuales de funcionamiento que
se proporcionan con el televisor y/o el receptor A/V.
Cuando está activado, el consumo de energía
durante el modo de espera aumenta por la función
de control de HDMI.
Notas
Notas
Consejo
MENÚ SETUP
31 Es
AJUSTES
4
Español
Idioma
OSD
Puede seleccionar el idioma de pantalla, es decir, el menú
o los mensajes mostrados en pantalla como, por ejemplo,
el menú SETUP.
English
*
, , , , ,
, ,
Menú
Puede dar prioridad al idioma del menú del disco.
English
*
, , , , , ,
, Portugués, Danés, , Finlandés,
Noruega, , Corea, Japonés, Más
Audio
Puede dar prioridad al idioma del audio para la reproducción
de BD/DVD. Para obtener detalles sobre la configuración de
elementos, consulte “Menú” (pág. 31).
Subtítulo
Puede dar prioridad al idioma de los Subtítulo.
English, , , , , ,
, Portugués, Danés, , Finlandés,
Noruega, , Corea, Japonés, Más, Desactivar
*
Reproducción
Subtítulos
Puede ajustar que se visualicen los subtítulos (pág. 42)
cuando se reproducen BD/DVD con subtítulos.
Activar, Desactivar
*
Marca de Angulo
Puede ajustar la visualización de Marca de Angulo ( )
cuando se reproducen BD/DVD con ángulos múltiples.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
Marca PIP
Puede ajustar la visualización de Marca PIP ( ) cuando
se reproducen BD (pág. 26) con Imagen en imagen.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
Marca Audio Secundario
Puede ajustar la visualización de Marca Audio Secundario
( ) cuando se reproducen BD con audio secundario.
Activar
*
, Desactivar
DivX(R) VOD DRM
Puede mostrar el código de registro del vídeo DivX(R).
Modo DVD-Audio
Algunos discos DVD-Audio contienen información de
DVD-Vídeo además del contenido de DVD-Audio. Puede
seleccionar el modo DVD-Audio o DVD-Vídeo.
Este ajuste solamente está disponible si no hay
ningún disco cargado.
Seguridad
Cambiar Contraseña
Puede ajustar la contraseña para cambiar el nivel de
Control Paterno y Código de país. Consulte “Control
Paterno” (pág. 31) y “Código de país” (pág. 31).
La contraseña predeterminada es 0000.
Si olvida la contraseña, consulte “RESOLUCIÓN
DE PROBLEMAS” (pág. 38) y configure todos los
ajustes de Seguridad en sus valores predeterminados.
Control Paterno
En algunos discos de BD/DVD, existe un nivel de control
para la visualización del disco en función de la edad del
espectador. Puede ajustar el Control Paterno mostrado en
pantalla en función del contenido del disco.
Es necesario introducir la contraseña (consulte “Cambiar
Contraseña” en pág. 31) antes de ajustar los niveles
de Control Paterno.
Después de ajustar el Control Paterno, si reproduce un
disco con un nivel más alto del nivel de Control Paterno
actual o si desea cambiar el nivel de Control Paterno,
aparecerá un cuadro de diálogo solicitando que introduzca
la contraseña.
Desactivar*, 1 a 8
Código de país
Puede ajustar el Código de país en el que vive.
Es necesario introducir la contraseña (consulte “Cambiar
Contraseña” en pág. 31) antes de ajustar el Código de país.
Este parámetro podría utilizarse para la calificación
de Control Paterno y reproducción de discos.
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Svenska Nederlandse
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
DVD-AUDIO
*
Se reproducen los contenidos de DVD-Audio
y Vídeo. En función del disco, tal vez solamente
pueda reproducirse el contenido de DVD-Audio.
DVD-VÍDEO Solamente se reproduce el contenido
de DVD-Vídeo.
Nota
Notas
MENÚ SETUP
32 Es
Red
Conexión a Internet
Defina este elemento en Permitir cuando utilice BD-Live
(pág. 26), DLNA (pág. 21) y actualice el software desde la
red (pág. 37).
Permitir
*
, Desactivar
Información
Puede mostrar la pantalla de información de red. En esta
pantalla puede ver información de Interfaz (Ethernet),
Tipo de dirección, Dirección IP, Máscara de subred,
Puerta de enlace predeterminada y DNS.
Prueba de conexión
Puede realizar una prueba de conexión a Internet. Si la
prueba falla, compruebe la “Configuración IP” (pág. 32)
y vuelva a realizar la prueba.
Configuración IP
Puede configurar los ajustes de red.
Teclas numéricas
Permiten introducir caracteres.
2/3 Permiten desplazar el elemento
resaltado.
CLEAR Permite eliminar un carácter.
ENTER Permite guardar los valores y
salir del menú.
Conexión BD-Live
Puede definir la restricción de acceso al contenido
de BD-Live.
DLNA
Puede definir la función DLNA (pág. 21) en Permitir/
Desactivar. Cuando no utilice la función DLNA, defínala
en Desactivar.
Permitir
*
, Desactivar
Configuración Proxy
Puede definir Configuración Proxy. Defínalo en
Desactivar para uso normal. Seleccione Permitir para
definir la configuración del proxy.
Configuración de pantalla
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “
*
”.
TV
Salida 3D
Puede seleccionar salida de vídeo en 3D o 2D desde este
reproductor.
Aunque establezca “Salida 3D” en “Auto” y
reproduzca un disco 3D de Blu-ray, este reproductor
selecciona imágenes en 2D en función de la
conexión y del ajuste del televisor, etc. (pág. 12).
Pantalla de TV
Puede ajustar la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del
televisor conectado, y ajustar la salida de vídeo.
Si cambia de televisor, por ejemplo, porque ha adquirido
uno nuevo, y la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del
televisor conectado cambia, también tendrá que cambiar
el ajuste Pantalla de TV.
Auto* Seleccione este valor para configurar
automáticamente los ajustes de red de este
reproductor con el servidor DHCP.
Manual Seleccione este valor para configurar los ajustes de
red (Dirección IP, Máscara de subred, Default
Gateway y DNS) manualmente.
Consejos
Autorizada Permite que todos los discos de BD-Live se conecten
a la red.
Permitida
Parcialmente
*
Permite únicamente los discos con certificación
de propietario.
Prohibido Prohíbe que todos los discos de BD-Live se conecten
a la red.
Permitir Activa los ajustes del host y el puerto proxy.
Desactivar
*
Desactiva el servidor proxy. Seleccione esta opción
cuando no utilice el servidor proxy.
Host Proxy Define el host proxy.
Puerto proxy Define el puerto proxy.
Auto* Este reproductor selecciona automáticamente vídeos
en 3D o 2D.
Desactivar Este reproductor siempre selecciona vídeos en 2D.
Nota
16:9 Lleno Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 16:9. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 4:3, el vídeo
se muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
16:9 Normal
*
Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 16:9. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 4:3, el vídeo
se muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
4:3
Panorámico
Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 4:3. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 16:9, el vídeo
se muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
4:3 Buzón Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 4:3. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 16:9, el vídeo
se muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
Tamaño
de imagen
original
En televisor 16:9 (pantalla
panorámica)
16:9 Lleno 16:9 Normal
4:3
Tamaño
de imagen
original
En televisor 4:3
4:3 Panorámico 4:3 Buzón
16:9
MENÚ SETUP
33 Es
AJUSTES
4
Español
Resolución
Puede seleccionar la resolución de salida de vídeo entre
Auto, 480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i y 1080p. Cuando
se define en Auto, la resolución se ajusta a la resolución
máxima según el televisor conectado. Para obtener
detalles adicionales sobre los formatos de salida, consulte
“Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo” (pág. 36).
Auto
*
, 480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p
Para emitir audio HD (como Dolby TrueHD o DTS-HD
Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI, configure
Resolución como Auto o un ajuste superior a 720p.
Sistema de TV
Puede seleccionar el valor de Sistema de TV entre PAL,
NTSC y Multi. Ajuste el mismo valor de Sistema de TV
que su televisor. Para obtener detalles adicionales sobre
los formatos de salida, consulte “Acerca de los formatos
de salida de vídeo” (pág. 36).
Color Space
Puede seleccionar la salida Color Space (pág. 41) desde
HDMI. Esta función está disponible cuando el reproductor
se conecta con un cable HDMI.
Esta función sólo está disponible en televisores que
admitan dicha función.
HDMI Deep Color
Si su televisor y/o receptor de A/V es compatible con
Deep Color (pág. 41), ajuste este elemento según su
televisor o receptor de A/V. Esta función está disponible
cuando el reproductor se conecta con un cable HDMI.
30 bits, 36 bits, Desactivar
*
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
Permite la salida del Vídeo BD codificado con una velocidad
de fotogramas de 24 Hz en HDMI 1080p 24Hz. Con esta
función es posible que disponga de una reproducción de
vídeo más suave. Esta función está disponible si el receptor
de A/V o el televisor admiten esta función y el reproductor
está conectado con un cable HDMI. Para obtener detalles
adicionales sobre los formatos de salida, consulte “Acerca de
los formatos de salida de vídeo” (pág. 36).
Auto
*
, Desactivar
Este parámetro está desactivado cuando la
resolución de salida es diferente de 1080p.
Sincronismo de labios
Puede definir o ajustar la función Sincronismo de labios
(pág. 42).
Procesamiento de Video
Modo de Vídeo
Puede seleccionar Modo de Vídeo más abajo.
Ajuste de color
Ajusta Brillo/Saturación/Tonalidad para cada color (Rojo/
Verde/Azul/Amarillo/Cian/Magenta). Para utilizar esta
función, configure Modo de Vídeo como Particularizado.
Para obtener detalles sobre la configuración de elementos,
consulte “Modo de Vídeo” (pág. 33).
Los valores predeterminados son 0.
Contraste automático
Ajusta el contraste para optimizar la imagen reproducida.
Para utilizar esta función, configure Modo de vídeo como
Particularizado.
Desactivar
*
, Activar
Reducción de ruido
Puede configurar la Reducción de ruido a un nivel entre 0
y 3. 0 equivale a desactivado y 3 es el nivel máximo.
0
*
, 1, 2, 3
Nota
NTSC, PAL
*
, Multi
(Modelos de Australia, Asia, Reino Unido,
Europa y Rusia)
NTSC
*
, PAL, Multi
(Modelos de EE. UU., Canadá, América
Central y del Sur, Taiwán y Corea)
RGB Permite la salida de la señal de vídeo con el rango
normal de señal.
YCbCr 4:4:4
*
Permite definir Color Space en YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 4:2:2 Permite definir Color Space en YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB Si se ha configurado RGB y el blanco y negro de la
pantalla está demasiado difuminado, seleccione este
elemento. Esta opción se aplica si un componente
conectado admite el intervalo RGB 0-255.
Nota
Nota
Auto* Este reproductor ajusta la función Sincronismo de
labios automáticamente.
Manual Puede ajustar la función Sincronismo de labios
manualmente. Puede establecer el retraso del audio
para contenido 2D y 3D de forma independiente.
2D
3D
Desactivar Este reproductor no ajusta la función Sincronismo de
labios.
Estándar* La imagen es más natural y equilibrada. Este modo
es adecuado para usos normales.
Rico La imagen es más viva e intensa.
Cine La imagen es adecuada para ver películas en
una habitación a oscuras.
Particularizado Puede ajustar la imagen visual manualmente. Pulse
5/a para seleccionar el parámetro, a continuación
pulse 2 /3 para ajustar la figura.
Brillo
Ajusta el brillo global de la imagen.
Nitidez
Ajusta la nitidez de los elementos del vídeo.
Tonalidad
Ajusta el tono de la imagen proyectada.
Saturación
Ajusta la riqueza de color de la imagen proyectada.
Contraste
Ajusta las áreas claras (niveles blancos) de la imagen.
CTI
Suaviza los bordes de las imágenes en color. De este
modo, las imágenes en color se distinguen más.
Los valores predeterminados son 0.
MENÚ SETUP
34 Es
Modo desentrelazado
Puede seleccionar cómo detectar la señal de vídeo.
Defínalo en Auto para uso normal. Cuando aparece en la
pantalla un ruido de desgarro horizontal, configure esta
opción en Película/Vídeo para eliminar el ruido.
Auto
*
, Película, Vídeo
Configuración de audio
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “
*
”.
Salida de audio
Coaxial/Optica
Puede seleccionar el modo de salida de la toma COAXIAL
y del terminal OPTICAL. Para obtener detalles adicionales
sobre los formatos de salida, consulte “Formatos de salida de
audio” (pág. 35).
HDMI
Puede seleccionar el modo de salida del terminal HDMI.
Para obtener detalles sobre la configuración de elementos,
consulte “Coaxial/Optica” (pág. 34). Para obtener detalles
adicionales sobre los formatos de salida, consulte “Formatos
de salida de audio” (pág. 35).
Bitstream
*
, PCM, Recodificar, Desactivar
Para emitir audio HD (como Dolby TrueHD
o DTS-HD Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI,
configure Resolución como Auto o un ajuste
superior a 720p (pág. 33).
Downsampling
Puede seleccionar la frecuencia de submuestreo de
la señal de audio digital. Esta función está activa para
la salida de señal de audio desde la toma COAXIAL/
terminal OPTICAL.
DRC
Puede activar, desactivar o poner en modo Auto el DRC
(Control de gama dinámica) (pág. 41). Cuando se define
en Auto, DRC se enciende automáticamente para una
fuente con información DRC en formatoDolby TrueHD.
DRC hace que los sonidos fuertes como oclusivos suenen
más bajo y que las conversaciones sean más audibles.
Resulta útil cuando se ven películas de noche.
Desactivar
*
, Activar, Auto
Salida SACD
Prioridad SACD
Puede seleccionar un contenido reproducido desde datos
multicanal o estéreo (2 canales) si se carga un SA-CD
híbrido (pág. 4) o los dos.
Multi-ch
*
, 2-ch
Salida HDMI
Puede seleccionar la salida de la señal de audio desde el
terminal HDMI cuando se reproduce un SA-CD.
Ajuste de altavoz
Configuración
Puede definir la salida de sonido envolvente de 7.1 canales
dependiendo del altavoz o amplificador conectado.
1 Pulse 5/a para seleccionar el altavoz que desea
configurar y, a continuación pulse ENTER.
2 Ajuste las cifras siguientes. En función del altavoz
seleccionado algunos elementos no aparecen.
3 Pulse RETURN para volver a la selección del altavoz.
Mezcla descendente 2 Canales
Puede seleccionar 2 canales analógico como método de
mezcla descendente desde Estéreo o Lt/Rt.
Post-procesamiento
Mezcla ascendente
Permite convertir la señal de audio de 2 canales en
multicanal. Para realizar esta conversión, seleccione
NEO6, y seleccione el modo Cinema o Music.
Desactivar
*
, NEO6
Sistema de Información
Se muestran la versión de software y la dirección MAC
(pág. 42).
Bitstream
Permite la salida de la señal digital sin ningún
procesamiento. No se produce la salida del audio
secundario.
PCM Permite la salida de PCM de 2 canales.
Recodificar
*
Permite la salida de Bitstream con audio secundario.
Desactivar Silencia el sonido.
Nota
48k
*
La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 48 kHz.
96k La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 96 kHz.
192k La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 192 kHz.
DSD
*
Emite una señal DSD en bruto. Al conectar el
reproductor a un receptor A/V compatible con DSD,
esta puede resultar una opción útil.
PCM Emite una señal PCM descodificada por este
reproductor.
Tamaño Cuando la parte del altavoz de graves del altavoz
mide 16 cm o más, seleccione Grande. Si es inferior
a 16 cm, seleccione Pequeño.
Grande
*
, Pequeño
Trim -12 a 0 dB (en pasos de 0,5 dB)
La configuración predeterminada es 0 dB.
Retraso 0,5 a 10 m (en pasos de 0,5 m)
La configuración predeterminada es 3 m.
Desactivar Cuando el altavoz seleccionado no se utiliza,
seleccione Sí.
Sí, No
*
Estéreo
*
Cambia la salida del canal a estéreo, con lo que
solamente se emite sonido desde los dos altavoces
frontales.
Lt/Rt Seleccione este elemento si la unidad está conectada
a un descodificador Dolby Pro Logic. El sonido de
los altavoces posteriores se mezcla con el sonido
estéreo de 2 canales.
MENÚ SETUP
35 Es
AJUSTES
4
Español
Formatos de salida de audio
* “AS” es audio secundario.
** “SCB” es el sonido clic del botón, el efecto de sonido de los menús emergentes, etc.
Formatos de salida SA-CD
Si Coaxial/Optica o HDMI se define en Bitstream, no se produce la salida de audio secundario. (pág. 34)
Para emitir audio HD (como Dolby TrueHD o DTS-HD Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI, configure
Resolución como Auto o un ajuste superior a 720p (pág. 33).
Para la reproducción de SA-CD, la configuración de Ajuste del altavoz (pág. 34) solamente tiene efecto si Salida
HDMI está ajustada en PCM.
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/
Sonido
envolvente
de 7.1
canales
Formato de origen Bitstream PCM Recodificar Bitstream PCM Recodificar
PCM 2 canales PCM 2 canales PCM 2 canales 2 canales
PCM 5.1 canales PCM 5.1 canales PCM 2 canales
2 canales/
5.1 canales
PCM 7.1 canales PCM 7.1 canales PCM 2 canales
2 canales/
7.1 canales
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
PCM hasta 5.1
canales
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
2 canales/
5.1 canales
con AS
*
oSCB
**
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital
Plus
PCM hasta 7.1
canales
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
2 canales/
7.1 canales
con AS
*
oSCB
**
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby
TrueHD
PCM hasta 7.1
canales
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby Digital
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
con AS
*
oSCB
**
Dolby Digital
DTS DTS
PCM hasta 5.1
canales
DTS DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
2 canales/
5.1 canales
con AS
*
oSCB
**
DTS HD High
Resolution
DTS HD High
Resolution
PCM hasta 7.1
canales
DTS HD High
Resolution
DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
2 canales/
7.1 canales
con AS
*
oSCB
**
DTS
DTS-HD
Master Audio
DTS-HD
Master Audio
PCM hasta 7.1
canales
DTS-HD
Master Audio
DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
con AS
*
oSCB
**
DTS
Ajustes de salida SACD
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/7.1 canales
sonido envolvente
Prioridad SACD Salida HDMI
Multi-ch
DSD DSD hasta 5.1 canales Sin salida 2 canales/5.1 canales
PCM PCM hasta 5.1 canales Sin salida 2 canales/5.1 canales
2-ch
DSD DSD 2 canales Sin salida 2 canales/2 canales
PCM PCM 2 canales Sin salida 2 canales/2 canales
Notas
MENÚ SETUP
36 Es
Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo
Si Sistema de TV se define en NTSC
* En función del disco o del contenido, este reproductor permite la salida de señal de vídeo de 480p.
Si Sistema de TV se define en PAL
* En función del disco o del contenido, este reproductor permite la salida de señal de vídeo de 576p.
Si Sistema de TV se define en Multi
Si Sistema de TV está configurado como Multi, la salida de la señal de vídeo tiene la misma frecuencia que la fuente.
Consulte las tablas anteriores para obtener información sobre la configuración de frecuencia del televisor y la resolución
de la señal de vídeo de salida.
Si se muestra una pantalla de menú como, por ejemplo, SETUP la salida de la señal de vídeo tiene la misma frecuencia
que el origen.
“Máx.” en la tabla significa que la resolución se ha definido en la resolución máxima admitida por el televisor
conectado.
El parámetro HDMI 1080p 24Hz está desactivado cuando la resolución de salida es diferente de 1080p.
Cuando este reproductor permite la salida de vídeo de 1080p 24 Hz desde HDMI, no se emiten señales desde las
tomas COMPONENT y VIDEO.
Cuando se reproduce un DVD comercial con salida de componente, la resolución máxima es 480p/576p.
Cuando Sistema de TV se define en NTSC y el origen de vídeo no es 60 Hz, la salida de vídeo se convierte a 60 Hz.
Cuando Sistema de TV se define en PAL y el origen de vídeo no es 50 Hz, la salida de vídeo se convierte a 50 Hz.
Resolución Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24 Hz Otros
HDMI
Reproducción
de BD
Máx. Máx. Máx. 720p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 60 Hz
otros 1080p 60 Hz
COMPONENT
Reproducción
de DVD
comercial
480i 480i
480p 480p 480p 480p
Reproducción
de BD
480i 480i 480i desactivado 480i
otros 480p 720p 60 Hz * 1080i 60 Hz * 1080i 60 Hz *
VIDEO
Reproducción
de BD
480i 480i 480i 480i 480i
desactivado
480i
otros 480i
Resolución Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24 Hz Otros
HDMI
Reproducción
de BD
Máx. Máx. Máx. 720p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 50 Hz
otros 1080p 50 Hz
COMPONENT
Reproducción
de DVD
comercial
576i 576i
576p 576p 576p 576p
Reproducción
de BD
576i 576i 576i desactivado 576i
otros 576p 720p 50 Hz * 1080i 50 Hz * 1080i 50 Hz *
VIDEO
Reproducción
de BD
576i 576i 576i 576i 576i
desactivado
576i
otros 576i
Notas
37 Es
AJUSTES
4
Español
Algunos de los discos BD recién lanzados no se pueden
reproducir a menos que actualice el software del
reproductor a la versión más reciente. Le recomendamos
la actualización para que el reproductor funcione con el
software más actual.
Para comprobar la disponibilidad de una actualización de
software, visite
http://download.yamaha.com/downloads/service/top/
?site=europe.yamaha.com&language=en
La actualización del software se inicia
automáticamente tras cargar el disco que contiene el
paquete de actualización.
No saque el disco/dispositivo de memoria USB, no
ponga el reproductor en modo de espera ni
desenchufe el cable de alimentación o el cable LAN
mientras se lleva a cabo la actualización de software.
Actualización del software
1. Prepare la actualización de
software.
Si actualiza el software desde Disc/USB Storage:
1 Guarde el paquete de archivos de actualización en
la carpeta correspondiente en el disco/dispositivo
de memoria USB. Para más información,
consulte el documento de procedimientos adjunto
con el paquete de archivos de actualización.
2 Cargue el disco o conecte el dispositivo de
memoria USB.
Al cargar el disco, la actualización de software
se inicia automáticamente. Omita el paso 2.
Si actualiza el software desde Network:
Confirme que el reproductor está conectado
alared.
2. Seleccione el método de
actualización e inicie la
actualización desde el menú SETUP.
1 Pulse SETUP para mostrar la pantalla de menú
SETUP.
2 Seleccione Configuración General = Sistema =
Actualizar.
3 Seleccione el elemento que contiene el paquete
de archivos de actualización desde Disc/USB
Storage/Network.
3. El sistema buscará el paquete
de archivos de actualización.
4. Pulse ENTER para iniciar
la actualización.
5. La actualización se ha
completado. El sistema se
reiniciará.
ACTUALIZACIÓN DE SOFTWARE
Consejo
Notas
¡ buscando archivo de actualización !
Por favor, espere. . .
Actualizar
38 Es
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
Consulte la tabla inferior cuando el equipo no funcione correctamente. Si el problema que usted tiene no aparece en la
lista inferior o las instrucciones no le sirven de ayuda, apague este reproductor, desenchufe el cable de alimentación
y póngase en contacto con un centro de servicio o concesionario Yamaha autorizado.
Alimentación
Funcionamiento básico
Reproducción de disco
RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
No hay alimentación. Conecte correctamente el cable de alimentación de CA.
–Pulse p en el panel delantero para encender la alimentación.
La alimentación del reproductor
está apagada.
La alimentación se desconectará automáticamente pasados 10 minutos continuos
de inactividad (sin reproducción).
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
El mando a distancia no funciona. Utilice el mando a distancia dentro de su alcance operativo. (pág. 5)
Cambie las pilas. (pág. 5)
Compruebe la configuración de ID de la unidad principal y el mando a distancia. (pág. 9)
Las teclas no funcionan. Mantenga pulsado p en el panel delantero durante unos 5 segundos para reiniciar
el reproductor.
Para reiniciar completamente el reproductor, desenchufe el cable de alimentación de la
toma de CA durante 10 segundos o más, vuelva a enchufarlo y, a continuación, encienda
el reproductor.
Se ha olvidado la contraseña.
Mantenga pulsado y en el panel delantero a la vez si no hay ningún disco
insertado y con la reproducción detenida para situar el reproductor en la configuración
predeterminada (el ajuste de Seguridad (pág. 31) también se restablece). Una vez que la
alimentación se desconecte automáticamente, pulse p para volver a conectarla.
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
El reproductor no puede reproducir
un disco.
Extraiga el disco y límpielo. (pág. 4)
Asegúrese de que se ha cargado correctamente el disco (alineado en la bandeja
portadiscos y con la cara de la etiqueta hacia arriba). (pág. 4)
Utilice un disco admitido por el reproductor. (pág. 3)
Extraiga el disco y compruebe si es un disco admitido por el reproductor o no. (pág. 3)
Compruebe el código de región. (pág. 3)
Compruebe si el disco está defectuoso probando con otro disco.
Los discos CD-R/RW, DVD+R/RW/R DL y DVD-R/RW/R DL deben estar finalizados.
(pág. 3)
El vídeo se para. El reproductor se parará si detecta golpes o vibraciones.
El reproductor hace un sonido
de chasquido cuando comienza
la reproducción o al cargar un disco.
Estos sonidos no son averías sino condiciones normales de funcionamiento
del reproductor.
RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS
39 Es
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
5
Español
Imagen
Sonido
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
No hay imagen. Asegúrese de que los cables están correctamente conectados. (pág. 10)
Asegúrese de que el televisor o receptor de A/V conectado está ajustado a la entrada
correcta. (pág. 10)
Conecte el reproductor al televisor con la toma VIDEO (pág. 13) mediante el cable
de clavijas de vídeo suministrado y definiendo correctamente la Resolución. (pág. 33)
El sistema de TV está mal ajustado. Mantenga pulsado DIMMER en el mando a
distancia para restablecer la configuración predeterminada del sistema de TV.
La pantalla se congela y las teclas
de operación no responden.
Pulse y, después, reinicie la reproducción.
Desconecte la alimentación y conéctela de nuevo.
Mantenga pulsado p en el panel delantero durante unos 5 segundos para reiniciar
el reproductor.
La salida de vídeo no tiene la resolución
deseada.
Ajuste la resolución deseada. (pág. 33)
El vídeo de ancho horizontal aparece
estirado verticalmente, o aparecen
bandas negras en las partes superior
e inferior de la pantalla. O el vídeo 4:3
aparece estirado horizontalmente.
Cambie la relación de aspecto del televisor. (pág. 32)
Aparece ruido cuadrado (mosaicos)
en la pantalla.
Se podrían ver bloques en las imágenes en escenas que contengan movimientos rápidos
debido a las características de la tecnología de compresión de imagen digital.
La pantalla de reproducción
se perturbará si se graba vídeo DVD
en una videograbadora, o se reproduce
a través de una videograbadora.
Este reproductor cumple con la protección contra copias analógicas. Algunos discos
contienen una señal de prohibición de copia. Si intenta reproducir tales discos a través
de una videograbadora, o grabar a una videograbadora y reproducir la señal,
la protección contra copia impedirá la reproducción normal.
No hay salida de audio o las imágenes
no se reproducen adecuadamente.
En algunos discos en los que se ha grabado contenido protegido por derechos de autor
es posible que no haya salida de audio o que las imágenes no se reproduzcan
adecuadamente.
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
No hay sonido o está distorsionado. Compruebe que el cable de audio está correctamente conectado. (pág. 10)
No hay sonido durante el modo de reproducción fija, cámara lenta, avance rápido
y retroceso rápido. (pág. 7)
El audio puede no salir dependiendo del estado de grabación del audio, por ejemplo,
cuando se haya grabado como contenido de audio, audio que no sea una señal de audio
o audio no estándar. (pág. 3)
Los canales de audio izquierdo
y derecho están invertidos o el
sonido sólo sale por uno de ellos.
Compruebe la conexión de audio. (pág. 10)
No hay salida de audio o las imágenes
no se reproducen adecuadamente.
En algunos discos en los que se ha grabado contenido protegido por derechos de autor
es posible que no haya salida de audio o que las imágenes no se reproduzcan
adecuadamente.
No se puede escuchar el tipo de audio
que se desea y/o el número de canales.
Consulte el ajuste Salida de audio y “Formatos de salida de audio”. (pág. 34, 35)
No se escucha el sonido de PIP
(audio secundario).
Ajuste Coaxial/Optica o HDMI en PCM/Recodificar. (pág. 34)
Para escuchar el audio secundario, pulse 2ND AUDIO. (pág. 6)
Dependiendo del disco, es posible que tenga que activar el audio secundario en el menú
principal del disco (pág. 7)
RESOLUCIÓN DE PROBLEMAS
40 Es
Red
Mensajes en pantalla
Los mensajes siguientes aparecerán en la pantalla del televisor si el disco que intenta reproducir no es apropiado
o la operación no es correcta.
Problema Causas posibles y soluciones
No se puede conectar a Internet. Conecte correctamente el cable de red.
Encienda el equipo conectado como, por ejemplo, un módem o enrutador de banda ancha.
Conecte correctamente el módem y/o el enrutador de banda ancha.
Configure correctamente el valor o valores de la red. Compruebe “Red”. (pág. 32)
No se pueden descargar contenidos
BD-Live.
Conecte correctamente el cable de red. (pág. 16)
Conecte el dispositivo de memoria USB correctamente. Compruebe que el dispositivo
de memoria USB está conectado al puerto USB del reproductor. (pág. 16)
Compruebe si el disco BD admite BD-Live.
Compruebe el ajuste de “Conexión a Internet”. (pág. 32)
Conecte el dispositivo de memoria USB formateado en FAT16 o FAT32.
Se recomienda conectar el dispositivo de memoria USB con al menos 2 GB de espacio libre.
Si no hay suficiente espacio libre, formatee el dispositivo de memoria USB. (pág. 30)
Consulte el manual del usuario suministrado del disco o póngase en contacto con el
fabricante del disco.
No se puede detectar el servidor DLNA. Conecte correctamente el cable de red.
Encienda el equipo conectado como, por ejemplo un enrutador de banda ancha
o el servidor.
Asegúrese de que el reproductor y el servidor están conectados al mismo punto de
acceso.
Configure correctamente el valor o valores de la red. Compruebe “Red”. (pág. 32)
Dependiendo del servidor DLNA, es posible que sea necesario autorizar al reproductor
desde el servidor.
No se puede reproducir el archivo
en el servidor doméstico de red.
Asegúrese de que el archivo se puede reproducir. (pág. 3)
Compruebe la configuración del servidor DLNA.
La calidad de funcionamiento y reproducción podría verse afectada por las condiciones
de la red doméstica.
Mensaje de error Causas posibles y soluciones
Not Support This File! El reproductor no admite el archivo. Consulte “Tipos de discos/archivos que se pueden utilizar con
este reproductor” (pág. 3).
¡Código de región erróneo! El disco tiene un código de región incompatible. Consulte “Información de gestión de la región”
(pág. 3).
La red ha fallado. El reproductor no se puede conectar a la red. Compruebe la conexión (pág. 16) y los valores de la red
(pág. 32).
Red está bien, proxy ha
fallado.
El reproductor no se puede conectar al servidor proxy. Consulte “Configuración Proxy” (pág. 32).
The Setting is prohibited,
please setup again.
La conexión de BD-Live está prohibida. Consulte “Conexión BD-Live” (pág. 32).
¡No se encuentra un fichero
válido para actualización!
Compruebe si el archivo de actualización está en la carpeta apropiada.
¡La actualización ha fallado
por alguna razón!
La actualización ha fallado. Compruebe si el archivo de actualización está dañado o es ilegible.
41 Es
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
5
Español
AVCHD
AVCHD es un nuevo formato (estándar) para cámaras
de vídeo de alta definición que se puede utilizar para
grabar y reproducir imágenes de alta definición (HD).
BD-Live™
BD-Live es un estándar de BD que utiliza una conexión
de red y permite al reproductor conectarse a la red para
descargar vídeos promocionales y otros datos.
BDMV
BDMV (Blu-ray Disc Movie, BD-MV=Películas en
disco Blu-ray BD-MV) se refiere a uno de los formatos
de aplicación utilizados para BD-ROM que constituye
una de las especificaciones de los discos Blu-ray.
BDMV es un formato de grabación equivalente al Vídeo
DVD de la especificación DVD.
Blu-ray 3D™
Blu-ray 3D le permite ver imágenes 3D de alta
definición completa.
BONUSVIEW
Los discos compatibles con BONUSVIEW le permiten
disfrutar simultáneamente de subcanal de vídeo para dos
pantallas, subcanal de audio y subtítulos. Aparece una
pequeña pantalla dentro de la pantalla principal durante
la reproducción (Imagen en imagen).
Buzón (LB 4:3)
Un tamaño de pantalla con barras negras en las partes
superior e inferior de la imagen para permitir la
visualización de material en pantalla ancha (16:9) en un
televisor 4:3 conectado.
Color Space
El Color Space es una gama de colores que se puede
representar. RGB es un espacio de color basado en el
modelo de color RGB (rojo, verde y azul) y se utiliza
normalmente para monitores de PC. YCbCr es un
espacio de color basado en una señal de luminancia (Y)
y dos señales de diferencia de color (Cb y Cr).
Deep Color
Deep Color se refiere al uso de diversas profundidades de
color en pantallas, a partir de las profundidades de 24 bits
de versiones anteriores de la especificación HDMI. Esta
profundidad de bits adicional permite que las pantallas
HDTV y otros tipos de pantallas pasen de millones a miles
de millones de colores y eliminan la aparición de bandas
de color en pantallas permitiendo unas transiciones tonales
suaves y una gradación ligera entre colores. La mayor
relación de contraste permite representar muchos más
tonos de gris entre blanco y negro. Además Deep Color
aumenta el número de colores disponibles dentro de los
límites definidos por el espacio de color RGB o YCbCr.
Dirección MAC
La dirección MAC es un valor único asignado a un
dispositivo de red para fines identificativos.
DivX®
DivX® es una tecnología multimedia popular creada por
DivX, Inc. Los archivos multimedia DivX® contienen
vídeo muy comprimido con una alta calidad visual que
mantiene un tamaño de archivo relativamente pequeño.
Los archivos DivX® también pueden incluir características
multimedia avanzadas como menús, subtítulos y pistas de
audio alternativas. Muchos archivos multimedia DivX®
están disponibles para descarga en línea y puede crear sus
propios archivos utilizando su propio contenido
y herramientas fáciles de utilizar de DivX.com.
Dolby Digital
Un sistema de sonido desarrollado por Dolby Laboratories
Inc. que da un ambiente de sala de cine a la salida de audio
cuando el producto está conectado con un amplificador
o procesador Dolby Digital.
Dolby Digital Plus
Un sistema de sonido desarrollado como una extensión
de Dolby Digital. Esta tecnología de codificación de
audio soporta sonido envolvente de 7.1 multicanales.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD es una tecnología de codificación sin
pérdidas que soporta hasta 8 canales de sonido envolvente
multicanal para los discos ópticos de próxima generación.
El sonido reproducido conserva fielmente, bit a bit,
la fuente original.
DRC (Control de gama dinámica)
DRC le permite ajustar la gama entre los sonidos más
alto y más bajo (gama dinámica) para reproducir a un
volumen intermedio. Utilícela cuando sea difícil
escuchar los diálogos o durante las horas en que la
reproducción pueda molestar a los vecinos.
DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
La tecnología DSD guarda señales de vídeo en soportes de
almacenamiento digitales, como Super Audio CD.
Mediante DSD, las señales se guardan como valores de un
solo bit en frecuencias de muestreo altas, de 2,8224 MHz,
mientras que el modelado del ruido y el sobremuestreo se
utilizan para reducir la distorsión, un fenómeno habitual en
situaciones de alta cuantificación de señales de audio.
Debido a la elevada frecuencia de muestreo, es posible
obtener una calidad de audio superior a la que ofrece el
formato PCM utilizado para CD de audio normales.
DTS
Un sistema de sonido digital desarrollado por DTS, Inc.
para su uso en salas de cine.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio es una nueva tecnología
desarrollada para el formato de disco óptico de alta
definición de próxima generación.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio es una tecnología de compresión
de audio sin pérdidas desarrollada para el formato de disco
óptico de alta definición de próxima generación.
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential es una tecnología de
compresión de audio sin pérdidas desarrollada para el
formato de disco óptico de alta definición de próxima
generación.
GLOSARIO
ESPECIFICACIONES
42 Es
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface, Interfaz
Multimedia de Alta Definición) es una interfaz que
soporta vídeo y audio en una sola conexión digital. La
conexión HDMI lleva señales de vídeo, lo mismo
estándar que de alta definición, y señales de audio en
multicanal a componentes A/V, por ejemplo, televisores
equipados con HDMI en forma digital y sin degradación.
Sonido PCM lineal
PCM lineal es un formato de grabación de señales
utilizado para CD de audio y en algunos discos DVD
y Blu-ray. El sonido de CD de audio se graba a 44,1 kHz
con 16 bits. (El sonido se graba entre 48 kHz con 16 bits
y 96 kHz con 24 bits en discos DVD y entre 48 kHz con
16 bits y 192 kHz con 24 bits en discos BD.)
Sincronismo de labios
Sincronismo de labios, una abreviatura de “lip
synchronization”, o sincronización de labios, es un
término que hace referencia tanto a un problema habitual
como a la posibilidad de mantener sincronizadas las
señales de audio y vídeo durante la posproducción y la
transmisión. La latencia de audio y vídeo requiere
complejos ajustes por parte del usuario, pero la versión
1.3 de HDMI incorpora una función de sincronización
automática de audio y vídeo que permite a los
dispositivos sincronizarse de forma automática y precisa
y sin la intervención del usuario.
Panorámico (PS 4:3)
Un tamaño de pantalla que recorta los costados de la
imagen para permitir la visualización de material de
pantalla ancha (16:9) en un televisor 4:3 conectado.
Subtítulos
Son las líneas de texto que aparecen en la parte inferior
de la pantalla y que traducen o transcriben el diálogo.
Están grabadas en muchos discos de vídeo DVD y BD.
Subtítulos
La audiodescripción es un tipo de subtítulos, la diferencia entre
los subtítulos y la audiodescripción es que los primeros están
diseñados para personas sin problemas auditivos, mientras que
los segundos lo están para personas que no oyen. Los
subtítulos no suelen mostrar todo el audio. La audiodescripción
muestra efectos de sonido (por ejemplo, un “suena el teléfono”
y “ruido de pasos”), mientras que los subtítulos no lo hacen.
Antes de seleccionar este ajuste, asegúrese de que el disco
contiene información de audiodescripción.
Menú principal
En un Vídeo BD/Vídeo DVD es el menú para
seleccionar elementos tales como el capítulo que se va
a reproducir y el idioma de los subtítulos. En algunos
vídeos DVD, al menú principal también se le denomina
“Menú de títulos”.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color reproduce una gama de colores más amplia
que antes, mostrando casi todos los colores que puede
Generalidades
Alimentación
[Modelos de EE. UU. y Canadá].............................110-240 V CA, 60 Hz
[Modelos para América Central y del Sur] .....110 – 240 V CA, 50/60 Hz
[Modelos para Europa y Rusia] ..................................... CA 230 V, 50 Hz
[Modelo para Australia] ..........................................110-240 V CA, 50 Hz
[Modelo para Asia] .........................................CA 220 – 240 V, 50/60 Hz
[Modelo para Taiwán].....................................CA 110 – 120 V, 50/60 Hz
[Modelo para Corea] ...................................................... CA 220 V, 60 Hz
Consumo de energía (normal) .............................................................. 25 W
Consumo (en espera) .............................................................0,5 W o menos
Dimensiones (Ancho × Alto × Largo) .......................... 435 × 96 × 316 mm
Peso ................................................................................................... 4,05 kg
Rendimiento de audio
Nivel de salida de audio (1 kHz, 0 dB, BD/DVD/CD-DA) ........... 2 ± 0,3 V
Relación señal/ruido (BD/DVD/CD-DA) ............................... 115 dB o más
Rango dinámico
BD/DVD .............................................................................. 105 dB o más
CD-DA ................................................................................. 100 dB o más
Distorsión armónica (1 kHz)
BD/DVD ....................................................................... 0,0028% o menos
CD-DA ........................................................................... 0,003 % o menos
Respuesta de frecuencia
BD/DVD ........................................... 2 Hz a 22 kHz (muestreo a 48 kHz)
2 Hz a 44 kHz (muestreo a 96 kHz)
CD-DA ................................................................................ 2 Hz a 20 kHz
Entrada/salida
Salida HDMI ................................................................. Conector tipo A × 1
480i/576i/480p/576p/720p/1080i/1080p/1080p@24Hz,
Soporte Deep Color, x.v. Color
Salida de vídeo componente......................................Y: 1 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
P
B, PR: 0,7 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
Salida de vídeo ...............................................................1 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
Salida digital.............................................................Óptica × 1, Coaxial × 1
Salida de audio analógica...................................................... 7.1 canales × 1
Mixed 2 canales × 1
Conectores USB ...........................................................................Tipo A × 2
Otros equipos ............................................................... Remote IN/OUT × 1
RS-232C × 1 (instalación personalizada),
Ethernet × 1
Las especificaciones están sujetas a cambio sin previo aviso.
ESPECIFICACIONES
ESPECIFICACIONES
43 Es
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
5
Español
Propiedad intelectual
El material audio-visual puede consistir de productos
con propiedad intelectual que no se deben grabar sin
la autorización del poseedor de dicha propiedad
intelectual. Remítase a las leyes aplicables en su país.
Este producto contiene tecnología de protección de
copia que está protegida por patentes de los EE. UU.
y otros derechos de propiedad intelectual de Rovi
Corporation. Se prohíbe la ingeniería inversa o el
desarmado de la unidad.
Fabricado bajo licencia de Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby y el símbolo de la doble D son marcas
comerciales de Dolby Laboratories.
Fabricado con licencia bajo las patentes de EE.UU.
número: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380;
5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872;
7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 y otras patentes de
los EE.UU. e internacionales emitidas o pendientes.
DTS y el símbolo son marcas registradas y los
logotipos DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master Audio y DTS
son marcas comerciales de DTS, Inc.. El producto
comprende también el software. © DTS, Inc. Todos
los derechos reservados.
“Blu-ray Disc
”, “Blu-ray
”, “Blu-ray 3D
”,
“BD-Live
”, “BONUSVIEW
” y los logotipos son
marcas comerciales de Blu-ray Disc Association.
es una marca comercial de DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
HDMI, el logotipo HDMI y High-Definition
Multimedia Interface son marcas comerciales
o marcas registradas de HDMI Licensing LLC.
“x.v.Color” y el logotipo “x.v.Color” son marcas
comerciales.
“AVCHD” y el logotipo “AVCHD” son marcas
comerciales de Panasonic Corporation y Sony
Corporation.
Java y todas las marcas comerciales y logotipos
basados en Java son marcas comerciales o marcas
registradas de Sun Microsystems, Inc. en los Estados
Unidos y/o otros países.
Este producto se otorga con licencia bajo la licencia
de cartera de patentes AVC y la licencia de cartera
de patentes VC-1 para su uso personal y no
comercial por parte de un consumidor para (i)
codificar vídeo que cumpla con las normas AVC
y VC-1 (“AVC/VC-1 Video”) y/o (ii) descodificar
vídeo AVC/VC-1 codificado por un consumidor
dedicado a una actividad personal y no comercial y/o
que se obtuvo de un proveedor de vídeo con licencia
para proporcionar vídeo AVC/VC-1. No se otorga
o se da por supuesta licencia alguna para cualquier
otro uso. Se puede obtener información adicional de
MPEG LA, LLC.
Consulte http://www.mpegla.com.
Windows Media Player es una marca comercial
o una marca comercial registrada de Microsoft
Corporation en Estados Unidos y/o en otros países.
DLNA y DLNA CERTIFIED son marcas
comerciales y/o marcas de servicio de Digital Living
Network Alliance.
YouTube y el logotipo YouTube son marcas
comerciales de Google. Inc.
“DivX®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus™ HD y los
logotipos asociados son marcas comerciales
registradas de DivX, Inc. y se utilizan con licencia.”
“DivX Certified® para reproducir vídeo DivX®
y DivX Plus™ HD (H.264/.MKV) hasta 1080p HD
y contenido de calidad.”
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX® es un formato de vídeo digital creado
por DivX, Inc. Este equipo es un dispositivo DivX Certified® oficial
que reproduce vídeo DivX. Visite divx.com para obtener más
información y conseguir herramientas de software para convertir
sus archivos a vídeo DivX.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: este dispositivo DivX
Certified® debe registrarse para poder reproducir películas DivX
Video-on-Demand (VOD) compradas. Para obtener el código de
registro, busque el apartado DivX VOD en el menú de configuración
del dispositivo. Visite el sitio vod.divx.com para obtener más
información sobre el proceso de registro.
i Ko
1
최고의 성능을 위하여 설명서를 주의깊게 읽어 보십시오.
본 설명서를 안전한 곳에 보관하고 나중에 참고하십시오.
2 서늘하고 건조하며 통풍이 잘 되는 청결한 곳에 본 기기를
설치하고, 직사광선, 발열기구, 진동, 먼지, 습기를 멀리하고
추운 곳에 두지 마십시오. 환기가 잘 되게 하려면 아래와 같
이 여유를 두십시오.
위쪽: 10 cm
뒤쪽: 10 cm
옆쪽: 10 cm
3 윙윙거리는 소리를 방지하려면 다른 전자 제품, 모터 또는
변압기에서 본 기기를 멀리 떨어뜨려 설치하십시오.
4 본 기기 내부의 결로 현상을 방지하려면 낮은 온도에서 높
은 온도로 온도가 급격하게 변하는 곳에 본 기기를 노출시
키거나 습도가 높은 환경 (예, 가습기가 있는 룸)에 본 기기
를 설치하지 마십시오. 화재가 발생하거나, 기기가 손상되
거나, 사용자가 감전되거나 부상당할 수도 있습니다.
5 이물질이 본 기기에 떨어질 수 있는 곳, 또는 액체가 떨어지
거나 흐를 수 있는 곳에 본 기기를 설치하지 마십시오. 본
기기위에 다음과 같은 물체를 올려놓지 마십시오:
다른 기기. 본 기기의 표면이 손상되거나 변색될 수도 있
습니다.
연소되는 물체 (예, 초). 화재가 발생하거나 본 기기가 손
상되거나 사용자가 부상당할 수도 있습니다.
액체가 담긴 용기. 용기가 넘어져 사용자가 감전되거나
본 기기가 손상될 수도 있습니다.
6 복사가 방해되지 않도록 신문, 책상보 및 커튼 등으로 본
기기를 덮지 마십시오. 본 기기의 내부 온도가 높아지면 화
재가 발생하거나 본 기기가 손상되거나 사용자가 부상당할
수도 있습니다.
7 모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 기기의 플러그를 연결하지
마십시오.
8 본 기기를 뒤집어서 조작하지 마십시오. 본 기기가 과열되
어 손상될 수도 있습니다.
9 스위치, 노브 또는 코드에 강한 압력을 가하지 마십시오.
10 전원 케이블을 콘센트에서 분리하는 경우, 항상 플러그를
잡고 케이블을 잡아 당기지 마십시오.
11
화학 솔벤트로 본 기기를 닦지 마십시오. 표면의 마무리가
훼손될 수도 있습니다. 깨끗하고 마른 헝겊을 사용하십시오.
12 반드시 본 기기에 지정된 전압만을 사용하십시오. 지정된
전압 이외의 전압을 사용하는 것은 매우 위험하며 화재가
발생하거나 본 기기가 손상되거나 사용자가 부상당할 수도
있습니다. 지정된 전압 이외의 전압을 사용하여 발생한 손
상에 대해서 Yamaha는 어떠한 책임도 지지 않습니다.
13 번개에 의한 손상을 방지하려면 뇌우시 전원 케이블을 콘센
트에서 분리하십시오.
14 본 기기를 개조하거나 수리하지 마십시오. 서비스가 필요한
때에는 공인 Yamaha 정비사에게 의뢰하십시오. 어떤 이유
로든지 절대로 캐비닛을 열지 마십시오.
15 오랜 기간 동안 본 기기를 사용하지 않는 경우 (예, 휴가),
전원을 콘센트에서 분리하십시오.
16 본 기기의 고장을 결정하기 전에 일반 조작 에러의 "문제 해
결" 장을 반드시 읽어 보십시오.
17 본 기기를 옮기기 전에 을 눌러 본 기기를 대기 모드로 설
정하고 AC 전원 플러그를 콘센트에서 분리하십시오.
18 주변 온도가 급격히 변하는 경우, 결로 현상이 발생합니다.
전원 케이블을 콘센트에서 분리한 후 본 기기를 둡니다.
19 본 기기를 장시간 사용하는 경우, 기기가 과열될 수도 있습
니다. 전원을 끄고 식도록 본 기기를 둡니다.
20 기기를 설치할 때 벽면 콘센트에 쉽게 접근할 수 있도록하
여 주십시오.
21 건전지를 직사광선, 불꽃 등과 같이 과도한 화기에 노출시
키지 마십시오.
레이저 안전
본 기기는 레이저를 사용하고 있습니다. 시력이 손상될 수 있으
므로 공인 서비스 기술자만 커버를 열고 본 기기를 수리해야 합
니다.
위험
본 기기를 열면 가시 레이저 방사선이 방출됩니다. 육안으로 빔
을 직접 보지 마십시오. 본 기기 플러그가 콘센트에 연결된 경
우, 디스크 트레이의 입구나 다른 개구부 또는 내부에 눈을 가
깝게 대지 마십시오.
주의: 본 기기를 조작하기 전에 읽어 주십시오.
본 기기가 콘센트에 연결되어 있으면 으로 본 기기
의 자체 전원을 끄더라도 전원이 차단되지 않습니다.
이를 대기 모드라 합니다. 상태에서 기기는 아주
적은 양의 전원을 소모하도록 설계되어 있습니다.
경고
화재 및 전의 위험을 줄이기 위해 본체를 비나 습기
등에 노출시키지 마십시오.
제품의 레이저 부품은 클래스 1제한을 초과하는
방사능을 방사합니다.
주의
여기서 지정한 이외의, 조정이나 제어 또는 동작을 실시했
을 경우, 유해한 방사선에 노출될 위험이 있습니다.
레이저 사양
Class 1 레이저 제품
파장: 790 nm (CD)/655 nm (DVD)/405 nm (BD)
레이저 출력: 최대 1 mW
1 Ko
1
2
3
4
5
한국어
본 플레이어에서 할 수 있는 작업 .............. 2
부속품 ....................................... 2
디스크 및 파일에 대하여 ...................... 3
본 플레이어에서 사용할 수 있는 디스크/파일 유형 ...... 3
디스크 넣기............................................................... 4
디스크 주의사항........................................................ 4
각 부 명칭 및 기능 ........................... 5
앞면 패널 .................................................................. 5
리모콘....................................................................... 6
연결 방법 ................................... 10
뒷면 패널 ................................................................ 10
HDMI 연결 ................................... 12
HDMI 단자에 연결 .................................................. 12
Blu-ray 3D 디스크 재생을 위한 연결...................... 12
비디오 연결 ................................. 13
컴포넌트/비디오 잭에 연결...................................... 13
오디오 연결 ................................. 14
디지털 오디오 잭/단자에 연결 ................................. 14
오디오 잭에 연결..................................................... 15
네트워크 및 USB 연결 ........................ 16
NETWORK 단자 및 USB 포트에 연결 .................... 16
기타 연결 ................................... 17
REMOTE CONTROL 잭에 연결.............................. 17
전원 케이블 연결..................................................... 17
INITIAL WIZARD/EASY SETUP ................... 18
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup을 사용하여 설정 ........... 18
HOME/MEDIA 메뉴 ............................. 19
사진/음악/비디오 재 ............................................ 19
네트워크 컨텐츠 사용.............................................. 21
네트워크 서비스 사용 ........................ 22
YouTube에서 비디오 재생.................... 22
고급 재생 조작 .............................. 23
On Screen 메뉴 ...................................................... 23
상태 메뉴 ................................................................ 24
Bookmark 사용 ...................................................... 25
프로그램 재생 ......................................................... 25
검색 사용 ................................................................ 25
BONUSVIEW 및 BD-Live 즐기기 ..................... 26
Picture in Picture 기능 사용
(보조 오디오/비디오 재생) .................................. 26
BD-Live 기능 사용 .............................................. 26
SETUP 메뉴 .................................. 27
SETUP 메뉴 조작 예 .............................................. 29
General Setting ..................................................... 30
Display Setting ...................................................... 32
Audio Setting......................................................... 34
System Information ............................................... 34
오디오 출력 형식에 대하여...................................... 35
비디오 출력 형식에 대하여...................................... 36
소프트웨어 업그레이드 ....................... 37
소프트웨어 업그레이드 ........................................... 37
문제 해결 ................................... 38
전원 ....................................................................... 38
기본 조작 ............................................................... 38
디스크 재생 ............................................................ 38
사진 ....................................................................... 39
사운드 .................................................................... 39
네트워크 ................................................................ 40
화면의 메시지 ........................................................ 40
용어집 ...................................... 41
제품 사양 ................................... 42
일반 사항 ............................................................... 42
오디오 성능 ............................................................ 42
입력/출력 ............................................................... 42
저작권 .................................................................... 43
(본 설명서 끝)
본 사용 설명서에 대하여
본 설명서는 리모콘을 사용할 수 있는 경우 리모콘
으로 본 플레이어를 조작하는 방법에 대해 설명합
니다. 일부 조작은 앞면 패널 버튼을 사용하여 수
행할 수도 있습니다.
참고에는 안전 및 조작 방법에 대한 중요한 정보가
들어 있습니다. 힌트는 조작을 위한 팁입니다.
본 설명서는 제품이 생산되기 전에 인쇄됩니다. 제
품 향상 등에 따라 디자인과 제품 사양이 변경될
수 있습니다. 설명서와 제품 간에 차이가 있는 경
우에는 제품을 우선시 합니다.
본 설명서에 사용된 아이콘
아이콘은 특정 형식에서 사용 가능한 버튼/기능을 나
내기 위해 사용합니다.
: BD-Video
: DVD-Video, DVD-VR, DVD+VR, DVD-
Audio
: 오디오 CD, Super Audio CD
: AVCHD, WMV, DivX
: MP3, WMA, WAV
: JPEG
목차
1. 소개
2. 연결
3. 재생
4. 설정
5. 추가 정보
Information about software ......................................... i
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
2 Ko
소개
* 재생 가능한 디스크 및 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 3페이지를 참조하십시오.
** 이 기능을 사용하려면 네트워크 설정이 필요합니다.
제품에 다음과 같은 액세서리가 제공되었는지 확인하십시오.
본 플레이어에서 할 수 있는 작업
언어, 해상도, 화면비율 간편 설정
\
18페이지
언어 및 TV 설정을 할 수 있습니다.
상업용으로 발매된 Blu-ray/DVD/CD/SA-CD/DVD-Audio 디스크 재생
*
\
23페이지
본 플레이어에서는 Blu-ray Discs™(BD 디스크) 이외에 다양한 다른 디스크의 재생도 지원
됩니다.
BONUSVIEW, BD-Live 등 재생
*
\
26페이지
최신 BD 디스크에서 동영상을 즐길 수 있습니다.
디스크에서 비디오, 음악, 사진 파일 재
*
\
19페이지
녹화한 디스크를 본 플레이어에서 재생할 수 있습니다.
디스크/USB 메모리 장치에서 비디오, 음악, 사진 파일 재생
*
\
19페이지
디스크/USB 메모리 장치에 녹화된 파일을 본 플레이어에서 재생할 수 있습니다.
홈 네트워크 서버에서 비디오, 음악, 사진 파일 재생
*
**
\
21페이지
본 플레이어를 네트워크 서버에 연결하면 TV 또는 AV 리시버에서 PC 컨텐츠를 재생할 수
있습니다.
리모콘으로 TV, AV 리시버 등 조
\
30페이지
HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 장치를 연결하면 HDMI Control 기능을 사용하여 리모콘 하나로
여러 장치를 조작할 수 있습니다.
네트워크 서비스 상의 스트리밍 재생 컨텐츠**
\
22페이지
본 플레이어를 이용하여 인터넷을 통해 즉시 비디오를 즐길 수 있습니다.
부속품
배터리(×2)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
전원 케이블리모콘 오디오 핀 케이블 비디오 핀 케이블
3 Ko
한국어
소개
1
본 플레이어에서 사용할 수 있는 디스
크/파일 유형
본 플레이어에서는 12 cm 및 8 cm 디스크를 재생
있습니다. 8 cm를 12 cm 어댑터를 사용하지
마십시오.
호환 표준을 준수하는 디스크에 한하여 디스크 라
벨에 공식 로고가 표시되어 있습니다. 호환 표준을
준수하는 디스크를 사용하십시오. 이 표준을 따르
지 않는 디스크의 재생은 보장되지 않습니다. 디스
크가 재생되더라도 화질 또는 음질은 보장되지 않
습니다.
BD/DVD Video 플레이어 디스크에는 디스크를
재생할 수 있는 지역을 나타내는 지역 코드가 있습
니다.
BD/DVD Video 조작 및 기능은 본 설명서의 설명
과 다를 수 있으며, 디스크 제조업체의 설정에 따
라 일부 조작이 제한될 수 있습니다.
디스크 재생 도중 메뉴 화면 또는 조작 지침이 표
시되는 경우 표시된 절차를 따르십시오.
디스크에 따라 왼쪽 표의 디스크 중 일부가 재생되
지 않을 수 있습니다.
본 플레이어에서 재생되는 모든 녹화 미디어를 파
이널라이즈하십시오.
"파이널라이즈"는 녹화된 디스크가 본 플레이어는
물론 다른 플레이어/레코더에서도 재생되도록 레
코더에서 진행되는 처리 작업입니다. 본 플레이어
에서는 파이널라이즈된 디스크만 재생됩니다. (본
플레이어에는 디스크를 파이널라이즈하는 기능이
없습니다.)
디스크, USB 메모리 장치 및 네트워크에서 일부
파일의 재생은 보장되지 않습니다.
저작권 보호 파일은 USB 메모리 장치 및 네트워크
를 통해 재생할 수 없습니다.
MP3/WMA/WAV 오디오 파일 요구사항
샘플링 주파수: 32 - 48 kHz(MP3/WMA),
LPCM 44.1 kHz/16 비트/스테레오(WAV)
비트 전송률: 8 - 320 kbps(MP3) 이내,
32 - 192 kbps(WMA)
디스크 및 파일에 대하여
디스크 유형 녹화 형식 데이터 형식
BD-ROM/BD-R/
BD-RE
BD-Video --
DVD-ROM DVD-Video/DVD-
Audio
--
DVD-R/DVD-R
DL/DVD-RW
DVD-Video/DVD-
VR/AVCHD/데이터
디스크
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
DVD+R/DVD+R
DL/DVD+RW
DVD-Video/
DVD+VR/AVCHD/
데이터 디스크
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
CD-ROM CDDA/HDCD --
CD-R/CD-RW CDDA/데이터 디스
DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
SA-CD SA-CD --
USB -- DivX/WMV/MP3/
WAV/WMA/JPEG
네트워크 -- WMV/MP3/WMA/
WAV/JPEG
지역 관리 정보
지역
BD-Video DVD-Video
미국 및 캐나다 지역 코드 "A" 또는
"ALL"
지역 코드 "1" 또는
"ALL"
아시아 지역 코드 "A" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "3" 또는
"ALL"
대만 지역 코드 "A" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "3" 또는
"ALL"
한국 지역 코드 "A" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "3" 또는
"ALL"
1
ALL
3
ALL
3
ALL
3
ALL
중남미 지역 코드 "A" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "4" 또는
"ALL"
유럽 지역 코드 "B" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "2" 또는
"ALL"
호주 지역 코드 "B" 또는
"ALL"
지역 코드 "4" 또는
"ALL"
러시아 지역 코드 "C" 또는
"ALL"
지역 번호 "5" 또는
"ALL"
참고
지역 관리 정보
지역
BD-Video DVD-Video
4
ALL
2
ALL
4
ALL
5
ALL
4 Ko
디스크 및 파일에 대하여
WMV 파일 요구사항
WMV9, 최대 해상도는 1,920 × 1,080입니다.
Super Audio CD(SA-CD)에 대하여
이 오디오 형식은 현재의 CD 표준을 기반으로 하
지만 더 많은 양의 고음질 정보를 포함하고 있습니
다. 디스크에는 단층, 이층, 하이브리드의 3종류가
있습니다. 하이브리드 디스크는 표준 오디오 CD
Super Audio CD 정보가 모두 포함되어 있어서
기존 CD 플레이어 및 Super Audio CD 플레이어
에서도 재생할 수 있습니다.
호환되는 AV 리시버를 사용하면 본 플레이어에서
HDMI를 통한 DSD 데이터 전송이 지원됩니다.
본 기기의 표시창에는 디스크에 들어 있는 텍스트
데이터가 표시되지 않습니다.
디스크 넣기
라벨이 위로 오도록 디스크를 넣으십시오.
양면 녹화된 디스크의 경우, 재생할 면이 아래로
가도록 넣으십시오.
디스크 및 본 플레이어의 설정에 따라 재생이 자동
으로 시작될 수 있습니다.
디스크에 따라 메뉴가 먼저 표시될 수 있습니다.
디스크에 따라 디스크를 읽어들이는 시간이 다를
수 있습니다.
디스크 주의사항
긁힘 및 먼지 주의
BD, DVD 및 CD 디스크는 먼지, 지문 및 특히 스
크래치에 취약합니다. 스크래치가 있는 디스크는
재생되지 않을 수 있습니다. 디스크를 조심해서 다
루고 안전한 장소에 보관하십시오.
적절한 디스크 보관
취급 시 주의 사항
픽업 렌즈 청소
시판용 클리닝 디스크는 절대 사용하지 마십시오.
렌즈가 손상될 수 있습니다.
렌즈를 청소하려면 가까운 공인 Yamaha 서비스
센터에 요청하십시오.
힌트
참고
참고
1
2
3
Super Audio CD 디스크 종류
단층 디스크
HD 계층
이층 디스크
하이브리드 디스크
HD 계층
CD 계층
HD 계층
Hybrid Super Audio CD 디스크
모든 CD 플레이어에서
재생되는 CD 계층
- 고화질 DSD 스테레오
- 고화질 DSD 멀티 채널
다음이 포함된 고밀도 계층:
디스크를 디스크 케이스의 가운데에 넣고
케이스와 디스크를 똑바로 세워 보관하십
시오.
직사광선에 노출된 곳, 난방 기구 근처 또
습도가 높은 장소에 디스크를 보관하
지 마십시오.
디스크를 떨어뜨리거나 강한 진동이나
충격을 가하지 마십시오.
먼지 또는 습기가 많은 장소에 디스크
보관하지 마십시오.
표면이 더러워진 경우 물에 살짝 적신
부드러운 헝겊으로 살살 닦으십시오.
스크를 닦을 때에는 항상 가운데 구멍에
서 바깥쪽으로 닦으십시오.
레코드용 클리닝 스프레이, 벤젠, 시너,
정전기 방지 용액 또는 기타 용해제를
사용하지 마십시오.
표면을 만지지 마십시오.
디스크에 종이 또는 접착 라벨을 붙이지 마십시오.
디스크의 재생 면이 더러워지거나 긁힌 경우 플레
이어가 호환되지 않는 디스크로 판단하여 디스크
트레이가 열리거나, 디스크를 올바로 재생하지 못
할 수 있습니다. 부드러운 헝겊으로 재생 면의 먼
지를 닦아 주십시오.
5 Ko
한국어
소개
1
앞면 패널
1 p (켬/대기)
2 USB 포트(16페이지)
3 SA-CD 표시등: SA-CD를 넣고 SA-CD 계층(4페이
)󱽹 󱥕󲤒󲶍󱊩 󲁅󰴦󰱞󰫽󰬙.
4 표시창
5 디스크 트레이(4페이지)
6 (꺼냄): 󰵉󱫙󲢡 󲫭󱀽󱾩󱆱 󱸩󰒥󰣍 󰬠󱫪󰫽󰬙.
7 (뒤로 검색/뒤로 건너뛰기): 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹
󱆩󱊩 󰳙󱂑 󰒩󰤽󰼥󰔕, 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆩󰔕 󱾽󱽱󱊩 󰳙󱂑 󰒵󱣾󲶞
󰫽󰬙.
8 (앞으로 검색/앞으로 건너뛰기):
󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆩󱊩 󱶓󱽱󱂑 󰒩󰤽󰼥󰔕, 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆩󰔕 󱾽󱽱
󱊩 󱶓󱽱󱂑 󰒵󱣾󲶞󰫽󰬙.
9 (재생)
0 (일시 정지)
A (정지)
B PURE DIRECT: Pure Direct 모드(7페이지)󰐵 󱋝󰴑 1/
󱋝󰴑 2/Off󱂑 󱓵󰓲󰱞󰫽󰬙. Pure Direct 󱋝󰴑󰐵 󱋝󰴑 1/
󱋝󰴑 2󱂑 󱥙󲁊󰱑 󰓲󱻥 󱒹󲫱󱾩 󲁅󰴦󰱞󰫽󰬙.
리모콘에 배터리 넣기
리모콘에 충격을 가하거나 물이나 습기가 심한 곳
에 놓아두지 마십시오.
플레이어의 리모콘 센서가 직사광선 또는 다른 강
한 빛에 노출된 경우 리모콘이 작동하지 않을 수
있습니다.
배터리를 잘못 사용하면 누액되거나 파열될 수 있
습니다. 배터리 경고를 읽고 배터리를 올바로 사용
하십시오.
쓰던 배터리와 새 배터리를 혼용하거나 브랜드가
다른 배터리를 혼용하지 마십시오.
리모콘을 장기간 사용하지 않을 경우 배터리를 꺼
내놓으십시오.
해당 지역의 규정에 따라 배터리를 폐기하십시오.
대략적인 리모콘 작동 범
각 부 명칭 및 기능
2 5 61 43 7 8 9 0 A B
참고
1
3
2
30˚30˚
리모콘 센서
6 m
6 Ko
각 부 명칭 및 기능
리모콘
사용할 수 없는 버튼을 누르면 가 화면의 왼쪽
상단에 나타납니다.
1 적외선 신호 송신기:외선 신호가 나옵니다. 이 창
을 리모콘 센서 쪽으로 향하게 합니다(5페이지).
2 MARKER : 동영상에서 지정한 지점에
Bookmark(25페이지)를 설정합니다. Bookmark를
설정한 다음 이동하려는 지점을 선택하려면 DIGEST
를 누릅니다. 북마크를 12개까지 설정할 수 있습니다.
3 : 디스크 트레이를 열거나 닫습니다.
4 PROGRAM : 재생 순서(25페이지)를 설정
합니다. 최대 15개의 트랙(오디오 디스크의 경우)
는 타이틀/챕터(DVD-Video)를 설정할 수 있습니다.
5 색상 버튼 : 화면 지침에 따라 이 버튼을 사용합
니다.
6 숫자 버튼: 숫자를 입력하거나, 재생 도중 입력한
자에 해당하는 트랙/챕터로 이동합니다. 디스크 종류
및 재생 조건에 따라 이 버튼을 사용하지 못할 수
습니다.
7 CLEAR: 입력한 숫자/설정 항목을 지웁니다.
8 SETUP: SETUP 메뉴 화면(27페이지)을 표시합니다.
9 PIP : Picture in Picture(26페이지)를 설정/해
제합니다. 이 기능을 사용할 수 있으면 PIP Mark
( )가 화면에 표시됩니다. On Screen 메뉴(23페
이지)에서 이 항목을 선택할 수도 있습니다.
PIP Mark가 On으로 설정된 경우에만 PIP Mark가
표시됩니다(31페이지).
0 2ND AUDIO : Picture in Picture(26페이지) 또
는 오디오 방송의 보조 오디오를 선택합니다. 이
능을 사용할 수 있으면 Secondary Audio Mark
( )가표시됩니다(34페이지). On Screen
메뉴(23페이지)에서 이 항목을 선택할 수도 있습니
다.
Secondary Audio Mark가 On으로 설정된 경우에
만 Secondary Audio Mark가 표시됩니다(31페이
지).
참고
참고
참고
DVD
VIDEO
DVD CD
BD
BD
BD
7 Ko
각 부 명칭 및 기능
한국어
소개
1
A TOP MENU : 디스크에 메뉴가 포함된 경
우 맨 처음 메뉴 화면(42페이지)이 표시됩니다.
5/a /2 /3ENTER󱆱 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡 󱼅󲶍󰫉 󲶢󱋞󱽹 󱥕
󲤒󲶞 󰫽󰬙.
디스크에 따라 특정 조작이 다를 수 있습니다. 각
메뉴 화면의 지침을 따르십시오.
B 커서 버튼(5/a /2 /3): 메뉴 화면에서 초점을 이동
합니다.
ENTER: 󲔽󲁅󱽹 󱈓󲗍 󱊉󰪩/󲶢󱋞󱽹 󱥕󲤒󲶞󰫽󰬙.
C RETURN: 󱾩󲀹 󱊉󰪩 󰹅󰫉 󲺉󱊩 󰴦󱽱󱂑 󰰁󱵹󰑆󰫽󰬙.
D SUBTITLE : 사용 가능한 경우
자막 언어(42페이지)를 변경합니다. On Screen 메
뉴 (23페이지)󱸅󱥑 󱾩 󲶢󱋞󱽹 󱥕󲤒󲶕 󱩍󰯹 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
E STATUS: 󱿡󱤒 󲁊󱔩(24페이지)󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
F 조절 버튼
/
:
앞으로/뒤로 검색합니다. 버튼을 누를 때마다 검색
속도가 변경됩니다(앞/뒤로 검색: 각각 5단계).
를 누르면 일반 재생이 다시 시작됩니다.
: 슬라이드 쇼의 속도를 변경합니다. (느리
게/빠르게: 3단계)
/ :
󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆩󰔕 󱾽󱽱󱊩 󲆾󱬑 󰒵󱣾/󰬙󱬑 󱔩󰙥󱆱 󲶞󰫽󰬙.
󲆾󱬑 󰒵󱣾󱽵 󲜝󲦅󲙕󱆱 30󲔽 󰒩󰤽󰼶󰫽󰬙. 󲆾󱬑 󰬙󱬑 󱔩
󰙥󰫉 󲜝󲦅󲙕󱆱 10󲔽 󲀹󱖵󲥥 󰬙󱬑 󱔺󰫽󰬙.
/ : 󱶓/󰳙󱂑 󰒩󰤽󰼶󰫽󰬙.
: 재생을 정지합니다. 재생을 완전히 중지하려면
이 버튼을 두 번 누릅니다.
: 재생을 일시 정지합니다.
: 󲜝󲦅󲙕󱆱 󱿡󱤒󲶞󰫽󰬙.
()/()
: 󰫅󱇡󰓁 󱶓/󰳙󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶞󰫽󰬙. 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹
󱆱 󰶁󱇽󰬙 󲀵󱧂 󱿡󱤒
󱧂󰯹󰐵 󱓵󰓲󰱞󰫽󰬙(󰫅󱇡󰓁 󱶓/󰳙
󱂑 󱾩󰰎: 󰐶󰐶 4󰬝󰓹).
󱾱󱬑 󲁊󲇵 󰯹󲅆 󱾩 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆩󱊩 󲴹󱀽󱾹 󱩑󱑞󲷚/󱸢󱑞
󲷚 󱿡󱤒󱽹 󱩍󲶾󲶞󰫽󰬙.
󱆱 󰨹󱆩󱊩 󱾱󱑍 󱿡󱤒󱾩 󰬙󱬑 󱬑󱿆󰱞󰫽󰬙.
대부분 DVD-Audio 디스크에는 슬라이드 쇼 및 페
이지 넘김 기능이 포함되어 있습니다. / 󱆱 󰨹󱆩
󱊩 󱾩󲀹/󰬙󱾁 󲯍󱾩󲇵󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶞󰫽󰬙. 󱾩 󰙥󰫚󱽵 DVD-
Audio󱸅󱈁 󲶩󰬮󰱞󰫽󰬙.
일부 BD/DVD 디스크에서는 프레임 순방향/역방
향 재생 기능이 호환되지 않습니다.
본 플레이어는 디스크에 따라 플레이어가 이전에
정지된 지점부터 재생이 다시 시작됩니다. 처음부
터 재생하려면 를 두 번 누른 다음 를 누르
십시오.
G SA-CD/CD: 󲶍󱾩󱙁󱇡󰴑 SA-CD󱾍 󱿡󱤒 󰓹󲙪󱽹 SA-CD
󱑄 CD 󲅆󱸅󱥑 󲀹󲺍󲶞󰫽󰬙(4페이지).
SA-CD를 넣고 SA-CD 계층을 선택하면 앞면 패
널의 SA-CD/CD 표시등(5페이지)이 점등됩니
(34페이지).
SA-CD 선택한 경우 오디오 신호는 AUDIO
OUT 잭(11)에서만 출력됩니다.
DSD 멀티 채널 형식으로 녹음된 오디오 신호는
플레이어에서 재생되지 않습니다.
H PURE DIRECT: Pure Direct 모드를 변경합니다.
튼을 누를 때마다 아래 표시된 Pure Direct 모드가
변경됩니다. Pure Direct 모드를 사용하면 음질이
향상됩니다. 앞면 패널의 PURE DIRECT는 Pure
Direct 모드가 모드 1/모드 2로 설정된 경우 점등됩
니다.
모드 1: 표시창이 꺼지고, 비디오 신호가 출력되지
않습니다. 이 모드는 오디오 청취 시 적합합니다.
모드 2: 표시창이 꺼지고, HDMI 단자 이외에서 출력
되는 비디오 신호가 출력되지 않습니다. 이 모드는
고음질의 동영상 시청 시 적합합니다.
Off: 󱾱󱑍 󱿡󱤒.
I DIMMER: 󲲑󱬑󲑲󱾍 󱑒󰙥󰐵 5󰬝󰓹󱂑 󱓵󰓲󰱞󰫽󰬙.
J DIGEST : 12개의 사진 썸네일을 표시합
다. 썸네일이 표시되면 / 를 사용하여 다음
/이전 페이지로 이동할 수 있습니다.
: Bookmark 󱥕󲤒 󱇾󰬵󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙
(25페이지).
K p: 󱔭 󲵁󱀽󱾩󱷩󱆱 󲝑󰒥󰣍 󰬵󰙥 󱋝󰴑󱂑 󱥙󲁊󲶞󰫽󰬙.
L ZOOM : 󲺊󰬵/󲗊󱧁󲶞󰫽󰬙.
󱒹󲫱󱽹 󰨹󱆱 󰶁󱇽󰬙 󲺉󱊩 󲢡󰙥󰐵 󱓵󰓲󰱞󰫽󰬙(󲺊󰬵/
󲗊󱧁: 󰐶󰐶 3󰬝󰓹).
참고
참고
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
힌트
참고
PHOTO
DVD VIDEO
DVD VIDEO PHOTO
다음 페이지에 계속.
\
8 Ko
각 부 명칭 및 기능
M SEARCH : 재생
도중 지정한 지점으로 이동합니다. 이 기능에 대한
자세한 내용은 "검색 사용"(25페이지)을 참조하십시
오. 상태 메뉴(24페이지)󱸅󱥑 󱾩 󲶢󱋞󱽹 󱥕󲤒󲶕 󱩍󰯹
󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
N HOME: HOME 메뉴 화면(19페이지)󱽹 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
O REPEAT
: 반복 모드를 변경합니다. 버튼을 누를 때
마다 아래 표시된 반복 모드가 변경됩니다.
: 재생 중인 타이틀을 반복합니다.
: 재생 중인 챕터를 반복합니다.
: 재생 중인 폴더를 반복합니다.
: 디스크의 모든 트랙/파일을 반복합니다.
: 재생 중인 트랙/파일을 반복합니다.
P A/B : 󱑍󱔪󲶍
󱁙󰫉 󲫮󲁊 󱖵󱖹󱽹 󱿡󱤒󲶞󰫽󰬙.
1 시작 지점으로 설정하려장면에서 A/B를 누릅니
다. "A-"가 화면에 표시됩니다.
2 끝 지점으로 설정하려는 장면에서 A/B다시 누
릅니다. "A-B"가 화면에 표시됩니다. 반복 재생이
시작됩니다.
3 반복 재생을 취소하려면 A/B를 누릅니다. "A-B"
가 사라지고 반복 재생이 종료됩니다.
디스크의 사양에 따라 기능을 수행하지 못할
있습니다.
Q POP-UP/MENU : 󲭒󱷺 󱊉󰪩󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
󲲑󱬑󰱍󰫉 󱊉󰪩 󰣩󱻞󱽵 󰵉󱫙󲢡󱸅 󰵥󰾱 󰬙󱆺󰫽󰬙. 󲭒󱷺
󱊉󰪩󱾍 󲲑󱬑 󱑄 󲂥󱿆 󱑞󱓊󱸅 󰬵󲶑 󱿅󱥭󲶑 󰣩󱻞󱽵 󰵉󱫙
󲢡 󱥙󱊺󱥑󱆱 󲑭󲂥󲶍󱬢󱬑󱹙.
DVD󱸅 󰵥󰾱 POP-UP/MENU󱆱 󰨹󱆩󱊩 󱈝 󲓍󱾁 󱊉󰪩󰐵
󲲑󱬑󰱍󰙥󰯹 󲶞󰫽󰬙.
R ON SCREEN: On Screen 󱊉󰪩(23페이지)󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
S ANGLE : 비디오가 여러 앵글로 녹화된
경우 카메라 앵글을 변경합니다. 이 기능을 사용할
수 있으면 Angle Mark( )가 화면에 표시됩니다.
On Screen 메뉴(23페이지)󱸅󱥑 󱾩 󲶢󱋞󱽹 󱥕󲤒󲶕
󱩍󰯹 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
Angle Mark가 On으로 설정된 경우에만 Angle
Mark가 표시됩니다(31페이지).
T AUDIO : 오디오 언어 또는 형식을 변경
합니다. On Screen 메뉴(23페이)󱸅󱥑 󱾩 󲶢󱋞󱽹
󱥕󲤒󲶕 󱩍󰯹 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
참고
참고
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
BD DVD
BD DVD
9 Ko
각 부 명칭 및 기능
한국어
소개
1
ID 기능
리모콘 ID를 변경하여 DVD 플레이어 같은 다른
Yamaha 플레이어에서 필요 없는 조작을 하지 못하도록
할 수 있습니다. 리모콘 ID를 변경한 경우 기본 기기에
서 동일한 ID를 선택했는지 확인하십시오. 기본 설정은
ID1입니다.
1 리모콘 설정
ID를 ID1에서 ID2로 변경하려면 빨간색 버튼과
숫자 버튼 2를 동시에 7초 동안 누릅니다. ID를
ID2에서 ID1로 변경하려면 빨간색 버튼과 숫자
버튼 및 1을 동시에 7초 동안 동시에 누릅니다.
2 기본 기기 설정
다음과 같은 경우 앞면 패널의
를 동시에 2초간 누르고 있으면 현재
ID가 표시됩니다.
플레이어에 디스크가 들어있지 않은 경우.
디스크 트레이가 닫혀 있는 경우.
재생이 중지된 경우.
"NO DISC"가 표시창에 표시된 경우.
키를 2초 동안 더 누르고 있으면 ID가 ID1과 ID2
중에서 변경됩니다.
리모콘 배터리를 몇 분간 빼 놓거나 다 쓴 배터리
를 리모콘에 그대로 두면 리모콘 ID가 자동으로
ID 1로 설정됩니다. 리모콘을 ID2로 설정하고
용하려면 새 배터리를 넣고 리모콘 ID를 다시 설정
하십시오.
참고
10 Ko
연결
사용하는 비디오/오디오 기기에 맞는 연결 방법을 찾아 보십시오. 케이블 하나로 고품질의 디지털 오디오 및 비디오
를 볼 수 있는 HDMI 단자를 사용하는 것이 좋습니다. 다른 단자/잭을 사용하는 경우 비디오를 먼저 연결하십시오.
그런 다음 오디오를 연결하십시오.
뒷면 패널
연결 방법
아니오
AV 리시버를 사용합니까?
AV 리시버에 HDMI
단자가 있습니까?
*
TV에 HDMI 단자가
있습니까?
TV에 HDMI 단자가
있습니까?
TV HDMI 단자가 있습니까?
HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 비디오 및 오디오를 TV에 연결합
니다.
비디오를 TV에 연결합니다.
HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 비디오를
TV에 연결합니다.
비디오를 AV 리시버에 연결합니다.
HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 비디오
및 오디오를 AV 리시버에 연결합
니다.
AV 리시버의 설명서를
참조하십시오.
시작
* 사운드 입력이 HDMI 단자로 출력되지 않는 AV 리시버에 연결한 경
우 AV 리시버의 설명서를 참조하십시오.
67 0 A93214 85
11 Ko
한국어
연결
2
1 NETWORK(16페이지)
2 HDMI(12페이지)
3 USB 포트(16페이지)
4 REMOTE CONTROL(IN/OUT/RS-232C)(17페이지)
5 7.1ch 서라운드(AUDIO OUT)(15페이지)
6 MIXED 2CH(AUDIO OUT) (15페이지)
7 VIDEO(13페이지)
8 COMPONENT(13페이지)
9 COAXIAL(14페이지)
0 OPTICAL(14페이지)
A AC IN(
17페이지)
비디오 연결
오디오를 AV 리시버
에 연결합니다.
TV에 비디오 연결
오디오를 TV에 연결합
니다.
HDMI(12페이지)
A
AV 리시버에 비디오
오디오 연결
AV 리시버에 오디오 연결
TV에 비디오 및 오디오 연결
TV에 오디오 연
HDMI(12페이지)
A
COMPONENT(13페이지)
B
VIDEO(13페이지)
C
TV에 연결
AV 리시버에 연결
또는
COMPONENT(13페이지)
B
VIDEO(13페이지)
C
또는
COAXIAL(14페이지)
D
OPTICAL(14페이지)
E
또는
MIXED 2CH(15페이지)
F
또는
COAXIAL (14페이지)
D
OPTICAL(14페이지)
E
또는
MIXED 2CH(15페이지)
F
또는
HDMI(12페이지)
A
7.1ch 서라운드(15페이지)
G
또는
12 Ko
HDMI 단자에 연결
HDMI 단자를 통해 고품질의 디지털 사진 및 사운드를 즐길 수 있습니다.
HDMI 케이블(시판용)을 HDMI 단자에 단단히 연결하십시오.
오디오/비디오 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 35페이지를 참조하십시오.
HDMI 로고(뒷 표지에 표시되어 있음)가 있는 HIGH SPEED HDMI 케이블을 사용하십시오.
주의!
모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 플레이어의 전원 케이블을 연결하지 마십시오.
HDMI 연결
HDMI IN
본 플레이어
HDMI 󰬝󱿅󱸅 󱸥󰓥
HDMI 케이블
(시판용)
HDMI Control 기능을 사용하는 경우
"HDMI Control"(30페이지)을 참조하십시
오.
HDMI 단자의 출력 모드에 대해서는
"HDMI"(34페이지)를 참조하십시오.
아무 사진도 표시되지 않으면 "문제 해결"
(39페이지)을 참조하십시오.
Blu-ray 3D 디스크 재생을 위한
연결
본 플레이어에서 Blu-ray 3D 디스크를 재생하려
면 다음과 같은 장비를 연결해야 합니다:
3D 기능을 갖춘 TV 및 (필요한 경우) AV 리
시버
모든 구성품은 HDMI 케이블을 이용하여
결해야 합니다.
Blu-ray 디스크에는 3D 이미지가 있어야
합니다.
힌트
AV 리시버
TV
A A
HDMI 입력 단자에 연결
13 Ko
한국어
연결
2
컴포넌트/비디오 잭에 연결
컴포넌트 잭을 통해 정확한 색상 재현과 고화질을 즐길 수 있습니다.
컴포넌트 비디오 케이블(시판용) 또는 비디오 핀 케이블을 COMPONENT 잭/VIDEO 잭에 단단히 연결하십시
오.
비디오 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 36페이지를 참조하십시오.
주의!
모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 플레이어의 전원 케이블을 연결하지 마십시오.
VCR을 통해 화상을 재생하는 경우 복제 방지 기능으로 인해 화질이 저하될 수 있습니다.
플레이어에서 BD-3D 디스크를 즐기려면 HDMI 케이블을 이용하여 AV 리시버, TV 본 플레이어를 연결
해야 합니다. 이전 페이지를 참조하십시오.
비디오 연결
COMPONENT IN
Y
PB
PR
본 플레이어
컴포넌트 비디오 케이블
(시판용)
AV 리시버
TV
󳶀󴳐
󵼓󴎇󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󳶀󴳐
󵼓󴎇󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
COMPONENT
잭에 연결
컴포넌트 입력 잭
에 연결
B B
󳶀󴳐
󵼓󴎇󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󳶀󴳐
󵼓󴎇󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
VIDEO
AV INPUT
본 플레이어
비디오 핀 케이블
(부속품)
AV 리시버 TV
󳵿󴎇󴳐
󳵿󴎇󴳐
󳵿󴎇󴳐
VIDEO 잭
에 연결
비디오 입력
잭에 연결
󳵿󴎇󴳐
C C
참고
14 Ko
디지털 오디오 잭/단자에 연결
오디오 기기 또는 TV를 COAXIAL 잭/OPTICAL 단자에 연결할 수 있습니다.
동축 디지털 오디오 케이블(시판용) 또는 케이블을 동축 디지털 오디오 잭 또는 광 디지털 오디오 단자에
단히 연결하십시오.
오디오 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 35페이지를 참조하십시오.
주의!
모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 플레이어의 전원 케이블을 연결하지 마십시오.
COAXIAL 잭/OPTICAL 단자의 출력 모드에 대한 자세한 내용은 "Coaxial/Optical"(34페이지)을 참조하십시
오.
오디오 연결
힌트
AV INPUT
COAXIAL
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
OPTICAL
본 플레이어
OPTICAL 단자
에 연결
TVAV 리시버
광 케이블
(시판용)
동축 디지털 오디오 케이블
(시판용)
본 플레이어
AV 리시버
D D'
COAXIAL 잭에
연결
동축 입력 잭에
연결
입력 단자에
연결
TV
D E E
오디오 연결
15 Ko
한국어
연결
2
오디오 잭에 연
오디오 기기 또는 TV를 MIXED 2CH/7.1채널 서라운드 잭에 연결할 수 있습니다.
오디오 핀 케이블(부속품 및 시판용)을 MIXED 2CH 잭 또는 7.1채널 서라운드 잭에 단단히 연결하십시오.
오디오 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 35페이지를 참조하십시오.
멀티 채널 SA-CD 및 DVD-Audio를 재생하려면, 시판되는 오디오 핀 케이블을 사용하여 7.1채널 서라운드
잭을 AV 리시버의 해당 입력 잭에 연결하십시오.
주의!
모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 플레이어의 전원 케이블을 연결하지 마십시오.
서브우퍼를 SUBWOOFER 잭에 직접 연결할 수 있습니다. 본 플레이어에 TV를 직접 연결할 경우, Yamaha
Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System 같은 활성 서브우퍼를 이 잭에 연결하십시오.
MIXED 2CH/7.1ch 서라운드 잭에서 오디오 신호를 출력하려면 "Speaker Setting"(34페이지)을 참조하십시
오.
AUDIO
AUDIO IN
LR
AUDIO OUT
MIXED 2CH 󱿢󱸅
󱸥󰓥
오디오 핀 케이블
(부속품)
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐 󴩯󳠋󴳐
TVAV 리시버
본 플레이어
오디오 입력
잭에 연결
F F
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
MULTICH IN
SURROUND
LR
SURROUND BACK
LR
FRONT
LR
CENTER SUBWOOFER
AV 리시버
본 플레이어
G
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
오디오 핀
케이블
(부속품 및
시판용)
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
󶍷󴳐
󴩯󳠋󴳐
7.1ch
서라운드
잭에 연결
MULTI
CH IN
잭에
연결
󶍷󴳐 󴩯󳠋󴳐 󶍷󴳐 󴩯󳠋󴳐󶍷󴳐 󴩯󳠋󴳐
힌트
16 Ko
NETWORK 단자 및 USB 포트에 연결
본 플레이어를 네트워크에 연결하여 PC 컨텐츠를 재생할 수 있습니다.
BD-Live 호환 디스크를 재생하는 경우 인터넷에 연결하면 인터랙티브 기능을 가진 다양한 컨텐츠를 즐길
있습니다. BD-Live 기능에 대한 자세한 내용은 26페이지를 참조하십시오.
BD Local Storage용 USB 메모리 장치(2 GB 이상, FAT 32/16으로 포맷됨)를 플레이어의 뒷면 패널(또는 앞
면 패널)에 있는 USB 포트에 연결하면 BD-Live 데이터를 저장하거나 본 플레이어의 소프트웨어를 업그레이
드할 수 있습니다.
네트워크 케이블(시판용) 및 USB 메모리 장치(시판용)를 NETWORK 단자 USB 포트에 단단히 연결하십시
오.
STP(shielded twisted pair) 네트워크 케이블만 사용하십시오.
인터넷을 사용 중일 경우 아래와 같은 광대역 인터넷 연결이 필요합니다.
네트워크 케이블의 다른 커넥터를 허브/광대역 라우터에 연결하십시오.
USB 메모리 장치를 사용하기 전에
연결한 후에
Network 설정을 수동으로 설정하려면 "Network"(32페이지)를 참조하십시오.
네트워크에서 PC 컨텐츠를 재생하려면 "네트워크 컨텐츠 사용"(21페이지)을 참조하십시오.
네트워크 및 USB 연결
LAN
본 플레이어
광대역 인터넷 연결을 사용하는 경우 인터
넷 서비스 제공자와 계약을 해야 합니다.
자세한 내용은 가까운 인터넷 서비스 제공
자에 문의하십시오.
인터넷 환경에 따라 연결하는 기기 연결
방법이 다를 있으므로 사용하는 기기의
사용 설명서를 참조하십시오.
10BASE-T/100BASE-TX를 지원하는
네트워크 케이블/라우터를 사용하십시오.
주의:
BD-Live(26페이지)를 조작하거나 소
프트웨어 업그레이드를 수중일 때는
USB 메모리 장치를 분리하거나 전원
케이블을 뽑지 마십시오.
USB 메모리 장치를 본 플레이어의
USB 포트에 연결할 때 USB 확장 케이
블을 사용하지 마십시오. USB 확장
이블을 사용하면 플레이어가 올바로 실
행되지 않을 수 있습니다.
Yamaha는 본 플레이어에서 모든 브
드의 USB 메모리 장치가 작동된다고
보증하지 않습니다.
참고
참고
NETWORK
단자에 연결
인터넷
모뎀
네트워크 케이블
(시판용)
허브 또는
광대역 라우터
PC
USB 󲰡󲫭󱸅
󱸥󰓥
USB 메모리 장치
(시판용)
LAN 󰬝󱿅󱸅
󱸥󰓥
전면 패널의 USB 메모
리 장치에 BD-Live 데
이터를 저장하려면
Local Storage를 Front
USB로 설정하십시오.
(30페이지)
힌트
17 Ko
한국어
연결
2
REMOTE CONTROL 잭에 연결
REMOTE CONTROL(OUT/IN) 잭에 연결하면
모콘 신호를 전송 및 수신할 수 있습니다.
모노 3.5 mm 미니 플러그 케이블(시판용)을
REMOTE CONTROL(OUT/IN) 잭에 단단히 연결
하십시오.
AV 리시버가 SCENE 제어 신호 전송 기능이 있는
Yamaha 제품인 경우 SCENE 기능을 사용하여
플레이어를 제어할 수 있습니다.
주의!
모든 연결이 완료될 때까지 본 플레이어의 전원 케이블
을 연결하지 마십시오.
SCENE 기능에 대한 자세한 내용은 Yamaha AV
리시버에 부속된 설명서를 참조하십시오.
SCENE 기능이 지원되는 Yamaha 컴포넌트(예:
CD 플레이어)를 본 플레이어의 REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT) 잭에 연결할 수 있습니다.
RS-232C.
자세한 내용은 가까운 대리점에 문의하십시오.
전원 케이블 연결
모든 연결을 완료한 후 부속된 전원 케이블을 플레
이어 뒷면의 AC IN에 꽂으십시오. 그런 다음 AC
전원에 꽂으십시오.
감전 사고를 방지하려면 전원 케이블이 연결된 경
우 케이블에서 절연되지 않은 부분을 만지지 마십
시오.
기타 연결
힌트
REMOTE CONTROL IN
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
본 플레이어
REMOTE
CONTROL(IN)
잭에 연결
모노 3.5 mm 미니
플러그 케이블
(시판용)
리모콘
출력 잭에
연결
Yamaha 컴포넌트
리모콘
입력 잭에
연결
모노 3.5 mm 미
니 플러그 케이블
(시판용)
적외선 신호 수신기
또는 Yamaha 컴포넌트
(예: AV 리시버)
REMOTE
CONTROL
(OUT) 잭에
연결
참고
AC 콘센트에 연결
AC IN󱸅 󱸥󰓥
18 Ko
재생
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup을 사용하
여 설정
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup을 사용하면 언어, 해상도
화면 비율을 간편하게 설정할 수 있습니다. 본 플레이어
를 구입하거나 업그레이드 한 후 처음으로 켜면 Initial
Wizard 화면이 표시됩니다. SETUP 메뉴 = System =
Easy Setup에서 이와 같은 설정을 할 수도 있습니다.
1 Easy Setup 화면이 표시된 경우 ENTER를 누르면
Easy Setup이 시작됩니다.
2 5/a 를 눌러 화면에 표시하려는 언어를 선택한 다음,
ENTER를 누릅니다.
3 5/a 를 눌러 해상도를 선택한 다음, ENTER누릅니
다. 설정 항목에 대한 자세한 내용은
"Resolution"(33페이지)를 참조하십시오.
4 5/a 를 눌러 화면 비율을 선택한 다음, ENTER를 누
릅니다. 설정 항목에 대한 자세한 내용은 "TV
Screen"(32페이지)을 참조하십시오.
Easy Setup이 완료되었습니다.
5 ENTER를 눌러 Easy Setup을 종료합니다.
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup이 완료된 후에 아무 사
진도 표시되지 않으면 "문제 해결"(39페이지)을
조하십시오.
본 플레이어를 켜면 3D 비디오 재생에 관한 경고
메시지가 표시됩니다. ENTER를 눌러 메시지를 닫거
CLEAR를 눌러 메시지를 비활성화시키십시오.
(30페이지)
INITIAL WIZARD/EASY SETUP
참고
ENTER
FinishPrevious
Setting
Page: 5/5
Easy Setup
The set-up wizard is finished!
Now press the Finish button to go to SETUP. Please
enjoy!
19 Ko
한국어
재생
3
HOME 및 MEDIA 메뉴를 사용하면 데이터 디스크,
USB 메모리 장치 및 네트워크에서 멀티미디어 파일을
찾아 재생할 수 있습니다.
재생 가능한 디스크 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은
3페이지를 참조하십시오.
사진/음악/비디오 재생
기본 조작
5/a : 초점을 이동합니다.
2: 상위 폴더로 돌아갑니다.
3: 단일 폴더/파일을 선택/선택 해제합니다.
HOME: HOME 메뉴 화면으로 이동/종료합니다.
ENTER: 폴더/파일을 확인합니다.
MEDIA 메뉴 상단의 아이콘
: 트레이에 있는 디스크를 재생하거나 데이터 디스
크의 내용을 표시합니다.
: USB 포트에 연결된 USB 메모리 장치의 내용을
표시합니다.
: 네트워크에서 DLNA(21페이지) 서버를 검색합
다.
: 연결된 DLNA 서버의 내용을 표시합니다.
선택한 폴더의 파일 재생 시 일반적인 조작
예: USB 메모리 장치에서 동영상 파일 선택
MEDIA 메뉴 화면으로 이동하기 전에 비디오 재생
을 중지하십시오.
1 HOME을 눌러 HOME 메뉴 화면으로 이동합니다.
2/3 를 눌러 MEDIA를 선택한 다음, ENTER를 누릅니
다.
2 MEDIA 화면이 나타납니다.
3 재생하려는 파일이 포함된 항목을 선택한 다음,
ENTER를 누릅니다.
HOME/MEDIA 메뉴
참고
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
2ND
AUDIO
A/B
HOME
참고
HOME/MEDIA 메뉴
20 Ko
4 재생하려는 Photo, Music, Video 또는 AVCHD 폴
더를 선택한 다음, ENTER를 누릅니다.
상위 폴더로 돌아가려2를 누르거나 를 선택
합니다.
이 단계에서 선택한 파일 유형만 다음 단계에 표시
됩니다. 예를 들어, 이 단계에서 Photo 폴더를
택한 경우 다음 단계에서는 사진 파일만 표시됩니
다. 사진 이외의 다른 것을 재생하려면 이 계층
로 돌아가 파일 유형을 다시 선택하십시오.
5 재생하려는 파일이 포함된 폴더를 선택합니다.
6 재생하려는 파일을 선택한 다음, ENTER를 누릅니다.
비디오 파일을 선택한 경우 재생이 시작됩니다.
음악 파일을 선택한 경우 상태 화면이 표시되고 재생
이 시작됩니다.
사진 파일을 선택한 경우 슬라이드 쇼가 시작됩니다.
음악이 있는 슬라이드 쇼를 즐기려면, 음악이 재생
되는 동안 HOME눌러 HOME 메뉴 화면으로 돌아
가 사진 파일을 선택합니다.
파일 내용에 따라 표시된 파일이 재생되지 않을
있습니다.
사진을 보기 위한 조작
사진을 보는 동안에는 리모콘 버튼이 아래와 같이 작동
합니다.
: 슬라이드 쇼를 정지하고 파일 찾아보기로 돌아갑
다.
: 슬라이드 쇼를 일시 정지합니다.
: 슬라이드 쇼를 재생합니다.
: 다음 사진으로 이동합니다.
: 이전 사진으로 이동합니다.
: 슬라이드 쇼의 속도가 3단계로 빨라집니다.
: 슬라이드 쇼의 속도가 3단계로 느려집니다.
5: 사진을 뒤집습니다.
a :진을 반사합니다.
2: 사진을 시계 반대 방향으로 회전합니다.
3: 사진을 시계 방향으로 회전합니다.
ZOOM: 사진을 확대/축소합니다(확대/축소: 각각 3단계).
5/a /2/3 : 󱣡󲇹󱾩 󲺉󱊩󱔩󰬙 󲢩 󰓲󱻥 󲅁 󱋝󰴑󱸅󱥑 󱾩
󰰎󲶞󰫽󰬙 .
DIGEST: 썸네일 모드(7페이지)로 전환합니다. 썸네일이
표시된 경우 / 를 사용하여 이전/다음 페이지
로 이동할 수 있습니다.
참고
힌트
참고
HOME/MEDIA 메뉴
21 Ko
재생
3
한국어
네트워크 컨텐츠 사용
본 플레이어는 DLNA 인증 디지털 미디어 플레이어입
니다, 사용자의 홈 네트워크에서 DLNA 서버에 저장된
사진, 음악 및 비디오 컨텐츠를 관리할 수 있습니다.
DLNA에 대하여
DLNA(Digital Living Network Alliance)는 가정에서
네트워크를 통해 디지털 미디어를 간편하게 공유할 수
있으며, DLNA 버 소프트웨어가 설치된 PC 또는 다른
DLNA 호환 장치에 저장된 디지털 컨텐츠를 본 플레이
어를 통해 TV에서 즐길 수 있습니다. 본 플레이어를
DLNA 서버에 연결하려면 DLNA 서버 또는 장치를 일
부 설정해야 합니다. 자세한 내용은 DLNA 서버 소프트
웨어 또는 DLNA 장치를 참조하십시오.
공유 컨텐츠 재생
1 PC에서 파일을 재생하려면, Windows Media
Player 12 같DLNA 서버 소프트웨어를 설치하고
재생하려는 파일을 공유합니다.
2 DLNA 서버 소프트웨어가 설치된 PC 또는 홈 네트워
크에 연결된 DLNA 장치를 켭니다.
3 HOME을 눌러 HOME 메뉴 화면을 표시합니다. 그런 다
음 MEDIA를 선택하여 MEDIA 메뉴로 이동합니다.
네트워크에 연결된 DLNA 서버가 화면에 표시됩니다.
사용하는 DLNA 서버가 표시되지 않을 경우
DLNA Search를 선택하고 서버를 찾아보십시오.
DLNA 서버에 따라 서버에서 본 플레이어를 허가
해야 할 수도 있습니다.
DLNA 서버에서 파일을 재생하려면 본 플레이어
와 서버가 동일한 액세스 포인트에 연결되어 있어
야 합니다.
파일 요구 사항이 호환되지 않을 수도 있습니다.
파일 특징 DLNA 서버 용량에 따라 일부 제한이
있을 수 있습니다.
4 재생하려는 파일을 선택합니다.
홈 네트워크 조건에 따라 재생 및 작동 상태에 영
향을 미칠 수도 있습니다.
USB 메모리 장치 또는 미디어 서버의 DVD 드라
이브 같은 이동식 매체의 파일이 올바로 공유되지
않을 수 있습니다.
참고
참고
22 Ko
아래의 네트워크에서 제공하는 비디오를 즉시 시청할 수 있습니다.
YouTube
타사가 제공하는 컨텐츠에 접근하려면 고속 인터넷 연결이 필요하며, 계정 등록 및 유료 구독이 필요할 수도
있습니다.
타사가 제공하는 컨텐츠 서비스는 예고 없이 언제든변경, 보류, 중단, 또는 중지될 있으며, 이와 관련하여
Yamaha에게는 어떠한 책임도 없습니다.
일부 컨텐츠는 특정 국가에서만 사용이 가능할 수 있으며 일부 언어로만 제공될 수도 있습니다.
Yamaha는 특정 기간 동안의 컨텐츠 서비스에 대한 지속적 제공이나 가용성에 대한 진술이나 보증을 제공하지
않으며, 명시적이든 암묵적이든 그러한 모든 보증에 대한 책임이 없습니다.
본 플레이어를 이용하여 인터넷을 통해 YouTube에서
영화를 시청할 수 있습니다.
해당 서비스들은 예고 없이 변경될 수 있습니다.
1 HOME을 눌러 HOME 메뉴 화면을 표시합니다.
모델에 따라 HOME 메뉴 화면은 다를 수 있습니다.
2 5/a /2 /3를 눌러 YouTube를 선택한 다음, ENTER
를 누릅니다.
HOME 메뉴 화면으로 돌아가려면 RETURN을 누릅
니다.
네트워크 서비스 사용
참고
YouTube에서 비디오 재생
힌트
힌트
23 Ko
한국어
재생
3
이 장에서는 시판용 BD 및 DVD 디스크, SA-CD, CD
및 녹화된 DVD-RW/R 디스크의 재생에 대해 설명합니
다.
기본적인 재생 조작에 대해서는 6페이지를 참조하
십시오.
On Screen 메뉴
On Screen 메뉴를 표시하려ON SCREEN을 누릅니다.
그런 다음, 5/a /2 /3를 눌러 항목을 선택하고, ENTER
를 눌러 원하는 기능을 조작합니다.
On Screen 메뉴에 포함된 항목은 다음과 같습니다.
Title : 재생 중인 타이틀 번호를
표시합니다. 이 항목에서 타이틀을 선택하여 원하는
이틀로 건너뛸 수 있습니다.
Chapter : 재생 중인 챕터 번호를
표시합니다. 이 항목에서 챕터를 선택하여 원하는 챕
로 건너뛸 수 있습니다.
Track/File : 재생
인 트랙/파일 번호를 표시합니다. 이 항목에서 트랙/파
일을 선택하여 원하는 트랙/파일로 건너뛸 수 있습니다.
Time : 재생 시간
을 표시합니다. 다음 중에서 표시 유형을 선택합니다.
타이틀, 챕터, 디스크, 트랙 또는 파일의 경과된
생 시간
타이틀, 챕터, 디스크, 트랙 또는 파일의 남아 있는
재생 시간
Mode/Play Mode
: 현재 재생
모드를 표시합니다. 다음 중에서 재생 모드를 선택할
있습니다.
Normal: 일반 재생.
Shuffle: 반복 없이 무작위 재생.
Random: 반복하여 무작위 재생.
Normal
Shuffle CH (챕터)
Shuffle TT (타이틀)
Shuffle All
Random CH (챕터)
Random TT (타이틀)
Random All
Normal
Shuffle F (폴더)
Shuffle All
Random F (폴더)
Random All
Audio : 현재 선택된 BD/DVD 디
스크의 오디오 언어/신호를 표시합니다. 원하는 오디오
유형을 선택할 수 있습니다.
Angle : 현재 선택된 앵글을 표시합니다.
디오가 여러 앵글로 녹화된 경우 앵글을 변경할 수 있습
니다.
Subtitle
: 자막이 제공되는 경우
현재 선택된 자막 언어를 표시합니다.
Subtitle Style : 현재 선택된 자막 스타일을 표시
합니다. 이 기능은 비디오 파일 외부 자막인 경우에만
사용할 수 있습니다. 자막의 텍스트 스타일을 선택
있습니다.
Bitrate : 오디오/비
디오 신호의 비트 전송률을 표시합니다.
Second Video : PIP를 설정/해제합니다(6페이지).
Second Audio : 보조 오디오를 설정/해제합니다
(6페이지).
Ins Search
: 30초를 건너뜁
니다.
Ins Replay
: 10초 전의 내용
부터 다시 봅니다.
Slide Show :
슬라이드 쇼의 속도를 표시합니다. Slow/Medium/Fast
중에서 슬라이드 쇼의 속도를 선택할 수 있습니다.
Transition : 화면에 사진이 나타나는 방법을
표시합니다. 전환 유형을 선택할 수 있습니다.
Code Page : DivX 비디오(41페이지)에 추가한
자막의 문자 코드를 선택합니다.
고급 재생 조작
참고
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD VIDEO
CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
CD
DVD
VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO
BD DVD VIDEO
BD DVD
BD DVD VIDEO
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD
BD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
PHOTO
PHOTO
VIDEO
고급 재생 조작
24 Ko
상태 메뉴
자막, 앵글 설정 및 현재 재생된 타이틀/챕터/트랙 번호
등 다양한 설정을 표시합니다. 상태 메뉴를 표시하려
STATUS를 누릅니다. 상태 메뉴에는 다음과 같은 메뉴가
포함되어 있습니다.
: BD 재생 시 아이콘
1 (재생 상태)
2 (디스크 유형/비디오 파일 아이콘)
3 (재생 중인 타이틀 번호): SEARCH 󱒹󲫱(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)
󱽹 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡 󲇵󲁊󲶑 󲣵󱾩󲫵󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
4 (재생 중인 챕터 번호): SEARCH 󱒹󲫱(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)
󱽹 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡 󲇵󲁊󲶑 󲒊󲥥󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
5 (경과된 재생 시간): SEARCH 󱒹󲫱(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)󱽹 󱣡
󱻞󲶍󱸡 󲇵󲁊󲶑 󲇵󲁅󱽱󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
6 (현재 선택된 자막): SUBTITLE 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡
󱿅󱇾 󱷭󱷩󱆱 󱓵󰓲󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
7 (현재 선택된 오디오): AUDIO 󱒹󲫱󱽹 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡
󱹙󰵉󱹙 󱷭󱷩 󰹅󰫉 󲹊󱬒󱽹 󱓵󰓲󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
8
(반복 모드):
󲸹󱿡 󱑍󱔪 󱋝󰴑(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽
󰬙.
: 음악 파일 재생 시 아이콘
1 (재생 상태)
2
(반복 모드):
󲸹󱿡 󱑍󱔪 󱋝󰴑(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽
󰬙.
3 (디스크 유형/음악 파일 아이콘)
4 (아트워크) : 󲭁󱾱󱸅 󱵹󲫭󱼁󲢡󰐵 󲰡󲶝󰱑 󰓲
󱻥 󱵹󲫭󱼁󲢡󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
5 (재생 중인 트랙/파일 번호): SEARCH 󱒹󲫱(8󲯍
󱾩󲇵)󱽹 󱣡󱻞󲶍󱸡 󲇵󲁊󲶑 󲫭󰿎󱽱󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽
󰬙.
6 (정보) : 󲭁󱾱󱸅 󱾁󱵺 󲁊󱔩󰐵 󲰡󲶝󰱑 󰓲󱻥 󱾁
󱵺 󲁊󱔩󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽󰬙.
7 (경과된 재생 시간): SEARCH 󱒹󲫱(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)󱽹 󱣡
󱻞󲶍󱸡 󲇵󲁊󲶑 󲇵󲁅󱽱󱂑 󱾩󰰎󲶕 󱩍 󱾽󱫪󰫽󰬙.
8 (진행률 막대) : 󲸹󱿡 󰔖󱾍 󲇹󲶾 󱣶󲤑󱆱 󲲑󱬑
󲶞󰫽󰬙.
9 (오디오 레벨 측정계): 󲸹󱿡󱾍 󱾁󰿾 󱀽󱓝󱽹 󲲑󱬑󲶞󰫽
󰬙.
1 (재생 상태)
2 (사진 파일 아이콘)
3 (표시되어 있는 파일 번호)
4
(반복 모드):
󲸹󱿡 󱑍󱔪 󱋝󰴑(8󲯍󱾩󲇵)󱆱 󲲑󱬑󲶞
󰫽󰬙.
5 (슬라이드 쇼 속도)
BD DVD VIDEO
13
78
245
6
DVD CD MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
MUSIC
PHOTO
고급 재생 조작
25 Ko
재생
3
한국어
Bookmark 사용
이 기능을 사용하면 비디오에서 지정한 지점에
Bookmark를 설정할 수 있습니다. Bookmark를 설정하
면, 이 기능을 사용하여 설정한 지점으로 이동할 수 있
습니다. 북마크를 12개까지 설정할 수 있습니다.
1 동영상 재생 도중 MARKER를 눌러 Bookmark를 설
합니다. Bookmark 번호 및 상태가 표시됩니다.
2 Bookmark를 설정한 다음, DIGEST를 눌러
Bookmark 선택 막대를 표시합니다.
3 2/3 를 눌러 재생하려는 Bookmark를 선택한 다음,
ENTER를 누릅니다.
선택한 Bookmark를 삭제하려면 CLEAR를 누릅니다.
재생이 끝나면(예: 디스크 꺼내기, 두 번 누르
기) 북마크가 자동으로 삭제됩니다.
프로그램 재
오디오 디스크 트랙 또는 DVD 챕터의 재생 순서를 프로
그래밍할 수 있습니다.
재생 도중 PROGRAM 눌러 PROGRAM 창을 표시하고
재생 순서를 프로그래밍합니다.
최대 15개의 트랙/챕터를 프로그래밍할 수 있습니다.
예: CD 트랙의 재생 순서 프로그래밍
1 재생 도중 PROGRAM 누릅니다.
2 ENTER를 눌러 재생 순서를 프로그래밍합니다.
오디오 디스크의 경우, 5/a 를 눌러 원하는 트랙
선택한 다음 ENTER를 누릅니다.
DVD-Video 디스크의 경우, 트랙 대신 원하는 타이
틀(TT로 표시됨) 및 챕터(CH로 표시됨)를 선택합니
다.
설정 트랙을 지우려면, 지우려는 트랙을 선택한 다
CLEAR를 누릅니다.
프로그램 재생을 취소하려면 RETURN누릅니다.
3 프로그래밍을 완료한 다음, 를 눌러 설정하면 프
로그램 재생이 시작됩니다.
4 프로그램 재생을 취소하려면 를 두 번 눌러 재생
을 완전히 중지합니다.
검색 사용
재생 도중 지정한 지점으로 이동할 수 있습니다.
1 재생 도중 SEARCH를 누릅니다. 상태 표시줄이 나타납
니다.
2 5/a /2/3눌러 아래 항목 하나를 선택한 다음,
ENTER를 누릅니다.
:
타이틀 번호( 로 표시됨)
챕터 번호( 로 표시됨)
타이틀 경과 시간( 로 표시됨)
챕터 경과 시간( 로 표시됨)
:
트랙 번호( 로 표시됨)
트랙 경과 시간( 로 표시됨)
디스크 경과 시간( 로 표시됨)
:
파일 번호( 로 표시됨)
파일 경과 시간( 로 표시됨)
3 5/a 또는 숫자 버튼을 눌러 초점을 맞춘 항목의 값
을 설정/조정하고, ENTER를 눌러 지정한 지점으로
동합니다.
4 상태 표시줄을 닫으려면 STATUS를 누릅니다.
참고
DVD VIDEO
DVD CD
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC
BD DVD
CD
VIDEO MUSIC
고급 재생 조작
26 Ko
BONUSVIEW 및 BD-Live 즐기기
본 플레이어는 BONUSVIEW(41페이지)(BD-ROM
Profile 1 버전 1.1) 및 BD-Live(41페이지)(BD-ROM
Profile 2) 재생 기능을 지원합니다.
기능 및 재생 방법은 디스크에 따라 다릅니다. 디
스크 안내 또는 부속된 사용 설명서를 참조하십시
오.
Picture in Picture 기능 사용
(보조 오디오/비디오 재생)
Picture in Picture와 호화되는 보조 오디오 및 비디오
가 포함된 BD-Video에서 보조 오디오 및 비디오를 화
면 구석에 작은 비디오로 동시에 재생할 수 있습니다.
PIP Mark( ) 또는 Secondary Audio
Mark( )가 표시된 상태에서 PIP를 누르면
Picture in Picture 기능이 설정/해제됩니다.
보조 오디오를 들으려면, Audio Output 설정
(Coaxial/Optical 또는 HDMI)이 PCM 또는
Reencode(34페이지)로 설정되어 있는지 확인하십
시오.
디스크에 따라 보조 오디오를 들으려면 디스크의
처음 메뉴에서 보조 오디오를 설정해야 수도
있습니다(7페이지).
Picture in Picture의 보조 오디오 및 비디오는 컨
텐츠에 따라 자동으로 재생되기도 하고 삭제되기
도 합니다. 또한 재생 가능한 영역이 제한되기도
합니다.
BD-Live 기능 사용
1. 네트워크 설정(32페이지)을 설정합니다.
2. USB 메모리 장치를 본 플레이어에 연결합니
다(16페이지).
BD-Live 데이터가 본 플레이어에 연결된 USB
모리 장치에 저장됩니다. 이 기능을 사용하려면
2.0 High Speed(480 Mbit/s)를 지원하는 USB 메
모리 장치(2GB 이상, FAT 32/16 포맷)를 Local
Storage에서 선택한 USB 포트에 연결하십시오
(30페이지). 기본 설정은 후면 패널에 있는 USB
포트입니다.
필요할 경우 USB 메모리 장치에 BUDA 폴더가
동으로 생성됩니다.
저장 공간이 충분하지 않을 경우 데이터가 복사/다
운로드되지 않습니다. 불필요한 데이터를 삭제하
거나 새 USB 메모리 장치를 사용하십시오.
데이터를 로드(읽기/쓰기)하는 데 시간이 걸릴 수
있습니다.
Yamaha는 본 플레이어에서 모든 브랜드의 USB
메모리 장치가 작동된다고 보증하지 않습니다.
USB 메모리 장치를 플레이어의 USB 포트에 연결
할 때 USB 확장 케이블을 사용하지 마십시오.
USB 확장 케이블을 사용하면 플레이어가 올바로
실행되지 않을 수 있습니다.
3. 디스크를 재생합니다.
4. 디스크 설명서에 따라 BD-Live를 실행합니
다.
BD-Live 컨텐츠 등의 재생 방법은 BD 디스크
명서의 지침에 따라 조작하십시오.
BD-Live 기능을 사용하려면, 네트워크 연결(16페
이지) 및 Network 설정(32페이지)을 수행하십시
오.
BD-Live 컨텐츠에 대한 액세스를 제한하는 설정
방법에 대해서는 "BD-Live Connection"(32페이
지)을 참조하십시오.
부속된 프로그램을 본 플레이어에 연결된 USB 메
모리 장치로 다운로드하는 데 필요한 시간은 인터
넷 연결 속도 및 프로그램의 데이터량에 따라 다릅
니다.
인터넷을 통해 제공된 BD-Live 프로그램은 서비
스 제공자의 상태(업그레이드)에 따라 연결이 표시
되지 않을 수 있습니다. 이 경우 디스크를 꺼내고
다시 시도해 보십시오.
BD 디스크 메뉴에서 BD-Live 기능을 선택한 후
에도 BD-Live 화면이 표시되지 않을 경우, USB
메모리 장치에 여유 공간이 충분하지 않을 수 있습
니다. 이 경우 플레이어에서 디스크를 꺼낸 다음,
"Local Storage"(30페이지)의 "Format" 메뉴를
사용하여 USB 메모리 장치의 데이터를 지우십시
오.
참고
참고
주 비디오 보조 비디오
참고
참고
27 Ko
한국어
설정
4
설정
SETUP 메뉴에서는 리모콘을 사용하여 다양한 오디오/비디오 설정을 할 수 있고 기능을 조정할 수 있습니다.
SETUP 메뉴
메뉴/하위 메뉴 항목 기능 페이지
General Setting
System Screen Saver 면 보호기를 설정/해제합니다. 30
Disc Auto Playback 플레이어에서 디스크가 자동으로 재생되도록 설정합니다. 30
HDMI Control 본 플레이어에서 TV/AV 리시버의 리모콘 제어 신호를 수
하도록 설정합니다.
30
Network Control 이더넷을 통한 제어를 설정/해제합니다. 30
Load Default Security 설정을 제외한 모든 설정을 기본 설정으로 재설정
합니다.
30
Upgrade 본 플레이어를 업그레이드합니다. 30
Easy Setup 언어, 해상도, 화면 비율을 설정합니다. 30
Local Storage Local Storage(30페이지)의 상태를 표시하고, Local
Storage를 포맷하고, Local Storage에서 앞/뒤 USB 포트를
선택합니다.
30
3D Playback
Message
본 플레이어를 켜면 3D 비디오 재생에 관한 경고 메시지가
표시됩니다.
30
Language OSD On Screen 표시 언어를 선택합니다. 31
Menu 디스크 메뉴 언어에 우선 순위를 부여합니다. 31
Audio 오디오 언어에 우선 순위를 부여합니다. 31
Subtitle 자막 언어에 우선 순위를 부여합니다. 31
Playback Closed Caption 자막 방송을 설정/해제합니다. 31
Angle Mark 앵글이 여러 개인 BD/DVD를 재생하는 경우 Angle Mark가
표시되도록 설정합니다.
31
PIP Mark Picture in Picture가 있는 BD/DVD를 재생하는 경우 PIP
Mark가 표시되도록 설정합니다.
31
Secondary Audio
Mark
보조 오디오가 있는 BD/DVD를 재생하는 경우 Secondary
Audio Mark가 표시되도록 설정합니다.
31
DivX(R) VOD DRM DivX(R) 비디오의 등록 코드를 표시합니다. 31
DVD-Audio Mode DVD-Audio 모드를 DVD-Audio/DVD-Video로 설정합니
다.
31
Security Change Password Parental Control 및 Country Code의 암호를 변경합니다. 31
Parental Control 디스크 내용에 따라 Parental Control을 설정합니다. 31
Country Code Country Code를 설정합니다. 31
Network Internet Connection 인터넷 연결을 Enable/Disable로 설정합니다. 32
Information 네트워크 정보 화면을 표시합니다. 32
Connection Test 네트워크 연결 테스트를 수행합니다. 32
IP Setting IP 설정을 Auto/Manual로 설정합니다. 32
BD-Live
Connection
BD-Live 연결을 Permitted/Partial Permitted/Prohibited
로 설정합니다.
32
DLNA DLNA를 Enable/Disable로 설정합니다. 32
Proxy Setting 프록시 설정을 합니다. 32
SETUP 메뉴
28 Ko
Display Setting
TV 3D Output 3D 또는 2D 비디오를 선택합니다. 32
TV Screen 연결된 TV의 화면 비율을 설정하고, 비디오 출력을 조정
니다.
32
Resolution 출력 비디오의 해상도를 선택합니다. 33
TV System TV System을 NTSC/PAL/Multi 중에서 선택합니다. 33
Color Space Color Space를 RGB/YCbCr 4:4:4/YCbCr 4:2:2/Full RGB
중에서 선택합니다.
33
HDMI Deep Color HDMI Deep Color를 30 bits/36 bits/Off 중에서 선택합니
다.
33
HDMI 1080p 24Hz HDMI 1080p 24Hz를 Auto/Off로 설정합니다. 33
Lip Sync 입모양과 목소리가 서로 동기화되지 않는 경우처럼 비디오와
오디오 사이의 지연을 조정합니다.
33
Video Process Video Mode 비디오 영상을 조정합니다. 33
Color Adjust 각 색상의 Brightness/Saturation/Hue를 조정합니다. 33
Auto Contrast 컨트라스트를 조정하여 재생되는 화상을 최적화합니다. 33
Noise Reduction Noise Reduction 레벨을 설정합니다. 33
De-interlacing
Mode
비디오 신호 감지 방법을 설정합니다.
34
Audio Setting
Audio Output Coaxial/Optical COAXIAL 잭/OPTICAL 단자의 출력 모드를 Bitstream/
PCM/Reencode/Off 중에서 선택합니다.
34
HDMI HDMI 단자의 출력 모드를 Bitstream/PCM/Reencode/Off
중에서 선택합니다.
34
Downsampling 디지털 오디오 신호의 다운 샘플링 주파수를 48k/96k/192k
중에서 선택합니다.
34
DRC DRC(Dynamic Range Compression)를 설정합니다. 34
SACD Output SACD Priority 하이브리드 SA-CD를 재생하는 경우 컨텐츠를 선택합니다. 34
HDMI Output SA-CD를 재생하는 경우 HDMI 단자의 출력 모드를 DSD/
PCM 중에서 선택합니다.
34
Speaker Setting Configuration 7.1채널 서라운드 잭의 오디오 출력을 설정합니다. 34
2ch Downmix 아날로그 2채널로 다운믹스하는 방법을 선택합니다. 34
Post Process Up Mix 2채널 오디오 신호를 멀티 채널화합니다. 34
System Information
소프트웨어 버전 및 MAC 주소(42페이지)를 표시합니다.
34
메뉴/하위 메뉴 항목 기능 페이지
SETUP 메뉴
29 Ko
설정
4
한국어
SETUP 메뉴 조작 예
본 플레이어에서 설정을 하려면 SETUP 메뉴 화면을
러와야 합니다. 다음은 SETUP 메뉴의 기본 조작에 대
한 설명입니다.
예: Parental Control 설정
재생 도중에는 일부 항목을 설정할 수 없습니다.
이 경우, 설정하기 전에 를 두 번 눌러 재생을
완전히 중지하십시오.
1. SETUP 메뉴 화면을 표시합니다.
SETUP을 눌러 SETUP 메뉴 화면을 표시합니다.
2/3 를 눌러 General Setting을 선택한 다음,
ENTER 또는 a 를 누릅니다.
2. 하위 메뉴를 선택합니다.
5/a 를 눌러 Security를 선택한 다음, ENTER 또는
커서 3를 누릅니다.
3. 메뉴 항목을 선택합니다.
5/a 를 눌러 Parental Control을 선택한 다음,
ENTER 또는 커서 3를 누릅니다.
4. 암호를 입력합니다.
숫자 버튼으로 압호를 입력합니다.
기본 암호는 0000입니다.
올바른 암호를 입력해야 다음 설정 화면으로 이
동할 수 있습니다.
암호를 변경하려면 "Change Password"(31페
이지)를 참조하십시오.
5. 다음 항목을 선택합니다.
5/a 를 눌러 BD/DVD의 Parental Control 벨을
선택한 다음, ENTER를 누릅니다.
6. 메뉴 화면을 종료합니다.
2를 누르면 이전 메뉴로 돌아갑니다.
참고
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
RETURN
ON SCREEN
ENTER
CLEAR SEARCH
SETUP
PIP
REPEAT
HOME
SETUP 메뉴
30 Ko
General Setting
기본 설정에는 "
*
"가 표시되어 있습니다.
System
Screen Saver
화면 보호기를 On/Off로 설정할 수 있습니다.
On으로 설정한 경우, 본 플레이어에서 3분 동안 아무런
조작도 하지 않으면 화면 보호기 모드로 전환됩니다.
이후에도 6분 동안 아무런 조작도 하지 않으면 본 플레
이어가 대기 모드로 들어갑니다.
On
*
, Off
Disc Auto Playback
Disc Auto Playback을 On/Off로 설정할 수 있습니다.
On으로 설정한 경우, 디스크를 넣으면 디스크가 자동으
로 재생됩니다.
On
*
, Off
HDMI Control
플레이어가 HDMI 케이블(12페이지)을 통해 HDMI
Control 기능과 호환되는 TV/AV 리시버의 제어 신호
를 수신하도록 설정할 수 있습니다.
On, Off
*
Network Control
이더넷을 통한 제어를 On/Off로 설정할 있습니다.
플레이어는 YNC(Yamaha Network Control) 프로토콜
을 채택하였습니다.
On, Off
*
On으로 설정하면 네트워크 제어 기능으로 인해 대
기 모드 동안 전력 소모가 늘어납니다.
On으로 설정하면 시스템 시작 시간이 단축됩니다.
Load Default
Security 설정(31페이지)제외한 본 플레이어의 모든
설정을 기본 설정으로 재설정할 수 있습니다. 기본 설정
에 대한 자세한 내용은 27-34페이지를 참조하십시오.
Upgrade
디스크, USB 저장 장치 또는 네트워크에서 소프트웨어
를 수동으로 업그레이드할 수 있습니다. 소프트웨어 업
그레이드에 대한 자세한 내용은 "소프트웨어 업그레이
드"(37페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Easy Setup
Easy Setup(18페이지)을 수행할 수 있습니다.
Local Storage
Local Storage 정보를 표시하고, Local Storage를 포
맷하고, Front USB/Rear USB를 선택하여 BD-Live
이터를 저장할 수 있습니다.
USB 메모리 장치에서 "BUDA" 폴더를 포맷하려면(비
우려면), Information을 선택하고 화면에 "Format" 표
시되면 ENTER를 누릅니다.
Front USB, Rear USB
*
Local Storage는 Blu-ray 디스크를 재생하는 경
우 보조 메모리로 사용됩니다.
3D Playback Message
본 플레이어를 켜면 TV에 표시되는 3D 비디오 재생에
관한 경고 메시지를 켜거나 끌 수 있습니다.
On
*
, Off
HDMI Control 기능 사용
HDMI Control 기능을 사용하면 본 플레이어와
TV(HDMI Control 기능 지원)를 대화 형식으로 조작
할 수 있습니다.
HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 본 플레이어를 HDMI
Control 기능과 호환되는 TV에 연결하고 SETUP 메
뉴의 HDMI Control을 On으로 설정하면(30페이지)
다음과 같은 기능을 수행할 수 있습니다.
자동 입력 선택 기능
플레이어에서 재생을 시작하면, TV(및 본 플레이
어가 AV시버를 통해 TV에 연결된 경우에는 AV
리시버)의 입력 셀렉터가 본 플레이어로 자동으로
전환됩니다. TV에 따라 TV가 자동으로 켜집니다.
자동 전원 꺼짐 기능
본 플레이어가 정지 모드에 있고 SETUP 메뉴 화면
이 표시되지 않은 상태에서 TV를 끄면 본 플레이어
도 자동으로 꺼집니다.
TV에 따라 HDMI Control 기능이 올바로 작동
하지 않을 수 있습니다.
TV 또는 AV 리시버에 따라 위에 표시되지 않은
다른 기능이 작동될 수도 있습니다.
HDMI Control 기능을 사용하려면, 모든 컴포넌
트(본 플레이어, TV 및 AV 리시버)에서 HDMI
Control 기능을 설정해야 합니다. 특정 조작
필요할 수도 있습니다.
TV에 따라 각 기능의 활성화/비활성화를 별도
로 설정하기도 합니다.
설정과 관련된 자세한 내용은 TV 및/또는 AV
리시버에 부속된 사용 설명서를 참조하십시오.
On으로 설정하면 HDMI 제어 기능으로 인해 대
기 모드 동안 전력 소모가 증가합니다.
참고
참고
힌트
SETUP 메뉴
31 Ko
설정
4
한국어
Language
OSD
SETUP 메뉴와 같이 화면에 표시되는 메시지 또는 메뉴
인 On Screen 표시 언어를 선택할 수 있습니다.
English
*
, , , , ,
, ,
러시아 모델의 경우 기본 설정은 입니다.
Menu
디스크 메뉴 언어에 우선 순위를 부여할 수 있습니다.
English
*
, , , , , ,
, Portuguese, Danish, , Finnish,
Norwegian, , Korean, Japanese, More
러시아 모델의 경우 기본 설정은 입니다.
한국 모델의 경우 기본 설정은 Korean입니다.
Audio
BD/DVD 오디오 언어에 우선 순위를 부여할
있습니다. 설정 항목에 대한 자세한 내용은 "Menu"(31
페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Subtitle
Subtitle 언어에 우선 순위를 부여할 수 있습니다.
English, , , , , ,
, Portuguese, Danish, , Finnish,
Norwegian, , Korean, Japanese, More, Off
*
러시아 모델의 경우 기본 설정은 입니다.
한국 모델의 경우 기본 설정은 Korean입니다.
Playback
Closed Caption
자막 방송이 있는 BD/DVD를 재생하는 경우 자막 방송
(41페이지)이 표시되도록 설정할 수 있습니다.
On, Off
*
Angle Mark
앵글이 여러 개인 BD/DVD를 재생하는 경우 Angle
Mark( )가 표시되도록 설정할 수 있습니다.
On
*
, Off
PIP Mark
Picture in Picture(26페이지)가 있는 BD를 재생하는
경우 PIP Mark( )가 표시되도록 설정할 수 있습니다.
On
*
, Off
Secondary Audio Mark
보조 오디오가 있는 BD를 재생하는 경우 Secondary
Audio Mark( )가 표시되도록 설정할 수 있습니다.
On
*
, Off
DivX(R) VOD DRM
DivX(R) 비디오의 등록 코드를 표시할 수 있습니다.
DVD-Audio Mode
일부 DVD-Audio 디스크에는 DVD-Audio 컨텐츠 이
외에 DVD-Video 컨텐츠도 포함되어 있습니다. DVD-
Audio 모드 또는 DVD-Video 모드를 선택할 수 있습니
다.
설정은 디스크를 넣지 않은 경우에만 사용할
있습니다.
Security
Change Password
Parental Control 레벨 및 Country Code를 변경하기
위한 암호를 설정할 수 있습니다. "Parental
Control"(31페이지) 및 "Country Code"(31페이지)
참조하십시오.
기본 비밀번호는 0000입니다.
비밀번호를 잊은 경우, "문제 해결" (38페이지)를
참조하여 모든 Security 설정값을 기본값으로 설
정하십시오.
Parental Control
일부 BD/DVD 디스크의 경우, 시청자 나이에 따라 디스
크를 볼 수 있는 시청 연령 제한이 설정됩니다. 디스
컨텐츠에 따라 화면에 표시된 Parental Control을 설정
할 수 있습니다.
Parental Control 레벨을 설정하려면 먼저 암호(31페이
지의 "Change Password" 참조)를 입력해야 합니다.
Parental Control을 설정한 다음, 현재의 Parental
Control 레벨보다 높은 레벨의 디스크를 재생하거나
Parental Control 레벨을 변경하려면 암호를 입력하라
는 대화 상자가 나타납니다.
Off*, 1에서 8
Country Code
거주하고 있는 Country Code를 설정할 수 있습니다.
Country Code를 설정하려면 먼저 암호(31페이지의
"Change Password" 참조)를 입력해야 합니다.
Parental Control 등급 지정 및 디스크 재생 시에도 이
설정이 사용될 수 있습니다.
참고
참고
참고
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Svenska Nederlandse
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
Fran
ç
ais Español Deutsch Italiano
Nederlandse Svenska
DVD-AUDIO
*
DVD-Audio/Video 컨텐츠 모두 재생됩니다. 디
크에 따라 DVD-Audio 컨텐츠만 재생되기도 합니
다.
DVD-VIDEO
DVD-Video 컨텐츠만 재생됩니다.
참고
참고
SETUP 메뉴
32 Ko
Network
Internet Connection
네트워크에서 BD-Live(26페이지), DLNA(21페이지) 및
소프트웨어 업그레이드를 사용하는 경우 이 항목을
Enable로 설정합니다(37페이지).
Enable
*
, Disable
Information
네트워크 정보 면을 표시할 수 있습니다. 이 화면에서
인터페이스(이더넷), 주소 유형, IP 주소, 서브넷 마스크,
기본 게이트웨이 및 DNS 정보를 볼 수 있습니다.
Connection Test
인터넷 연결 테스트를 실행할 수 있습니다. 테스트가
패하면 "IP Setting"(32페이지)을 확인하고 테스트를
시 실행하십시오.
IP Setting
다음과 같이 네트워크 설정을 구성할 수 있습니다.
Numeric keys 문자를 입력합니다.
2/3 강조표시를 이동합니다.
CLEAR 문자를 지웁니다.
ENTER 설정 내용을 저장한 후 메뉴를 종
료합니다.
BD-Live Connection
BD-Live 컨텐츠에 대한 액세스 제한을 설정할 수 있습
니다.
DLNA
DLNA(21페이지)를 Enable/Disable로 설정할 수 있습
니다. DLNA 기능을 사용하지 않으면 Disable로 설정하
십시오.
Enable
*
, Disable
Proxy Setting
Proxy Setting을 설정할 수 있습니다. 일반적인 사용
Disable로 설정하십시오. 프록시 설정을 하려면 Enable
로 설정하십시오.
Display Setting
기본 설정에는 "
*
"가 표시됩니다.
TV
3D Output
다음과 같이 본 플레이어의 3D 또는 2D 비디오 출력을
선택할 수 있습니다.
"3D Output" 을 "Auto" 로택한 후 Blu-ray 3D
디스크를 재생한다 하더라도 TV와 기타 연결 및
설정(12페이지)에 따라 본 플레이어는 2D 화상을
선택할 수도 있습니다.
TV Screen
연결된 TV의 화면 비율을 설정하고, 비디오 출력을
정할 수 있습니다.
TV를 바꾸거나(예를 들면, 새로 구입) 연결된 TV의 화
면 비율을 변경하면 TV Screen 설정을 변경해야 합니
다.
Auto*
이 기능을 선택하면 본 플레이어와 DHCP 서버의
네트워크 설정을 자동으로 구성합니다.
Manual
이 기능을 선택하면 네트워크 설정(IP Address,
Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, DNS)을 수동으
로 구성할 수 있습니다.
힌트
Permitted 모든 BD-Live 디스크를 네트워크에 연결할 수 있
습니다.
Partial
Permitted
*
소유자 인증이 있는 디스크만 연결할 수 있습니다.
Prohibited
모든 BD-Live 디스크의 네트워크 연결이 금지됩니
다.
Enable 프록시 호스트 및 프록시 포트 설정을 설정합니다.
Disable
*
프록시 서버를 비활성화합니다. 프록시 서버를 사
용하지 않는 경우 이 항목을 선택합니다.
Proxy Host
프록시 호스트를 설정합니다.
Proxy Port
프록시 포트를 설정합니다.
Auto*
본 플레이어가 3D 또는 2D 비디오를 자동으로 선
택합니다.
Off
본 플레이어가 항상 2D 비디오를 선택합니다.
참고
16:9 Full 화면 비율이 16:9인 TV에 본 플레이어가 연결된
경우 선택합니다. 화면 비율이 4:3인 비디오를 재생
하면 비디오가 아래와 같이 표시됩니다.
16:9 Normal
*
화면 비율이 16:9인 TV에 본 플레이어가 연결된
경우 선택합니다. 화면 비율이 4:3인 비디오를 재생
하면 비디오가 아래와 같이 표시됩니다.
4:3 Pan Scan
화면 비율이 4:3인 TV에 본 플레이어가 연결된 경
우 선택합니다. 화면 비율이 16:9인 비디오를 재생
하면 비디오가 아래와 같이 표시됩니다.
4:3 Letterbox
화면 비율이 4:3인 TV에 본 플레이어가 연결된 경
우 선택합니다. 화면 비율이 16:9인 비디오를 재생
하면 비디오가 아래와 같이 표시됩니다.
원래 화상
사이즈
16:9(와이드 스크린) TV의 경우
16:9 Full 16:9 Normal
4:3
원래 화상
사이즈
4:3 TV의 경우
4:3 Pan Scan 4:3 Letterbox
16:9
SETUP 메뉴
33 Ko
설정
4
한국어
Resolution
비디오 출력 해상도를 Auto, 480i/576i, 480p/576p,
720p, 1080i 및 1080p 중에서 선택할 수 있습니다.
Auto로 설정하면, 연결된 TV에 따라 해상도가 최대 해
상도로 설정됩니다. 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은
"비디오 출력 형식에 대하여"(36페이지)를 참조하십시
오.
Auto
*
, 480i/576i, 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p
HDMI 단자에서 HD 오디오(예: Dolby TrueHD
는 DTS-HD Master Audio)를 출력하려면
Resolution을 Auto 또는 720p 이상으로 설정하십
시오.
TV System
TV System을 PAL, NTSC 및 Multi 중에서 선택할 수
있습니다. TV 세트와 동일한 TV System을 설정하십시
오. 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 "비디오 출력 형식
에 대하여"(36페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Color Space
HDMI에서 출력되는 Color Space(41페이지)를 선택할
수 있습니다. 이 기능은 본 플레이어가 HDMI 케이블을
사용하여 연결된 경우에만 사용할 수 있습니다.
이 기능을 지원하는 TV에서만 이 기능을 사용할
수 있습니다.
HDMI Deep Color
TV 및/또는 AV 리시버가 Deep Color(41페이지)와 호
환되는 경우, TV/AV 리시버에 맞게 이 항목을 설정하
십시오. 이 기능은 본 플레이어가 HDMI 케이블을 사용
하여 연결된 경우 사용할 수 있습니다.
30 bits, 36 bits, Off
*
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
이 기능은 프레임 속도가 24Hz로 인코딩된 BD-Video
를 HDMI 1080p 24Hz로 출력합니다. 이 기능을 사용하
면 비디오가 더 매끄럽게 재생될 수 있습니다. 이 기능
은 TV/AV 리시버가 이 기능을 지원하고, 본 플레이어
가 HDMI 케이블을 사용하여 연결된 경우 사용할 수 있
습니다. 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 "비디오 출력
형식에 대하여"(36페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Auto
*
, Off
출력 해상도가 1080p가 아닌 경우 이 설정은 사용
할 수 없습니다.
Lip Sync
다음과 같이 Lip Sync(42페이지) 기능을 설정/조정할
수 있습니다.
Video Process
Video Mode
다음과 같은 Video Mode를 선택할 수 있습니다.
Color Adjust
각 색상(Red/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan/Magenta)에
대해 Brightness/Saturation/Hue를 조정할 수 있습니
다. 이 기능을 사용하려면 Video Mode를 Custom으로
설정하십시오. 설정 항목에 대한 자세한 내용은 "Video
Mode"(33페이지)를 참조하십시오.
기본 설정은 0입니다.
Auto Contrast
명암 대비를 조정하여 재생되는 화상을 최적화합니다.
이 기능을 사용하려면 Video Mode를 Custom으로 설
정하십시오.
Off
*
, On
Noise Reduction
Noise Reduction을 레벨 0에서 3으로 설정할 수 있습
니다. 0은 설정 해제이고, 3은 최대 레벨입니다.
0
*
, 1, 2, 3
참고
NTSC, PAL
*
, Multi
(호주, 아시아, 영국, 유럽 및 러시아 모델)
NTSC
*
, PAL, Multi
(미국, 캐나다, 중남미, 대만 및 한국 모델)
RGB 일반 신호 범위에서 비디오 신호를 출력합니다.
YCbCr 4:4:4
*
Color Space를 YCbCr 4:4:4로 설정합니다.
YCbCr 4:2:2
Color Space를 YCbCr 4:2:2로 설정합니다.
Full RGB
RGB를 설정했지만 화면에 흰색과 검은색이 너무
약할 경우 이 항목을 선택합니다. 이 설정은 연결된
컴포넌트가 RGB 0-255 범위를 지원하는 경우
과적입니다.
참고
참고
Auto*
플레이어가 Lip Sync 기능을 자동으로 조정합니
다.
Manual
Lip Sync 기능을 수동으조정할 수 있습니다. 2D
및 3D 컨텐츠의 오디오 지연을 개별적으로 설정
수 있습니다.
2D
3D
Off
플레이어가 Lip Sync 기능을 조정하지 않습니다.
Standard*
화상이 가장 자연스럽고 균형이 잘 맞습니다. 이 모
드는 일반적인 사용에 적합합니다.
Vivid
화상이 훨씬 생생하고 선명합니다.
Cinema
어두운 실내에서 동영상을 시청할 때 적합합니다.
Custom
화상을 수동으로 조정할 수 있습니다. 5 /a 눌러
파라미터를 선택한 다음, 2/3 를 눌러 값을 조정합
니다.
Brightness
화상의 전반적인 밝기를 조정합니다.
Saturation
영사된 화상의 색상 포화도를 조정합니다.
Hue
영사된 화상의 색조를 조정합니다.
Contrast
화상에서 밝은 영역(흰색 레벨)을 조정합니다.
Sharpness
비디오에서 물체의 선명도를 조정합니다.
CTI
컬러 영상의 가장자리를 매끄럽게 합니다. 컬러
상이 더 뚜렷해집니다.
기본 설정은 0입니다.
SETUP 메뉴
34 Ko
De-interlacing Mode
비디오 신호 감방법을 선택할 있습니다. 일반적인
사용에서는 Auto로 설정하십시오. 화면에 가로 줄무늬
가 나타나는 경우, 노이즈를 제거하려면 Film/Video로
설정하십시오.
Auto
*
, Film, Video
Audio Setting
기본 설정에는 "
*
"가 표시됩니다.
Audio Output
Coaxial/Optical
COAXIAL및 OPTICAL 단자의 출력 모드를 선택할
수 있습니다. 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 "오디오
출력 형식에 대하여"(35페이지)를 참조하십시오.
HDMI
HDMI 단자의 출력 모드를 선택할 수 있습니다. 설정 항
목에 대한 세한 내용은 "Coaxial/Optical"(34페이지)을
참조하십시오. 출력 형식에 대한 자세한 내용은 "오디오
출력 형식에 대하여"(35페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Bitstream
*
, PCM, Reencode, Off
HDMI 단자에서 HD 오디오(예: Dolby TrueHD
는 DTS-HD Master Audio)를 출력하려면
Resolution을 Auto 또는 720p(33페이지) 이상으
로 설정하십시오.
Downsampling
디지털 오디오 신호 다운샘플링 주파수를 선택할 수
습니다. 기능은 COAXIAL 잭/OPTICAL 단자에서
디오 신호 출력 시 효과적입니다.
DRC
DRC(Dynamic Range Compression)(41페이지)를 On/
Off/Auto로 설정할 수 있습니다. Auto로 설정하면,
Dolby TrueHD 형식으로 된 DRC 정보가 포함된 소스
경우 DRC가 자동으로 켜집니다. DRC는 폭발음과
은 강한 사운드는 작게, 대화는 잘 들리도록 합니다.
에 영화를 볼 때 유용합니다.
Off
*
, On, Auto
SACD Output
SACD Priority
멀티 채널 또는 스테레오(2채널) 컨텐츠가 모두 포함된
하이브리드 SA-CD(4페이지)를 넣은 경우 둘 중에서
생되는 컨텐츠를 선택할 수 있습니다.
Multi-ch
*
, 2-ch
HDMI Output
SA-CD를 재생하는 경우 HDMI 단자에서 출력되는 오
디오 신호를 선택할 수 있습니다.
Speaker Setting
Configuration
연결된 스피커 또는 앰프에 따라 7.1채널 서라운드 출력
을 설정할 수 있습니다.
1 5/a 를 눌러 구성하려는 스피커를 선택한 다음,
ENTER를 누릅니다.
2 아래와 같은 값을 조정합니다. 선택한 스피커에 따
일부 항목이 표시되지 않을 수 있습니다.
3 RETURN을 눌러 스피커 선택으로 돌아갑니다.
2ch Downmix
아날로그 2채널로 다운믹스하는 방법을 Stereo 또는
Lt/Rt 중에서 선택할 수 있습니다.
Post Process
Up Mix
2채널 오디오 신호를 멀티 채널화할 수 있습니다. 멀티
채널화하려면 NEO6선택한 다음 Cinema 또는 Music
모드를 선택합니다.
Off
*
, NEO6
System Information
소프트웨어 버전 및 MAC 주소(42페이지)가 표시됩니다.
Bitstream 디지털 신호를 전혀 처리하지 않고 출력합니다. 보
조 오디오는 출력되지 않습니다.
PCM
2채널 PCM을 출력합니다.
Reencode
*
보조 오디오와 함께 Bitstream을 출력합니다.
Off
음을 소거합니다.
참고
48k
*
디지털 PCM 출력의 최고 샘플링 속도가 48 kHz입
니다.
96k
디지털 PCM 출력의 최고 샘플링 속도가 96 kHz입
니다.
192k
디지털 PCM 출력의 최고 샘플링 속도가 192 kHz
입니다.
DSD
*
DSD raw 신호를 출력합니다. 본 플레이어가 DSD
호환 AV 리시버에 연결된 경우 항목을 사용하는
것이 좋습니다.
PCM
본 플레이어에서 디코딩된 PCM 신호를 출력합니
다.
Size
스피커의 우퍼 섹션이 16 cm 이상일 경우 Large를
선택합니다. 16 cm보다 작으면 Small을 선택합니다.
Large
*
, Small
Trim
-12에서 0 dB(0.5 dB 간격)
기본 설정은 0 dB입니다.
Delay
0.5에서 10 m(0.5 m 간격)
기본 설정은 3 m입니다.
Disable
선택한 스피커를 사용하지 않을 경우 Yes를 선택합
니다.
Yes, No
*
Stereo
*
채널 출력이 스테레오로 변경되어, 두 개의 프론
스피커의 사운드만 전달됩니다.
Lt/Rt
본 기기가 Dolby Pro Logic 디코더에 연결된 경우
이 항목을 선택합니다. 리어 스피커의 사운드가 2
채널 스테레오 사운드로 믹스됩니다.
SETUP 메뉴
35 Ko
설정
4
한국어
오디오 출력 형식에 대하여
* "SA"는 보조 오디오(Secondary Audio)입니다.
** "BCS"는 버튼 조작음, 팝업 메뉴 효과음 등입니다.
SA-CD 출
Coaxial/Optical 또는 HDMI가 Bitstream으로 설정된 경우 보조 오디오가 출력되지 않습니다. (34페이지)
HDMI 단자에서 HD 오디오(예: Dolby TrueHD 또는 DTS-HD Master Audio)를력하려면 Resolution
Auto 또는 720p(33페이지) 이상으로 설정하십시오.
SA-CD를 재생하는 경우, Speaker Setting(34페이지)의 Configuration은 HDMI Output이 PCM으로 설
된 경우에만 적용됩니다.
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/7.1
채널
서라운드
소스 형식 Bitstream PCM Reencode Bitstream PCM Reencode
PCM 2채널 PCM 2채널 PCM 2채널 2채널
PCM 5.1채널 PCM 5.1채널 PCM 2채널
2채널/5.1채널
PCM 7.1채널 PCM 7.1채널 PCM 2채널
2채널/7.1채널
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
PCM 최대
5.1채널
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital
2채널/5.1채널
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital
Plus
PCM 최대
7.1채널
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital
2채널/7.1채널
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby
TrueHD
PCM 최대
7.1채널
Dolby
TrueHD
Dolby Digital PCM 2ch Dolby Digital
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
Dolby Digital
DTS DTS
PCM 최대
5.1채널
DTS DTS PCM 2ch DTS
2채널/5.1채널
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
DTS HD
High
Resolution
DTS HD
High
Resolution
PCM 최대
7.1채널
DTS HD
High
Resolution
DTS PCM 2ch DTS
2채널/7.1채널
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
DTS
DTS-HD
Master
Audio
DTS-HD
Master
Audio
PCM 최대
7.1채널
DTS-HD
Master
Audio
DTS PCM 2ch DTS
SA
*
또는
BCS
**
사용
DTS
SACD Output 설정
HDMI COAXIAL/OPTICAL
MIXED 2CH/7.1채널 서라운
SACD Priority HDMI Output
Multi-ch
DSD DSD 최대 5.1채널 출력 안됨 2채널/5.1채널
PCM PCM 최대 5.1채널 출력 안됨 2채널/5.1채널
2-ch
DSD DSD 2채널 출력 안됨 2채널/2채널
PCM PCM 2채널 출력 안됨 2채널/2채널
참고
SETUP 메뉴
36 Ko
비디오 출력 형식에 대하여
TV System이 NTSC로 설정된 경우
* 디스크나 컨텐츠에 따라 본 플레이어는 480p 비디오 신호를 출력합니다.
TV System이 PAL로 설된 경
* 디스크나 컨텐츠에 따라 본 플레이어는 576p 비디오 신호를 출력합니다.
TV System이 Multi로 설정된 경우
TV System 이 Multi 로 설정된 경우 , 비디오 신호는 소스와 동일한 주파수로 출력됩니다 . TV 의 주파수 설정 및
출력 비디오 신호의 해상도에 대한 자세한 내용은 위의 표를 참조하십시오 .
SETUP 메뉴와 같은 메뉴 화면이 표시된 경우 비디오 신호는 소스와 동일한 주파수로 출력됩니다 .
표에서 "최대"는 연결된 TV에서 지원되는 최대 해상도로 설정된다는 것을 의미합니다.
출력 해상도가 1080p가 아니면 HDMI 1080p 24Hz 설정을 사용할 수 없습니다.
본 플레이어가 HDMI로부터 1080p 24Hz 비디오 신호를 출력하는 경우 COMPONENT와 VIDEO 잭에서
신호가 출력되지 않습니다.
상업적으로 출시된 DVD를 컴포넌트 출력에서 재생하는 경우 최대 해상도는 480p/576p입니다.
TV System이 NTSC로 설정된 경우 비디오 소스가 60 Hz가 아니면 비디오 출력 신호가 60 Hz로 변환됩니
다.
TV System이 PAL로 설정된 경우 비디오 소스가 50 Hz가 아니면 비디오 출력 신호가 50 Hz로 변환됩니다.
Resolution Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24Hz 기타
HDMI
BD 재생
최대 최대 최대 720p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 60 Hz
기타 1080p 60 Hz
COMPONENT
상용 DVD 재
480i 480i
480p 480p 480p 480p
BD 재생 480i 480i 480i 480i
기타 480p 720p 60 Hz *
1080i 60 Hz *
1080i 60 Hz *
VIDEO
BD 재생
480i 480i 480i 480i 480i
480i
기타 480i
Resolution Auto 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i
1080p
24Hz 기타
HDMI
BD 재생
최대 최대 최대 720p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz
1080p 24 Hz
1080p 50 Hz
기타 1080p 50 Hz
COMPONENT
상용 DVD 재
576i 576i
576p 576p 576p 576p
BD 재생 576i 576i 576i 576i
기타 576p 720p 50 Hz *
1080i 50 Hz *
1080i 50 Hz *
VIDEO
BD 재생
576i 576i 576i 576i 576i
576i
기타 576i
참고
37 Ko
설정
4
한국어
본 플레이어 소프트웨어를 최신으로 업그레이드하지 않
은 경우 새로 출시된 BD 디스크가 재생되지 않을 수 있
습니다. 본 플레이어가 최신 소프트웨어에서 작동되도
록 소프트웨어 업그레이드로 플레이어를 업그레이드하
는 것이 좋습니다.
소프트웨어 업그레이드 기능을 확인하려면 다음을 방문
하십시오.
http://download.yamaha.com/downloads/service/
top/?site=europe.yamaha.com&language=en
업그레이드 파일 패키지가 포함된 디스크를 넣으
소프트웨어 업그레이드가 자동으로 시작됩니다.
소프트웨어 업그레이드를 실행 중일 때는 디스크/
USB 메모리 장치를 빼거나, 본 플레이어를 대기
모드로 설정하거나, 전원 케이블/LAN 케이블을
지 마십시오.
소프트웨어 업그레이드
1. 소프트웨어 업그레이드를 준비합니다.
디스크/USB 저장 장치에서 소프트웨어를 업그레
이드하는 경우:
1 업그레이드 파일 패키지를 디스크/USB 메모리
장치의 적절한 폴더에 저장합니다. 자세한 내용
은 업그레이드 파일 패키지에 부속된 설명서를
참조하십시오.
2 디스크를 넣거나 USB 메모리 장치를 연결합
니다.
디스크를 넣으면 소프트웨어 업그레이드가
동으로 시작됩니다. 단계 2를 건너뜁니다.
네트워크에서 소프트웨어를 업그레이드하는 경우:
본 플레이어가 네트워크에 연결되어 있는지
인하십시오.
2. 업그레이드 방법을 선택하고 SETUP 메뉴
서 업그레이드를 시작합니다.
1 SETUP을 눌러 SETUP 메뉴 화면을 표시합니다.
2 General Setting = System = Upgrade를 선택
합니다.
3 Disc/USB Storage/Network 중에서 업그레이
드 파일 패키지가 포함된 항목을 선택합니다.
3. 시스템에서 업그레이드 파일 패키지를 검색
합니다.
4. ENTER를 눌러 업그레이드를 시작합니다.
5. 업그레이드가 완료되었습니다. 시스템이 다시
시작됩니다.
소프트웨어 업그레이드
힌트
참고
38 Ko
추가 정보
󱔭 󲵁󱀽󱾩󱷩󰐵 󲁊󱣶󲀶󱽱󱂑 󱿆󰰎󲶍󲇵 󱵿󱽹 󰓲󱻥 󱵹󰿍 󲲑󱆱 󲑭󲂥󲶍󱬢󱬑󱹙. 󱵹󰿍󱸅 󲶩󰬮󰱍󲇵 󱵿󰫉 󱍭󲁑󰐵 󱑑󱤒󲶑 󰓲󱻥 󰹅󰫉 󱵹󰿍
󱾍 󲶩󰓥󲑺󱾩 󰯹󱻵󱾩 󱵽 󰱍󰫉 󰓲󱻥 󱔭 󲵁󱀽󱾩󱷩󱆱 󰡹󰔕 󲀹󱼅 󲜵󱾩󱙉󱽹 󱖹󱇡󲶑 󰬙󱾁 󰐵󰚁󱻩 󰔪󱾭 Yamaha 󰬵󱇡󲁅󱾩󰣍 󱥑󱙹󱫙 󱥱
󲥥󱂑 󱍭󱾍󲶍󱬢󱬑󱹙.
전원
기본 조작
디스크 재생
문제 해결
문제 원인 및 해결 방법
전원이 켜지지 않는다. AC 전원 케이블을 올바로 연결하십시오.
면 패널의 p 를 눌러 전원을 켜십시오.
플레이어가 꺼진다. 10분 동안 계속해서 아무 작동도 하지 않으면(재생 안함) 전원이 자동을 꺼집니다.
문제 원인 및 해결 방법
리모콘이 작동하지 않는다. 리모콘 작동 범위 내에서 리모콘을 사용하십시오. (5페이지)
배터리를 교체하십시오. (5페이지)
본체 및 리모콘의 ID 설정을 확인하십시오. (9페이지)
버튼이 작동하지 않는다. 앞면 패널의 p를 5초 정도 눌러 본 플레이어를 다시 시작하십시오.
본 플레이어를 완전히 재설정하려면, AC 콘센트에서 전원 케이블을 10초 이상 동안
뽑아 놓은 후에, 전원 케이블을 AC 콘센트에 다시 꽂은 다음 본 플레이어를 켜십시오.
암호를 잊어버렸다.
플레이어에 디스크가 들어 있지 않고 재생이 정지된 상태에서 앞면 패널의
를 동시에 눌러 플레이어를 기본 설정으로 설정하십시오(Security 설정(31페이
지)도 재설정됨). 전원이 자동으로 꺼진 후에 p를 눌러 전원을 다시 켜십시오.
문제 원인 및 해결 방법
플레이어에서 디스크를 재생할 수 없다. 디스크를 꺼내 청소하여 주십시오. (4페이지)
디스크가 올바로 들어 있는지 확인하십시오(라벨 면이 위로 되어 있고 디스크 트레이
의 제자리에 들어 있는지 확인). (4페이지)
본 플레이어에서 지원하는 디스크를 사용하십시오. (3페이지)
디스크를 꺼낸 다음 본 플레이어에서 지원하는 디스크인지 확인하십시오. (3페이지)
지역 코드를 확인하십시오. (3페이지)
다른 디스크를 넣어서 디스크가 손상되었는지 확인하십시오.
CD-R/RW, DVD+R/RW/R DL 및 DVD-R/RW/R DL은 파이널라이즈해야 합니다. (3페
이지)
비디오가 멈춘다. 강한 충격 또는 진동이 감지된 경우 플레이어가 정지됩니다.
재생을 시작하거나 디스크를 읽어들일 때
레이어에서 딱 하는 소리가 들린다.
이 소리는 플레이어 고장이 아니며 정상적인 작동 상태입니다.
문제 해결
39 Ko
추가 정보
5
한국어
사진
사운드
문제 원인 및 해결 방법
사진이 표시되지 않는다. 케이블이 올바로 연결되어 있는지 확인하십시오. (10페이지)
연결된 TV 또는 AV 리시버가 올바른 입력으로 설정되어 있는지 확인하십시오. (10
페이지)
부속된 비디오 핀 케이블을 사용하여 본 플레이어를 VIDEO 잭(13페이지)이 장착된
TV에 연결하고 Resolution을 올바로 설정하십시오. (33페이지)
TV System이 올바로 설정되어 있지 않습니다. 리모콘의 DIMMER를 잠시 눌러 TV
System 설정을 기본 설정으로 재설정하십시오.
화면이 정지되고 조작 버튼이 작동하지 않는
다.
를 누른 다음 재생을 다시 시작하십시오.
전원을 껐다가 다시 켜십시오.
앞면 패널의 p를 5초 정도 눌러 본 플레이어를 다시 시작하십시오.
비디오가 원하는 해상도로 출력되지 않는다. 원하는 해상도로 설정하십시오. (33페이지)
와이드 스크린 비디오가 세로로 늘어난 것처
보이거나, 화면 위아래에 검은색 띠가 나
타난다. 또는 4:3 비디오가 가로로 늘어난 것
처럼 보인다.
TV의 화면 비율을 변경하십시오. (32페이지)
네모난 무늬(모자이크)가 화면에 나타난다. 디지털 화상 압축 기술의 특성상 빠른 동작이 있는 장면에서 화상에 블록이 보일 수
있습니다.
DVD 비디오를 VCR로 녹화하거나 VCR을 통해
재생하면 재생 화면이 고르지 못하다.
본 플레이어는 아날로그 복사 방지 규정을 준수합니다. 일부 디스크에는 복사 방지
호가 포함되어 있습니다. 이러한 디스크를 VCR을 통해 재생하려고 하거나 VCR
화하고 신호를 재생하려고 하면 복사 방지로 인해 올바로 재생되지 않습니다.
오디오가 출력되지 않거나 화상이 올바로
생되지 않는다.
복사 방지 컨텐츠가 녹화된 일부 디스크의 경우 오디오가 출력되지 않거나 화상이 올
바로 재생되지 않을 수 있습니다.
문제 문제 및 해결 방법
사운드가 출력되지 않거나 왜곡된다. 오디오 케이블이 올바로 연결되어 있는지 확인하십시오. (10페이지)
정지화상 모드, 슬로 모션 재생, 빨리감기 빨리되감기 도중에는 사운드가 출력되지
않습니다. (7페이지)
오디오 컨텐츠에 오디오 신호 이외의 오디오 또는 비표준 오디오가 녹음된 경우와 같
이 오디오 녹음 상태에 따라 오디오가 출력되지 않을 수 있습니다. (3페이지)
오디오의 좌우 채널이 바뀌거나 사운드가
쪽에서만 출력된다.
오디오 연결을 확인하십시오. (10페이지)
오디오가 출력되지 않거나 화상이 올바로
생되지 않는다.
저작권 보호 컨텐츠가 녹화된 일부 디스크이 경우 오디오가 출력되지 않거나 화상이
올바로 재생되지 않을 수 있습니다.
원하는 오디오 유형/채널 번호를 들을 수 없
다.
Audio Output 설정 및 "오디오 출력 형식에 대하여"를 참조하십시오. (34, 35페이지)
PIP 사운드(보조 오디오)가 들리지 않는다. Coaxial/Optical 또는 HDMI를 PCM/Reencode로 설정하십시오. (34페이지)
보조 오디오를 들으려면 2ND AUDIO를 누르십시오. (6페이지)
디스크에 따라 디스크의 맨 처음 메뉴에서 보조 오디오를 On으로 설정해야 하는 경
우도 있습니다. (7페이지)
문제 해결
40 Ko
네트워크
화면의 메시지
재생하려는 디스크가 적합하지 않거나 조작이 잘못된 경우 TV 화면에 다음과 같은 메시지가 나타납니다.
문제 원인 및 해결 방법
인터넷에 연결할 수 없다. 네트워크 케이블을 올바로 연결하십시오.
광대역 라우터 또는 모뎀 등 연결된 기기의 전원을 켜십시오.
광대역 라우터 및/또는 모뎀을 올바로 연결하십시오.
네트워크 설정에서 올바른 값을 설정하십시오. "Network"를 확인하십시오. (32페이
지)
BD-Live 컨텐츠를 다운로드할 수 없다. 네트워크 케이블을 올바로 연결하십시오. (16페이지)
USB 메모리 장치를 올바로 연결하십시오. USB 메모리 장치가 본 플레이어의 USB
포트에 연결되어 있는지 확인하십시오. (16페이지)
BD 디스크가 BD-Live를 지원하는지 확인하십시오.
"Internet Connection"의 설정을 확인하십시오. (32페이지)
FAT16 또는 FAT32로 포맷된 USB 메모리 장치를 연결하십시오.
여유 공간이 2 GB 이상인 USB 메모리 장치를 연결하는 것이 좋습니다. 여유 공간이
충분하지 않을 경우 USB 메모리 장치를 포맷하십시오. (30페이지)
디스크과 함께 제공된 사용 설명서를 참조하거나 디스크 제조업체에 문의하십시오.
DLNA 서버가 감지되지 않는다. 네트워크 케이블을 올바로 연결하십시오.
광대역 라우터 또는 서버 등 연결된 기기의 전원을 켜십시오.
플레이어 및 서버가 동일한 액세스 포인트에 연결되어 있는지 확인하십시오.
네트워크 설정에서 올바른 값을 설정하십시오 "Network"를 확인하십시오. (32페이
지)
DLNA 서버에 따라, 서버로부터 플레이어를 허가 받아야 할 수도 있습니다.
홈 네트워크 서버에서 파일을 재생할 수
다.
재생 가능한 파일인지 확인하십시오. (3페이지)
DLNA 서버의 설정을 확인하십시오.
홈 네트워크 조건에 따라 재생 및 작동 상태가 영향을 받을 수 있습니다.
오류 메시지 원인 및 해결 방법
Not Support This File! 파일레이어에원되습니. "본 플레이어에서 사용할 수 있는 디스크/파일 유형"
(3페이지)을 참조하십시오.
Wrong region code! 디스크의 지역 코드가 호환되지 않습니다. "지역 관리 정보"(3페이지)를 참조하십시오.
Network has FAILED. 본 플레이어를 네트워크에 연결할 수 없습니다. 연결(16페이지) 및 Network 설정(32페이지)을 확
인하십시오.
Network is OK, proxy has
FAILED.
본 플레이어를 프록시 서버에 연결할 수 없습니다. "Proxy Setting"(32페이지)을 참조하십시오.
The Setting is prohibited,
please setup again.
BD-Live 연결이 금지되어 있습니다. "BD-Live Connection"(32페이지)을 참조하십시오.
No valid upgrade file is
found!
업그레이드 파일이 적절한 폴더에 있는지 확인하십시오.
Upgrade has failed for some
reason!
업그레이드가 실패했습니다. 업그레이드 파일이 손상되었는지 또는 읽을 수 없는 파일인지 확인
하십시오.
41 Ko
추가 정보
5
한국어
AVCHD
AVCHD는 고해상도 HD 화상을 녹화 및 재생할 수 있
는 고선명 비디오 카메라의 새로운 형식(표준)입니다.
BD-Live
BD-Live는 네트워크 연결을 사용할 수 있는 BD 표
준으로, 본 플레이어에서 온라인에 연결하여 판촉용
영상이나 기타 데이터를 다운로드할 수 있습니다.
BDMV
BDMV(Blu-ray Disc Movie, BD-MV)는 Blu-ray
Disc 규격의 하나인 BD-ROM에서 사용되는 응용
로그램 형식 중 하나입니다. BDMV는 DVD 규격의
DVD-Video와 동일한 녹화 형식입니다.
Blu-ray 3D™
Blu-ray 3D는 풀 HD 3D 영상을 제공합니다.
BONUSVIEW
BONUSVIEW 호환 디스크를 사용하면 두 개의 화면
용 비디오 하위 채널, 오디오 하위 채널 및 하위 타이
틀을 동시에 즐길 수 있습니다. 재생 도중 기본 화
안에 작은 화면이 나타납니다(Picture in Picture).
자막 방송
자막 방송은 자막의 일종이지만, 자막은 일반 사람들
을 위한 것이고 자막 방송은 청각 장애인용이라는
이 서로 다릅니다. 자막에는 모든 오디오가 거의
시되지 않습니다. 예를 들어, 자막에서는 사운드
과(예: "전화벨 소리" 및 "발자국 소리")가 나타나
만, 자막 방송에서는 그렇지 않습니다. 이 설정을
택하기 전에 디스크에 자막 방송 정보가 포함되어
는지 확인하십시오.
Color Space
Color Space는 표현할 수 있는 색상 범위입니다.
RGB는 RGB 색상 모델(적색, 녹색 및 청색)을 기준
으로 하는 색상 공간이며 일반적으로 PC 모니터에
사용됩니다. YCbCr는 휘도 신호(Y) 색차 신호(Cb
및 Cr)를 기준으로 하는 색상 공간입니다.
Deep Color
Deep Color는 디스플레이에서 다양한 색심도를
용하는 것으로, 이전 버전의 HDMI 규격에서는 최대
24비트 깊이까지 사용합니다. 이렇게 비트 심도가 늘
어나면 HDTV 및 다른 디스플레이에서 수백만 색상
에서 수십억 색상까지 표시할 수 있으며, 화면의 컬
러 밴딩을 제거하여 색조 전환 및 색상 간 그라데이
션이 매끄러워집니다. 음영비가 증가되면 검은색과
흰색 사이에 몇 배나 더 많은 회색 음영을 표현할 수
있습니다. 또한 Deep Color는 RGB 또는 YCbCr 색
상 공간에서 정의한 범위 내에서 사용할 수 있는
상 수가 늘어납니다.
DivX
DivX
®
는 DivX, Inc.에서 개발하여 널리 사용되는 미
디어 기술입니다. DivX
®
파일에는 고화질이지만 상
대적으로 파일 크기가 작고 고도로 압축된 비디오가
포함되어 있습니다. 또한 DivX
®
파일에는 메뉴, 자막
및 대체 오디오 트랙 같은 고급 미디어 기능이 포함되
어 있습니다. 많은 DivX
®
미디어 파일을 온라인에서
다운로드할 수 있으며, DivX.com에서 개인 콘텐츠와
간단한 툴을 사용하여 직접 만들 수 있습니다.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Laboratories Inc.에서 개발한 사운드 시스템
으로, 제품을 Dolby Digital 프로세서 또는 앰프에 연
결하면 영화관과 같은 오디오 출력이 제공됩니다.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital의 확장으로서 개발된 사운드 시스템
입니다. 이 오디오 코딩 기술은 7.1 멀티 채널 서라운
드 사운드를 지원합니다.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD는 차세대 광 디스크용 최대 8개의
티 채널 서라운드 사운드를 지원하는 무손실 코딩 기
술입니다. 재생된 사운드는 비트마다 원음에 충실합
니다.
DRC(Dynamic Range Control)
DRC를 사용하여 평균 음량으로 재생 시 최강음과 최
약음 사이의 범위(동적 범위)를 조정할 수 있습니다.
대화가 잘 들리지 않거나 이웃에 피해를 줄 수 있
시간에 재생하는 경우 사용하십시오.
DSD(Direct Stream Digital)
DSD 기술은 Super Audio CD 같은 디지털 저장
체에 오디오 신호를 저장합니다. DSD를 사용하면,
신호가 2.8224 MHz의 고주파수 샘플링 속도의 단일
비트값으로 저장되고, 노이즈 셰이핑 및 오버 샘플링
을 사용하여 오디오 신호의 양자화에서 일반적으로
발생하는 왜곡을 줄입니다. 샘플링 속도가 높기 때문
에 일반 오디오 CD에 사용되는 PCM에서 제공하는
것보다 훨씬 좋은 음질을 얻을 수 있습니다.
DTS
이것은 영화에서 사용하기 위해 DTS, Inc.에서 개발
한 디지털 사운드 시스템입니다.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio는 차세대 고선명
광 디스크 형식을 위해 개발된 신기술입니다.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio차세대 고선광 디스크
형식을 위해 개발된 무손실 오디오 압축 기술입니다.
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential
DTS-HD Master Audio | Essential은 차세대 고
선명 광 디스크 형식을 위해 개발된 무손실 오디오
압축 기술입니다.
HDMI
HDMI(High-Definition Multimedia Interface)는
하나의 디지털 연결로 비디오와 오디오를 모두 지원
하는 인터페이스입니다. HDMI 연결은 고선명 비디
오 신호 및 멀티 채널 오디오 신호를 품질 저하 없이
디지털 형태로 HDMI가 장착된 TV 같은 AV 컴포넌
트로 전달합니다.
Letterbox(LB 4:3)
화상의 위아래에 검은색 막대가 나타나는 화면 크기로,
연결된 4:3 TV에서 와이드 스크린(16:9) 영상을 볼 수
있습니다.
용어집
제품 사양
42 Ko
Linear PCM 사운드
Linear PCM는 오디오 CD 및 일부 DVD 및 Blu-ray
디스크에서 사용되는 신호 기록 형식입니다. 오디오
CD의 사운드는 16비트 44.1 kHz로 기록됩니다.
(DVD 디스크에서 사운드는 16비트 48 kHz 및 24비
트 96 kHz 사이에 기록되고, BD 디스크에서는 16비
트 48 kHz 및 24비트 192 kHz 사이에 기록됩니다.)
Lip Sync
Lip Sync는 lip synchronization(립싱크)의 약자로,
제작 후 및 전송 과정에서 오디오 신호와 비디오 신호
가 동기화되도록 유지하는 문제 및 성능과 관련된 기
술 용어입니다. 오디오 및 비디오 지연의 경우 사용자
가 복잡한 조정을 해야 하는 반면, HDMI 버전 1.3에
서는 자동 오디오 및 비디오 싱크 기능을 통합하여 사
용자의 개입 없이 장치에서 동기화를 자동으로 정확하
게 수행할 수 있습니다.
Mac 주소
Mac 주소는 식별을 위해 네트워크 장치에 할당한 고
유한 값입니다.
Pan Scan(PS 4:3)
화상의 양쪽을 잘라낸 화면 크기를 사용하여 연결된
4:3 TV에서 와이드 스크린(16:9) 영상을 볼 수 있습니
다.
자막
자막은 화면 아래쪽에 표시되어 대화를 번역 또는 기
술하는 텍스트 줄입니다. 자막은 주로 DVD 및 BD 디
스크에 기록되어 있습니다.
맨 처음 메뉴
BD-Video/DVD-Video의 경우, 재생할 챕터 및 자막
언어 등을 선택하는 메뉴입니다. 일부 DVD-Video에
서 맨 처음 메뉴를 "타이틀 메뉴"라고도 합니다.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color는 전보다 넓은 범위의 색상을 재현할 수 있
어서 인간의 눈으로 감지할 수 있는 거의 모든 색상을
표시할 수 있습니다.
일반 사항
전원
[미국 및 캐나다 모델].....................................AC 110-240 V, 60 Hz
[중남미 모델] ........................................... AC 110-240 V, 50/60 Hz
[유럽 및 러시아 모델]............................................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz
[호주 모델].....................................................AC 110-240 V, 50 Hz
[아시아 모델] ........................................... AC 220-240 V, 50/60 Hz
[대만 모델]............................................... AC 110-120 V, 50/60 Hz
[한국 모델]............................................................. AC 220 V, 60 Hz
소비 전력(일반)............................................................................. 25 W
소비 전력(대기).................................................................... 0.5 W 이하
크기(W × H × D)...................................................... 435 × 96 × 316 mm
무게 ...........................................................................................4.05 kg
오디오 성능
오디오 출력 레벨(1 kHz, 0 dB, BD/DVD/CD-DA).................. 2 ± 0.3 V
신호 대 잡음비(BD/DVD/CD-DA) ..................................... 115 dB 이상
동적 범위
BD/DVD ......................................................................... 105 dB 이상
CD-DA........................................................................... 100 dB 이상
고조파 왜곡(1 kHz)
BD/DVD ..................................................................... 0.0028 % 이하
CD-DA......................................................................... 0.003 % 이하
주파수 응답
BD/DVD ........................................ 2 Hz에서 22 kHz(48 kHz 샘플링)
2 Hz에서 44 kHz(96 kHz 샘플링)
CD-DA....................................................................2 Hz에서 20 kHz
입력/출
HDMI 출력 ................................................................ 타입 A 커넥터 × 1
480i/576i/480p/576p/720p/1080i/1080p/1080p@24Hz,
Deep Color, x.v. 색상 지원
컴포넌트 비디오 출력............................................ Y: 1 Vp-p(75 ohms)
P
B, PR: 0.7 Vp-p(75 ohms)
비디오 출력 ...............................................................1 Vp-p(75 ohms)
디지털 출력 ................................................................... × 1, 동축 × 1
아날로그 오디오 출력............................................................ 7.1 ch × 1,
Mixed 2 ch × 1
USB........................................................................... 타입 A 커넥터 × 2
기타 장비 .............................................................. Remote IN/OUT × 1,
RS-232C × 1(커스텀 인스톨러용),
이더넷 × 1
제품 사양은 사전 예고 없이 변경될 수 있습니다.
제품 사양
제품 사양
43 Ko
추가 정보
5
한국어
저작권
오디오 비디오 영상에는 저작권자의 권한이 없으
면 녹화할 수 없는 저작권 보호 작품이 포함되어 있
을 수 있습니다. 국내 관련 법규를 참조하십시오.
이 항목은 미국 특허 및 Rovi Corporation의 다른
지적 재산권의 보호를 받는 저작권 보호 기술을 통
합합니다. 리버스 엔지니어링 및 분해는 금지됩니
다.
Dolby Laboratories의 사용허락 아래 제작되었습
니다. Dolby 및 이중 D 기호는 Dolby
Laboratories의 상표입니다.
미국 특허 번호 5,451,942; 5,956,674;
5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535;
7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567
미국과 전세계에서 출원 필했거나 출원 중인 기타
특허로 제조되었습니다. DTS 및 그 기호는 등록
상표이며 DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS 로고는 DTS, Inc.의 상표입니다. 제품에는
프트웨어가 포함됩니다.
© DTS, Inc.
유.
"Blu-ray Disc
", "Blu-ray
", "Blu-ray 3D
",
"BD-Live
", "BONUSVIEW
" 및 로고들은
Blu-ray Disc Association의 상표입니다.
는 DVD Format/Logo Licensing
Corporation의 상표입니다.
HDMI, HDMI 로고 및 High-Definition
Multimedia Interface는 HDMI Licensing LLC의
상표 또는 등록 상표입니다.
"x.v.Color" 및 "x.v.Color" 로고는 상표입니다.
"AVCHD" 및 "AVCHD" 로고는 Panasonic
Corporation 및 Sony Corporation의 상표입니다.
Java 및 모든 Java 기반 상표와 로고는 미국 및/또
기타 국가에서 Sun Microsystems, Inc.의 상표
또는 등록 상표입니다.
제품은 AVC 특허 포트폴리오 및 VC-1 특허 포
트폴리오 라이센스 하에서 다음과 같은 개인적이
고 비상업적인 용도로 사용하는 경우에 한하여 허
가를 받았습니다. (i) AVC 표준 및 VC-1 표준
("AVC/VC-1 비디오")에 호환되는 비디오 인코
및/또는 (ii) 개인적이고 비상업적인 업무에 종사
는 사용자가 인코딩한 AVC/VC-1 비디오의 디코
딩 및/또는 AVC/VC-1 비디오 배급 허가가 있는
비디오 공급자가 제공한 AVC/VC-1 비디오의
코딩. 그 외 용도로는 라이센스가 허가되거나 묵시
적으로도 인정되지 않습니다. 자세한 내용은
MPEG LA, LLC에서 얻을 수 있습니다.
http://www.mpegla.com을 참조하십시오
Windows Media Player는 미국 및/또는 기타 국가
에서 Microsoft corporation의 등록 상표 또는 상표
입니다.
DLNA 및 DLNA CERTIFIED는 Digital Living
Network Alliance의 상표 및/또는 서비스 마크입
니다.
YouTube 및 YouTube 로고는 Google. Inc의 상
표입니다.
"DivX
®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus HD
련 로고는 DivX, Inc.의 등록 상표이고 라이센스
하에 사용되었습니다."
"DivX Certified
®는 최대 1080p HD 및 프리미엄
컨텐츠 DivX
® DivX Plus HD(H.264/.MKV)
비디오 재생용입니다."
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX®는 DivX, Inc.에서 만든 디지털 비디오
형식입니다. 이 형식은 DivX 비디오를 재생하는 공식 DivX
Certified
® 장치입니다. 자세한 정보 및 파일을 DivX 비디오로 변환하
는 소프트웨어 툴에 대해 알아보려면 divx.com을 방문하십시오.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: 구입한 DivX Video-on-
Demand (VOD) 동영상을 재생하려면 이 DivX Certified
® 장치를 등
록해야 합니다. 등록 코드를 얻으려면, 장치 설정 메뉴에서 DivX VOD
섹션으로 이동하십시오. vod.divx.com을 방문하여 등록을 완료하는
방법에 대해 자세히 알아보십시오.
i
Information about software
This product uses the following software.
For information (copyright, etc) about each software, read the original sentences stated below.
About Linux, Busybox, SquashFS, LIRC, U-boot
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and
change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its
users. This General Public License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation’s
software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other Free
Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute
copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source
code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in
new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you
these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you
must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too,
receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know
their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this
license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software.
Also, for each author’s protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone
understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is
not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the
original authors’ reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to
avoid the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent
licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it
clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone’s free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND
MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed
by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this General
Public License. The “Program”, below, refers to any such program or work, and a
“work based on the Program” means either the Program or any derivative work
under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language.
(Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term “modification”.)
Each licensee is addressed as “you”.
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted,
and the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately
publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty;
keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any
warranty; and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License along
with the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at
your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus
forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these
conditions:
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you
changed the files and the date of any change.
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in part
contains or is derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed as a
whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License.
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you
must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most
ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate
copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you
provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these
conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this License. (Exception:
if the Program itself is interactive but does not normally print such an
announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to print an
announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of
that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Program,
the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions
for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless
of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the
Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution
medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section 2)
in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above
provided that you also do one of the following:
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code,
which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any
third party, for a charge no more than your cost of physically performing source
distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the corresponding source
code, to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange; or,
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute
corresponding source code. (This alternative is allowed only for
noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object
code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b
above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source
code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the
scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs,
unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a
designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same
place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as
expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,
sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your
rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights,
from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However,
nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its
derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based
on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its
terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works
based on it.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the Program), the
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may
not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the rights granted
herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this
License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for
any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License
and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute
the Program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free
redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be
to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole
is intended to apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
impose that choice.
ii
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence
of the rest of this License.
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either
by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places
the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution
limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a
version number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a
version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free
Software Foundation.
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose
distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free
Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be
guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE
PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR
THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the
public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can
redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the
start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each
file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is
found.
<one line to give the program’s name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with
this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St,
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
when it starts in an interactive mode:
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author Gnomovision comes
with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’. This is free
software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type
‘show c’ for details.
The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts
of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may be called
something other than ‘show w’ and ‘show c’; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu
items--whatever suits your program.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample;
alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
‘Gnomovision’ (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
Ty Coon, President of Vice
This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more
useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you
want to do, use the GNU Library General
Public License instead of this License..
About glibc, libmtp, libusb, libusb-compat, DirectFB
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of
the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.]
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and
change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee
your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for
all its users.
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated
software packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully
about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price. Our
General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you
receive source code or can get it if you want it; that you can change the software and
use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these
things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you
these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must
give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too,
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must
provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the
library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show
them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and (2) we
offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or
modify the library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that there is no warranty for
the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the
recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the
original author’s reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced
by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program.
We wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free
program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist
that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the
full freedom of use specified in this license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General
Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to
certain designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public
License. We use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those
libraries into non-free programs.
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the
combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original
library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the
entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public License
permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library.
We call this license the “Lesser” General Public License because it does Less to protect
the user’s freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free
software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These
disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many
libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special
circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest
possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this,
non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a
free library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is
little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser
General Public License.
In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free programs enables a
greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission
to use the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many more people to use the
whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system.
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users’ freedom, it
does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom
and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
Pay close attention to the difference between a “work based on the library” and a “work
that uses the library”. The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the
latter must be combined with the library in order to run.
iii
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND
MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which
contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it
may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also
called “this License”). Each licensee is addressed as “you”.
A “library” means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be
conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and
data) to form executables.
The “Library”, below, refers to any such software library or work which has been
distributed under these terms. A “work based on the Library” means either the Library
or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the
Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated
straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without
limitation in the term “modification”.)
“Source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for
all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts
used to control compilation and installation of the library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is
not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute
a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing
it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that
uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library’s complete source
code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer
of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence
of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the Library.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your
option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus
forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these
conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you
changed the files and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third
parties under the terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be
supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an
argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith
effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function
or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose
remains meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is
entirely well-defined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d
requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must
be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still
compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of
that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the
distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of
who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library
(or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium
does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License
instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all
the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU General
Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than
version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can
specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these
notices.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary
GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works
made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a
program that is not a library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under
Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-
readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above on a medium customarily used for software interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated
place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place
satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed
to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a “work that
uses the Library”. Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library,
and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
However, linking a “work that uses the Library” with the Library creates an executable
that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather
than a “work that uses the library”. The executable is therefore covered by this License.
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.
When a “work that uses the Library” uses material from a header file that is part of the
Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work
can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for
this to be true is not precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and
accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then
the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still
fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code
for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also
fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or link a ‘work that
uses the Library” with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the
terms permit modification of the work for the customer’s own use and reverse
engineering for debugging such modifications.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in
it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy
of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must
include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference
directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the work
(which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an
executable linked with the Library, with the complete machine-readable “work
that uses the Library”, as object code and/or source code, so that the user can
modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing
the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents
of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the
application to use the modified definitions.)
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A
suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library already
present on the user’s computer system, rather than copying library functions
into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the
library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version is interface-
compatible with the version that the work was made with.
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give
the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no
more than the cost of performing this distribution.
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated
place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the
same place.
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you
have already sent this user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the “work that uses the Library” must include
any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However,
as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs,
unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other
proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable
that you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side-by-side in
a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License,
and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the
work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted,
and provided that you do these two things:
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the
Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed
under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a
work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying
uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except as
expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,
sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically
terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received
copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
iv
9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However,
nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its
derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on
the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms
and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based
on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the rights
granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties
with this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for
any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License
and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute
the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free
redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be
to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole
is intended to apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence
of the rest of this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either
by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places
the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution
limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar
in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a
version number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free
Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose
distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,
write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all
derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software
generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE
LIBRARY “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR
THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH
ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the
public, we recommend making it free software that everyone can redistribute and
change. You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively,
under the terms of the ordinary General Public License).
To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is safest to attach
them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of
warranty; and each file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where
the full notice is found.
<one line to give the library’s name and a brief idea of what it does.> Copyright (C)
<year> <name of author>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms
of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General Public
License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License along
with this library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple
Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library ‘Frob’ (a
library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon, President of Vice
That’s all there is to it!
About Fusion
DirectFB Fusion kernel module: introduction and API
by Niels Roest
Copyright (C) 2009 Niels Roest
This documentation is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any
later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this
program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
For more details see the ?le COPYING in the source distribution of Linux.
About openssl
Copyright (C) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display
the following acknowledgment:
“This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the
OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)”
4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and “OpenSSL Project” must not be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior written
permission. For written permission, please contact [email protected].
5. Products derived from this software may not be called “OpenSSL” nor may
“OpenSSL” appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL
Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
acknowledgment:
‘This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the
OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF
THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISEDOF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
([email protected]). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
v
Original SSLeay License
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young ([email protected]).
The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following
conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The
SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright
terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Copyright remains Eric Young’s, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not
to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given
attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a
textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided
with the package.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display
the following acknowledgement:
“This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
([email protected])” The word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the rouines from
the library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps
directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
“This product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected])”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of
this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under
another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]
About zlib
Copyright notice:
(C) 1995-2004 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler
This software is provided ‘as-is’, without any express or implied warranty. In no event
will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including
commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the
following restrictions:
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you
wrote the original software. If you use this software in a product, an
acknowledgment in the product documentation would be appreciated but is not
required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
misrepresented as being the original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
Jean-loup Gailly Mark Adler
If you use the zlib library in a product, we would appreciate *not* receiving lengthy
legal documents to sign. The sources are provided for free but without warranty of any
kind. The library has been entirely written by Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler; it does
not include third-party code.
If you redistribute modified sources, we would appreciate that you include in the file
ChangeLog history information documenting your changes. Please read the FAQ for
more information on the distribution of modified source versions.
About FreeType
The FreeType Project LICENSE
2006-Jan-27
Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by
David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg
Introduction
The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive packages; some of them may
contain, in addition to the FreeType font engine, various tools and contributions which
rely on, or relate to, the FreeType Project.
This license applies to all files found in such packages, and which do not fall under their
own explicit license. The license affects thus the FreeType font engine, the test
programs, documentation and makefiles, at the very least.
This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and IJG (Independent JPEG Group)
licenses, which all encourage inclusion and use of free software in commercial and
freeware products alike. As a consequence, its main points are that:
o We don’t promise that this software works. However, we will be interested in any
kind of bug reports. (‘as is’ distribution)
o You can use this software for whatever you want, in parts or full form, without
having to pay us. (‘royalty-free’ usage)
o You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in
a program, you must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you have
used the FreeType code. (‘credits’)
We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion of this software, with or without
modifications, in commercial products. We disclaim all warranties covering The
FreeType Project and assume no liability related to The FreeType Project.
Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form for a credit/disclaimer to use in
compliance with this license. We thus encourage you to use the following text:
Portions of this software are copyright (C) <year> The FreeType Project
(www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.
Please replace <year> with the value from the FreeType version you actually use.
Legal Terms
0. Definitions
Throughout this license, the terms ‘package’, ‘FreeType Project’, and ‘FreeType
archive’ refer to the set of files originally distributed by the authors (David Turner,
Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg) as the ‘FreeType Project’, be they named as
alpha, beta or final release.
‘You’ refers to the licensee, or person using the project, where ‘using’ is a generic term
including compiling the project’s source code as well as linking it to form a ‘program’
or ‘executable’. This program is referred to as ‘a program using the FreeType engine’.
This license applies to all files distributed in the original FreeType Project, including
all source code, binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its
original, unmodified form as distributed in the original archive. If you are unsure
whether or not a particular file is covered by this license, you must contact us to verify
this.
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm,
and Werner Lemberg. All rights reserved except as specified below.
1. No Warranty
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED ‘AS IS’ WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE
USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT.
2. Redistribution
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free, perpetual and irrevocable right and
license to use, execute, perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of,
distribute and sublicense the FreeType Project (in both source and object code forms)
and derivative works thereof for any purpose; and to authorize others to exercise some
or all of the rights granted herein, subject to the following conditions:
o Redistribution of source code must retain this license file (‘FTL.TXT’) unaltered;
any additions, deletions or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying documentation. The copyright notices of the unaltered, original files
must be preserved in all copies of source files.
o Redistribution in binary form must provide a disclaimer that states that the software
is based in part of the work of the FreeType Team, in the distribution documentation.
We also encourage you to put an URL to the FreeType web page in your
documentation, though this isn’t mandatory.
These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the FreeType Project,
not just the unmodified files. If you use our work, you must acknowledge us. However,
no fee need be paid to us.
3. Advertising
Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor you shall use the name of the other
for commercial, advertising, or promotional purposes without specific prior written
permission.
We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or more of the following phrases to
refer to this software in your documentation or advertising materials: ‘FreeType
Project’, ‘FreeType Engine’, ‘FreeType library’, or ‘FreeType Distribution’.
As you have not signed this license, you are not required to accept it. However, as the
FreeType Project is copyrighted material, only this license, or another one contracted
with the authors, grants you the right to use, distribute, and modify it. Therefore, by
using, distributing, or modifying the FreeType Project, you indicate that you understand
and accept all the terms of this license.
4. Contacts
There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:
Discusses general use and applications of FreeType, as well as future and wanted
additions to the library and distribution. If you are looking for support, start in this list if
you haven’t found anything to help you in the documentation.
Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.
Our home page can be found at
http://www.freetype.org
vi
About Expat
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd
and Clark Cooper
Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Expat maintainers.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons
to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or
substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS
OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
About cURL
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (C) 1996 - 2009, Daniel Stenberg, <[email protected]>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this
permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION
OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
About Independent JPEG group
The Independent JPEG Group’s JPEG software
README for release 7 of 27-Jun-2009
This distribution contains the seventh public release of the Independent JPEG Group’s
free JPEG software. You are welcome to redistribute this software and to use it for any
purpose, subject to the conditions under LEGAL ISSUES, below.
This software is the work of Tom Lane, Guido Vollbeding, Philip Gladstone, Bill
Allombert, Jim Boucher, Lee Crocker, Bob Friesenhahn, Ben Jackson, Julian
Minguillon, Luis Ortiz, George Phillips, Davide Rossi, Ge’ Weijers, and other members
of the Independent JPEG Group.
IJG is not affiliated with the official ISO JPEG standards committee.
DOCUMENTATION ROADMAP
This file contains the following sections:
OVERVIEW General description of JPEG and the IJG software.
LEGAL ISSUES Copyright, lack of warranty, terms of distribution.
REFERENCES Where to learn more about JPEG.
ARCHIVE LOCATIONS Where to find newer versions of this software.
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS Special thanks.
FILE FORMAT WARS Software *not* to get.
TO DO Plans for future IJG releases.
Other documentation files in the distribution are:
User documentation:
install.txt How to configure and install the IJG software.
usage.txt Usage instructions for cjpeg, djpeg, jpegtran, rdjpgcom, and
wrjpgcom.
*.1 Unix-style man pages for programs (same info as usage.txt).
wizard.txt Advanced usage instructions for JPEG wizards only.
change.log Version-to-version change highlights.
Programmer and internal documentation:
libjpeg.txt How to use the JPEG library in your own programs.
example.c Sample code for calling the JPEG library.
structure.txt Overview of the JPEG library’s internal structure.
filelist.txt Road map of IJG files.
coderules.txt Coding style rules --- please read if you contribute code.
Please read at least the files install.txt and usage.txt. Some information can also be
found in the JPEG FAQ (Frequently Asked Questions) article. See ARCHIVE
LOCATIONS below to find out where to obtain the FAQ article.
If you want to understand how the JPEG code works, we suggest reading one or more
of the REFERENCES, then looking at the documentation files (in roughly the order
listed) before diving into the code.
OVERVIEW
This package contains C software to implement JPEG image encoding, decoding, and
transcoding. JPEG (pronounced “jay-peg”) is a standardized compression method for
full-color and gray-scale images.
This software implements JPEG baseline, extended-sequential, and progressive
compression processes. Provision is made for supporting all variants of these processes,
although some uncommon parameter settings aren’t implemented yet. We have made
no provision for supporting the hierarchical or lossless processes defined in the
standard.
We provide a set of library routines for reading and writing JPEG image files, plus two
sample applications “cjpeg” and “djpeg”, which use the library to perform conversion
between JPEG and some other popular image file formats. The library is intended to be
reused in other applications.
In order to support file conversion and viewing software, we have included
considerable functionality beyond the bare JPEG coding/decoding capability; for
example, the color quantization modules are not strictly part of JPEG decoding, but
they are essential for output to colormapped file formats or colormapped displays.
These extra functions can be compiled out of the library if not required for a particular
application.
We have also included “jpegtran”, a utility for lossless transcoding between different
JPEG processes, and “rdjpgcom” and “wrjpgcom”, two simple applications for
inserting and extracting textual comments in JFIF files.
The emphasis in designing this software has been on achieving portability and
flexibility, while also making it fast enough to be useful. In particular, the software is
not intended to be read as a tutorial on JPEG. (See the REFERENCES section for
introductory material.) Rather, it is intended to be reliable, portable, industrial-strength
code. We do not claim to have achieved that goal in every aspect of the software, but
we strive for it.
We welcome the use of this software as a component of commercial products. No
royalty is required, but we do ask for an acknowledgement in product documentation,
as described under LEGAL ISSUES.
LEGAL ISSUES
In plain English:
1. We don’t promise that this software works. (But if you find any bugs, please let us
know!)
2. You can use this software for whatever you want. You don’t have to pay us.
3. You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it in a program, you
must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you’ve used the IJG code.
In legalese:
The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation, either express or implied, with
respect to this software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or fitness for a particular
purpose. This software is provided “AS IS”, and you, its user, assume the entire risk as
to its quality and accuracy.
This software is copyright (C) 1991-2009, Thomas G. Lane, Guido Vollbeding.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software (or
portions thereof) for any purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this software is distributed, then this README file
must be included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice unaltered; and any
additions, deletions, or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the accompanying documentation must
state that “this software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group”.
(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts full
responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the authors accept NO LIABILITY for
damages of any kind.
These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code, not just
to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you ought to acknowledge us.
Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author’s name or company name in
advertising or publicity relating to this software or products derived from it. This
software may be referred to only as “the Independent JPEG Group’s software”.
We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of
commercial products, provided that all warranty or liability claims are assumed by the
product vendor.
ansi2knr.c is included in this distribution by permission of L. Peter Deutsch, sole
proprietor of its copyright holder, Aladdin Enterprises of Menlo Park, CA. ansi2knr.c is
NOT covered by the above copyright and conditions, but instead by the usual
distribution terms of the Free Software Foundation; principally, that you must include
source code if you redistribute it. (See the file ansi2knr.c for full details.) However,
since ansi2knr.c is not needed as part of any program generated from the IJG code, this
does not limit you more than the foregoing paragraphs do.
The Unix configuration script “configure” was produced with GNU Autoconf. It is
copyright by the Free Software Foundation but is freely distributable. The same holds
for its supporting scripts (config.guess, config.sub, ltmain.sh). Another support script,
install-sh, is copyright by X Consortium but is also freely distributable.
The IJG distribution formerly included code to read and write GIF files. To avoid
entanglement with the Unisys LZW patent, GIF reading support has been removed
altogether, and the GIF writer has been simplified to produce “uncompressed GIFs”.
This technique does not use the LZW algorithm; the resulting GIF files are larger than
usual, but are readable by all standard GIF decoders.
We are required to state that
“The Graphics Interchange Format(c) is the Copyright property of
CompuServe Incorporated. GIF(sm) is a Service Mark property of
CompuServe Incorporated.”
REFERENCES
We recommend reading one or more of these references before trying to understand the
innards of the JPEG software.
The best short technical introduction to the JPEG compression algorithm is
Wallace, Gregory K. “The JPEG Still Picture Compression Standard”,
vii
Communications of the ACM, April 1991 (vol. 34 no. 4), pp. 30-44.
(Adjacent articles in that issue discuss MPEG motion picture compression, applications
of JPEG, and related topics.) If you don’t have the CACM issue handy, a PostScript file
containing a revised version of Wallace’s article is available at http://www.ijg.org/files/
wallace.ps.gz. The file (actually a preprint for an article that appeared in IEEE Trans.
Consumer Electronics) omits the sample images that appeared in CACM, but it
includes corrections and some added material. Note: the Wallace article is copyright
ACM and IEEE, and it may not be used for commercial purposes.
A somewhat less technical, more leisurely introduction to JPEG can be found in “The
Data Compression Book” by Mark Nelson and Jean-loup Gailly, published by M&T
Books (New York), 2nd ed. 1996, ISBN 1-55851-434-1. This book provides good
explanations and example C code for a multitude of compression methods including
JPEG. It is an excellent source if you are comfortable reading C code but don’t know
much about data compression in general. The book’s JPEG sample code is far from
industrial-strength, but when you are ready to look at a full implementation, you’ve got
one here...
The best currently available description of JPEG is the textbook “JPEG Still Image
Data Compression Standard” by William B. Pennebaker and Joan L. Mitchell,
published by Van Nostrand Reinhold, 1993, ISBN 0-442-01272-1. Price US$59.95,
638 pp. The book includes the complete text of the ISO JPEG standards (DIS 10918-1
and draft DIS 10918-2).
Although this is by far the most detailed and comprehensive exposition of JPEG
publicly available, we point out that it is still missing an explanation of the most
essential properties and algorithms of the underlying DCT technology.
If you think that you know about DCT-based JPEG after reading this book, then you are
in delusion. The real fundamentals and corresponding potential of DCT-based JPEG are
not publicly known so far, and that is the reason for all the mistaken developments
taking place in the image coding domain.
The original JPEG standard is divided into two parts, Part 1 being the actual
specification, while Part 2 covers compliance testing methods. Part 1 is titled “Digital
Compression and Coding of Continuous-tone Still Images, Part 1: Requirements and
guidelines” and has document numbers ISO/IEC IS 10918-1, ITU-T T.81. Part 2 is
titled “Digital Compression and Coding of Continuous-tone Still Images, Part 2:
Compliance testing” and has document numbers ISO/IEC IS 10918-2, ITU-T T.83.
The JPEG standard does not specify all details of an interchangeable file format. For the
omitted details we follow the “JFIF” conventions, revision 1.02. A copy of the JFIF
spec is available from:
Literature Department
C-Cube Microsystems, Inc.
1778 McCarthy Blvd.
Milpitas, CA 95035
phone (408) 944-6300, fax (408) 944-6314
A PostScript version of this document is available at http://www.ijg.org/files/jfif.ps.gz.
There is also a plain text version at http://www.ijg.org/files/jfif.txt.gz, but it is missing
the figures.
The TIFF 6.0 file format specification can be obtained by FTP from ftp://ftp.sgi.com/
graphics/tiff/TIFF6.ps.gz. The JPEG incorporation scheme found in the TIFF 6.0 spec
of 3-June-92 has a number of serious problems. IJG does not recommend use of the
TIFF 6.0 design (TIFF Compression tag 6). Instead, we recommend the JPEG design
proposed by TIFF Technical Note #2 (Compression tag 7). Copies of this Note can be
obtained from http://www.ijg.org/files/. It is expected that the next revision of the TIFF
spec will replace the 6.0 JPEG design with the Note’s design. Although IJG’s own code
does not support TIFF/JPEG, the free libtiff library uses our library to implement TIFF/
JPEG per the Note.
ARCHIVE LOCATIONS
The “official” archive site for this software is www.ijg.org. The most recent released
version can always be found there in directory “files”. This particular version will be
archived as http://www.ijg.org/files/jpegsrc.v7.tar.gz, and in Windows-compatible
“zip” archive format as http://www.ijg.org/files/jpegsr7.zip.
The JPEG FAQ (Frequently Asked Questions) article is a source of some general
information about JPEG. It is available on the World Wide Web at http://www.faqs.org/
faqs/jpeg-faq/ and other news.answers archive sites, including the official
news.answers archive at rtfm.mit.edu: ftp://rtfm.mit.edu/pub/usenet/news.answers/
jpeg-faq/. If you don’t have Web or FTP access, send e-mail to mail-
send usenet/news.answers/jpeg-faq/part1
send usenet/news.answers/jpeg-faq/part2
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
Thank to Juergen Bruder of the Georg-Cantor-Organization at the Martin-Luther-
University Halle for providing me with a copy of the common DCT algorithm article,
only to find out that I had come to the same result in a more direct and comprehensible
way with a more generative approach.
Thank to Istvan Sebestyen and Joan L. Mitchell for inviting me to the ITU JPEG (Study
Group 16) meeting in Geneva, Switzerland.
Thank to Thomas Wiegand and Gary Sullivan for inviting me to the Joint Video Team
(MPEG & ITU) meeting in Geneva, Switzerland.
Thank to John Korejwa and Massimo Ballerini for inviting me to fruitful consultations
in Boston, MA and Milan, Italy.
Thank to Hendrik Elstner, Roland Fassauer, and Simone Zuck for corresponding
business development.
Thank to Nico Zschach and Dirk Stelling of the technical support team at the Digital
Images company in Halle for providing me with extra equipment for configuration
tests.
Thank to Richard F. Lyon (then of Foveon Inc.) for fruitful communication about JPEG
configuration in Sigma Photo Pro software.
Last but not least special thank to Thomas G. Lane for the original design and
development of this singular software package.
FILE FORMAT WARS
The ISO JPEG standards committee actually promotes different formats like JPEG-
2000 or JPEG-XR which are incompatible with original DCT-based JPEG and which
are based on faulty technologies. IJG therefore does not and will not support such
momentary mistakes (see REFERENCES). We have little or no sympathy for the
promotion of these formats. Indeed, one of the original reasons for developing this free
software was to help force convergence on common, interoperable format standards for
JPEG files. Don’t use an incompatible file format! (In any case, our decoder will remain
capable of reading existing JPEG image files indefinitely.)
TO DO
v7 is basically just a necessary interim release, paving the way for a major breakthrough
in image coding technology with the next v8 package which is scheduled for release in
the year 2010.
Please send bug reports, offers of help, etc. to [email protected].
About International Components for Unicode
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (C) 1995-2003 International Business Machines Corporation and others
All rights reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom
the Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above copyright notice(s) and this
permission notice appear in all copies of the Software and that both the above copyright
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS
NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER
RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE
OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
All trademarks and registered trademarks mentioned herein are the property of their
respective owners.
About libpng
This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your convenience. In case of any
discrepancy between this copy and the notices in the file png.h that is included in the
libpng distribution, the latter shall prevail.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE:
If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices immediately following this
sentence.
libpng versions 1.2.6, August 15, 2004, through 1.2.35, February 14, 2009, are
Copyright (C) 2004, 2006-2008 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according
to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-1.2.5 with the following individual added
to the list of Contributing Authors
Cosmin Truta
libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.5 - October 3, 2002, are Copyright
(C) 2000-2002 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according to the same
disclaimer and license as libpng-1.0.6 with the following individuals added to the
list of Contributing Authors
Simon-Pierre Cadieux
Eric S. Raymond
Gilles Vollant
and with the following additions to the disclaimer:
There is no warranty against interference with your enjoyment of the library or
against infringement. There is no warranty that our efforts or the library will fulfill
any of your particular purposes or needs. This library is provided with all faults,
and the entire risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy, and effort is with
the user.
libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6, March 20, 2000, are Copyright (C)
1998, 1999 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according to the same
disclaimer and license as libpng-0.96, with the following individuals added to the list of
Contributing Authors:
Tom Lane
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
Willem van Schaik
libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May 1997, are Copyright (C) 1996, 1997
Andreas Dilger Distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-0.88,
with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors:
John Bowler
Kevin Bracey
Sam Bushell
Magnus Holmgren
viii
Greg Roelofs
Tom Tanner
libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January 1996, are Copyright (C) 1995,
1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42, Inc.
For the purposes of this copyright and license, “Contributing Authors” is defined as the
following set of individuals:
Andreas Dilger
Dave Martindale
Guy Eric Schalnat
Paul Schmidt
Tim Wegner
The PNG Reference Library is supplied “AS IS”. The Contributing Authors and Group
42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed or implied, including, without limitation, the
warranties of merchantability and of fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc. assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental, special,
exemplary, or consequential damages, which may result from the use of the PNG
Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of such damage.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this source code, or
portions hereof, for any purpose, without fee, subject to the following restrictions:
1. The origin of this source code must not be misrepresented.
2. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such and must not be misrepresented
as being the original source.
3. This Copyright notice may not be removed or altered from any source or altered
source distribution.
The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. specifically permit, without fee, and
encourage the use of this source code as a component to supporting the PNG file format
in commercial products. If you use this source code in a product, acknowledgment is
not required but would be appreciated.
A “png_get_copyright” function is available, for convenient use in “about” boxes and
the like:
printf(“%s”,png_get_copyright(NULL));
Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is supplied in the files “pngbar.png” and
“pngbar.jpg (88x31) and “pngnow.png” (98x31).
Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI Certified Open Source is a
certification mark of the Open Source Initiative.
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
glennrp at users.sourceforge.net
February 14, 2009
About tinyxml
www.sourceforge.net/projects/tinyxml
Original code (2.0 and earlier )copyright (C) 2000-2006 Lee Thomason
(www.grinninglizard.com)
This software is provided ‘as-is’, without any express or implied warranty. In no event
will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including
commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the
following restrictions:
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you
wrote the original software. If you use this software in a product, an acknowledgment in
the product documentation would be appreciated but is not required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
misrepresented as being the original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
About dtoa and strtod
The author of this software is David M. Gay.
Copyright (C) 1991, 2000, 2001 by Lucent Technologies.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose without
fee is hereby granted, provided that this entire notice is included in all copies of any
software which is or includes a copy or modification of this software and in all copies
of the supporting documentation for such software.
THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE AUTHOR NOR
LUCENT MAKES ANY REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND
CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS
FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
About gSOAP
gSOAP Public License
Version 1.3b
The gSOAP public license is derived from the Mozilla Public License (MPL1.1). The
sections that were deleted
from the original MPL1.1 text are 1.0.1, 2.1.(c),(d), 2.2.(c),(d), 8.2.(b), 10, and 11.
Section 3.8 was added. The
modified sections are 2.1.(b), 2.2.(b), 3.2 (simplified), 3.5 (deleted the last sentence),
and 3.6 (simplified).
This license applies to the gSOAP software package, with the exception of the wsdl2h
source code located in
gsoap/wsdl, all code generated by wsdl2h, the UDDI source code gsoap/uddi2, and the
Web server sample
source code samples/webserver. To use all of the software commercially, a commercial
license has to be obtained
from www.genivia.com.
1 DEFINITIONS.
1.0.1.
1.1. “Contributor” means each entity that creates or contributes to the creation of
Modifications.
1.2. “Contributor Version” means the combination of the Original Code, prior
Modifications used by a Contributor, and the Modifications made by that particular
Contributor.
1.3. “Covered Code” means the Original Code, or Modifications or the combination of
the Original Code, and Modifications, in each case including portions thereof.
1.4. “Electronic Distribution Mechanism” means a mechanism generally accepted in
the software development community for the electronic transfer of data.
1.5. “Executable” means Covered Code in any form other than Source Code.
1.6. “Initial Developer” means the individual or entity identified as the Initial
Developer in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A.
1.7. “Larger Work” means a work which combines Covered Code or portions thereof
with code not governed by the terms of this License.
1.8. “License” means this document.
1.8.1. “Licensable” means having the right to grant, to the maximum extent possible,
whether at the time of the initial grant or subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights
conveyed herein.
1.9. “Modifications” means any addition to or deletion from the substance or structure
of either the Original Code or any previous Modifications. When Covered Code is
released as a series of files, a Modification is: A.
Any addition to or deletion from the contents of a file containing Original Code or
previous Modifications. B.
Any new file that contains any part of the Original Code, or previous Modifications.
1.10. “Original Code” means Source Code of computer software code which is
described in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A as Original Code, and which,
at the time of its release under this License is not already Covered Code governed by
this License.
1.10.1. “Patent Claims” means any patent claim(s), now owned or hereafter acquired,
including without limitation, method, process, and apparatus claims, in any patent
Licensable by grantor.
http://www.cs.fsu.edu/~engelen/license.html
1.11. “Source Code” means the preferred form of the Covered Code for making
modifications to it, including all modules it contains, plus any associated interface
definition files, scripts used to control compilation and installation of an Executable, or
source code differential comparisons against either the Original Code or another well
known, available Covered Code of the Contributor’s choice. The Source Code can be in
a compressed or archival form, provided the appropriate decompression or de-archiving
software is widely available for no charge.
1.12. “You” (or “Your”) means an individual or a legal entity exercising rights under,
and complying with all of the terms of, this License or a future version of this License
issued under Section 6.1. For legal entities, “You” includes any entity which controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with You. For purposes of this definition,
“control” means (a) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management
of such entity, whether by contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty
percent (50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial ownership of such entity.
2 SOURCE CODE LICENSE.
2.1. The Initial Developer Grant. The Initial Developer hereby grants You a world-
wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license, subject to third party intellectual property
claims:
(a)
under intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) Licensable by Initial
Developer to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the
Original Code (or portions thereof) with or without Modifications, and/or as part of a
Larger Work; and
(b)
under patents now or hereafter owned or controlled by Initial Developer, to make, have
made, use and sell (“offer to sell and import”) the Original Code, Modifications, or
portions thereof, but solely to the extent that any such patent is reasonably necessary to
enable You to utilize, alone or in combination with other software, the Original Code,
Modifications, or any combination or portions thereof.
(c)
(d)
2.2. Contributor Grant.
Subject to third party intellectual property claims, each Contributor hereby grants You a
world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license
(a)
under intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) Licensable by
Contributor, to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the
Modifications created by such Contributor (or portions thereof) either on an unmodified
basis, with other Modifications, as Covered Code and/or as part of a Larger Work; and
(b)
under patents now or hereafter owned or controlled by Contributor, to make, have
made, use and sell (“offer to sell and import”) the Contributor Version (or portions
thereof), but solely to the extent that any such patent is reasonably necessary to enable
You to utilize, alone or in combination with other software, the Contributor Version (or
portions thereof).
(c)
(d)
3 DISTRIBUTION OBLIGATIONS.
3.1. Application of License.
The Modifications which You create or to which You contribute are governed by the
terms of this License, including without limitation Section 2.2. The Source Code
version of Covered Code may be distributed only under the terms of this License or a
future version of this License released under Section 6.1, and You must include a copy
of this License with every copy of the Source Code You distribute. You may not offer
or impose any terms on any Source Code version that alters or restricts the applicable
version of this License or the recipients’ rights hereunder. However, You may include
an additional document offering the additional rights described in Section 3.5.
3.2. Availability of Source Code.
ix
Any Modification created by You will be provided to the Initial Developer in Source
Code form and are subject to the terms of the License.
3.3. Description of Modifications.
You must cause all Covered Code to which You contribute to contain a file
documenting the changes You made to create that Covered Code and the date of any
change. You must include a prominent statement that the Modification is derived,
directly or indirectly, from Original Code provided by the Initial Developer and
including the name of the Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b) in any notice
in an Executable version or related documentation in which You describe the origin or
ownership of the Covered Code.
3.4. Intellectual Property Matters.
(a) Third Party Claims.
If Contributor has knowledge that a license under a third party’s intellectual property
rights is required to exercise the rights granted by such Contributor under Sections 2.1
or 2.2, Contributor must include a text file with the Source Code distribution titled
“LEGAL” which describes the claim and the party making the claim in sufficient detail
that a recipient will know whom to contact. If Contributor obtains such knowledge after
the Modification is made available as described in Section 3.2, Contributor shall
promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies Contributor makes available thereafter
and shall take other steps (such as notifying appropriate mailing lists or newsgroups)
reasonably calculated to inform those who received the Covered Code that new
knowledge has been obtained.
(b) Contributor APIs.
If Contributor’s Modifications include an application programming interface and
Contributor has knowledge of patent licenses which are reasonably necessary to
implement that API, Contributor must also include this information in the LEGAL file.
(c) Representations.
Contributor represents that, except as disclosed pursuant to Section 3.4(a) above,
Contributor believes that Contributor’s Modifications are Contributor’s original
creation(s) and/or Contributor has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by this
License.
3.5. Required Notices.
You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in each file of the Source Code. If it is not
possible to put such notice in a particular Source Code file due to its structure, then You
must include such notice in a location (such as a relevant directory) where a user would
be likely to look for such a notice. If You created one or more Modification(s) You may
add your name as a Contributor to the notice described in Exhibit A. You must also
duplicate this License in any documentation for the Source Code where You describe
recipients’ rights or ownership rights relating to Covered Code. You may choose to
offer, and to charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligations to
one or more recipients of Covered Code. However, You may do so only on Your own
behalf, and not on behalf of the Initial Developer or any Contributor.
3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions.
You may distribute Covered Code in Executable form only if the requirements of
Section 3.1-3.5 have been met for that Covered Code. You may distribute the
Executable version of Covered Code or ownership rights under a license of Your
choice, which may contain terms different from this License, provided that You are in
compliance with the terms of this License and that the license for the Executable
version does not attempt to limit or alter the recipient’s rights in the Source Code
version from the rights set forth in this License. If You distribute the Executable version
under a different license You must make it absolutely clear that any terms which differ
from this License are offered by You alone, not by the Initial Developer or any
Contributor. If you distribute executable versions containing Covered Code as part of a
product, you must reproduce the notice in Exhibit B in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the product.
3.7. Larger Works.
You may create a Larger Work by combining Covered Code with other code not
governed by the terms of this License and distribute the Larger Work as a single
product. In such a case, You must make sure the requirements of this License are
fulfilled for the Covered Code.
3.8. Restrictions.
You may not remove any product identification, copyright, proprietary notices or labels
from gSOAP.
4 INABILITY TO COMPLY DUE TO STATUTE OR REGULATION.
If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the terms of this License with respect
to some or all of the Covered Code due to statute, judicial order, or regulation then You
must: (a) comply with the terms of this License to the maximum extent possible; and
(b) describe the limitations and the code they affect. Such description must be included
in the LEGAL file described in Section 3.4 and must be included with all distributions
of the Source Code. Except to the extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such
description must be sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able to
understand it.
5 APPLICATION OF THIS LICENSE.
This License applies to code to which the Initial Developer has attached the notice in
Exhibit A and to related Covered Code.
6 VERSIONS OF THE LICENSE.
6.1. New Versions.
Grantor may publish revised and/or new versions of the License from time to time.
Each version will be given a distinguishing version number.
6.2. Effect of New Versions.
Once Covered Code has been published under a particular version of the License, You
may always continue to use it under the terms of that version. You may also choose to
use such Covered Code under the terms of any subsequent version of the License.
6.3. Derivative Works.
If You create or use a modified version of this License (which you may only do in order
to apply it to code which is not already Covered Code governed by this License), You
must (a) rename Your license so that the phrase “gSOAP” or any confusingly similar
phrase do not appear in your license (except to note that your license differs from this
License) and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your version of the license contains terms
which differ from the gSOAP Public License. (Filling in the name of the Initial
Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the notice described in Exhibit A shall not
of themselves be deemed to be modifications of this License.)
7 DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY.
COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS LICENSE ON AN “AS IS” BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR
STATUTORY, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY INTELLECTUAL
PROPERTY RIGHTS, AND ANY WARRANTY THAT MAY ARISE BY REASON
OF TRADE USAGE, CUSTOM, OR COURSE OF DEALING. WITHOUT
LIMITING THE FOREGOING, YOU ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THE SOFTWARE
IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND THAT THE AUTHORS DO NOT WARRANT THE
SOFTWARE WILL RUN UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE. LIMITED
LIABILITY THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO RESULTS AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
SOFTWARE IS ASSUMED BY YOU. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES WILL THE
AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND OR NATURE
WHATSOEVER, WHETHER BASED ON CONTRACT, WARRANTY, TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), STRICT LIABILITY OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
OUT OF OR IN ANY WAY RELATED TO THE SOFTWARE, EVEN IF THE
AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED ON THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE
OR IF SUCH DAMAGE COULD HAVE BEEN REASONABLY FORESEEN, AND
NOTWITHSTANDING ANY FAILURE OF ESSENTIAL PURPOSE OF ANY
EXCLUSIVE REMEDY PROVIDED. SUCH LIMITATION ON DAMAGES
INCLUDES, BUT IS NOT LIMITED TO, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL,
LOST PROFITS, LOSS OF DATA OR SOFTWARE, WORK STOPPAGE,
COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION OR IMPAIRMENT OF OTHER
GOODS. IN NO EVENT WILL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR THE COSTS OF
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES. YOU
ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THIS SOFTWARE IS NOT DESIGNED FOR USE IN ON-
LINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS SUCH AS OPERATION
OF NUCLEAR FACILITIES, AIRCRAFT NAVIGATION OR CONTROL, OR LIFE-
CRITICAL APPLICATIONS. THE AUTHORS EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ANY
LIABILITY RESULTING FROM USE OF THE SOFTWARE IN ANY SUCH ON-
LINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS AND ACCEPTS NO
LIABILITY IN RESPECT OF ANY ACTIONS OR CLAIMS BASED ON THE USE
OF THE SOFTWARE IN ANY SUCH ON-LINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS
ENVIRONMENTS BY YOU. FOR PURPOSES OF THIS PARAGRAPH, THE
TERM “LIFE- CRITICAL APPLICATION” MEANS AN APPLICATION IN
WHICH THE FUNCTIONING OR MALFUNCTIONING OF THE SOFTWARE
MAY RESULT DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY IN PHYSICAL INJURY OR LOSS
OF HUMAN LIFE. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN
ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS LICENSE. NO USE OF ANY COVERED CODE IS
AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER.
8 TERMINATION.
8.1.
This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate automatically if You fail to
comply with terms herein and fail to cure such breach within 30 days of becoming
aware of the breach. All sublicenses to the Covered Code which are properly granted
shall survive any termination of this License. Provisions which, by their nature, must
remain in effect beyond the termination of this License shall survive.
8.2.
8.3.
If You assert a patent infringement claim against Participant alleging that such
Participant’s Contributor Version directly or indirectly infringes any patent where such
claim is resolved (such as by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of patent
infringement litigation, then the reasonable value of the licenses granted by such
Participant under Sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken into account in determining the
amount or value of any payment or license.
8.4.
In the event of termination under Sections 8.1 or 8.2 above, all end user license
agreements (excluding distributors and resellers) which have been validly granted by
You or any distributor hereunder prior to termination shall survive termination.
9 LIMITATION OF LIABILITY.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE, SHALL
YOU, THE INITIAL DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY
DISTRIBUTOR OF COVERED CODE, OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH
PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL,
INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL,
WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND
ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF SUCH PARTY
SHALL HAVE BEEN INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY FOR
DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY’S
NEGLIGENCE TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW PROHIBITS SUCH
LIMITATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THIS
EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
10 U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS.
11 MISCELLANEOUS.
12 RESPONSIBILITY FOR CLAIMS.
As between Initial Developer and the Contributors, each party is responsible for claims
and damages arising, directly or indirectly, out of its utilization of rights under this
License and You agree to work with Initial Developer and Contributors to distribute
such responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing herein is intended or shall be deemed
to constitute any admission of liability.
EXHIBIT A.
“The contents of this file are subject to the gSOAP Public License Version 1.3 (the
“License”); you may not use this
file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of the License
athttp://www.cs.fsu.edu/ engelen/soaplicense.html
x
Software distributed under the License is distributed on an “AS IS” basis, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License for the
specific language governing rights and limitations under the License.
The Original Code of the gSOAP Software is: stdsoap.h, stdsoap2.h, stdsoap.c,
stdsoap2.c, stdsoap.cpp,
stdsoap2.cpp, soapcpp2.h, soapcpp2.c, soapcpp2_lex.l, soapcpp2_yacc.y, error2.h,
error2.c, symbol2.c, init2.c,
soapdoc2.html, and soapdoc2.pdf, httpget.h, httpget.c, stl.h, stldeque.h, stllist.h,
stlvector.h, stlset.h.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is Robert A. van Engelen. Portions created
by Robert A. van Engelen are
Copyright (C) 2001-2004 Robert A. van Engelen, Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s):
“________________________.”
[Note: The text of this Exhibit A may differ slightly form the text of the notices in the
Source Code files of the Original code. You should use the text of this Exhibit A rather
than the text found in the Original Code Source Codefor Your Modifications.]
EXHIBIT B.
“Part of the software embedded in this product is gSOAP software.
Portions created by gSOAP are Copyright (C) 2001-2009 Robert A. van Engelen,
Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved. THE SOFTWARE IN THIS PRODUCT WAS IN
PART PROVIDED BY GENIVIA INC AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.”
http://www.cs.fsu.edu/~engelen/license.html
About fonts
Fonts are (c) Bitstream (see below). DejaVu changes are in public domain.
Glyphs imported from Arev fonts are (c) Tavmjong Bah (see below)
Bitstream Vera Fonts Copyright
------------------------------
Copyright (c) 2003 by Bitstream, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Bitstream Vera is a
trademark of Bitstream, Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of the fonts
accompanying this license (“Fonts”) and associated documentation files (the “Font
Software”), to reproduce and distribute the Font Software, including without limitation
the rights to use, copy, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Font
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Font Software is furnished to do so,
subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright and trademark notices and this permission notice shall be included
in all copies of one or more of the Font Software typefaces.
The Font Software may be modified, altered, or added to, and in particular the designs
of glyphs or characters in the Fonts may be modified and additional glyphs or
characters may be added to the Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not
containing either the words “Bitstream” or the word “Vera”.
This License becomes null and void to the extent applicable to Fonts or Font Software
that has been modified and is distributed under the “Bitstream Vera” names.
The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger software package but no copy of one
or more of the Font Software typefaces may be sold by itself.
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT,
TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL BITSTREAM OR THE
GNOME FOUNDATION BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO
USE THE FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT
SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the names of Gnome, the Gnome Foundation, and
Bitstream Inc., shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or
other dealings in this Font Software without prior written authorization from the Gnome
Foundation or Bitstream Inc., respectively. For further information, contact: fonts at
gnome dot org.
Arev Fonts Copyright
------------------------------
Copyright (c) 2006 by Tavmjong Bah. All Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of the fonts
accompanying this license (“Fonts”) and associated documentation files (the “Font
Software”), to reproduce and distribute the modifications to the Bitstream Vera Font
Software, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, merge, publish,
distribute, and/or sell copies of the Font Software, and to permit persons to whom the
Font Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright and trademark notices and this permission notice shall be included
in all copies of one or more of the Font Software typefaces.
The Font Software may be modified, altered, or added to, and in particular the designs
of glyphs or characters in the Fonts may be modified and additional glyphs or
characters may be added to the Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not
containing either the words “Tavmjong Bah” or the word “Arev”.
This License becomes null and void to the extent applicable to Fonts or Font Software
that has been modified and is distributed under the “Tavmjong Bah Arev” names.
The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger software package but no copy of one
or more of the Font Software typefaces may be sold by itself.
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT,
TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL TAVMJONG BAH BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Tavmjong Bah shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Font Software
without prior written authorization from Tavmjong Bah. For further information,
contact: tavmjong @ free. fr.
BD-A1010
© 2011 Yamaha Corporation
Printed in Malaysia WZ02530
(전원 키)
본 기기의 전원을 켜거나 대기 모드에 맞추십시오.
00_BD-A1010_K_cv.fm Page 1 Tuesday, April 19, 2011 2:52 PM
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138
  • Page 139 139
  • Page 140 140
  • Page 141 141
  • Page 142 142
  • Page 143 143
  • Page 144 144

Yamaha BD-A1010 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Reproductores de Blu-Ray
Tipo
El manual del propietario

En otros idiomas